You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

24182 lines
642KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}@@@var{id}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program optionally followed by "@@@var{id}".
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{FILTER_NAME} ::= @var{NAME}["@@"@var{NAME}]
  173. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  174. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  175. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  176. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{FILTER_NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  177. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  178. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  179. @end example
  180. @anchor{filtergraph escaping}
  181. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  182. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  183. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  184. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  185. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  186. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  187. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  188. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  189. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  190. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  191. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  192. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  193. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  194. characters contained within it.
  195. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  196. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  197. @example
  198. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  199. @end example
  200. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  201. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  202. @example
  203. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  204. @end example
  205. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  206. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  207. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  208. @example
  209. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  210. @end example
  211. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  212. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  213. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  214. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  215. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  216. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  217. previous string will finally result in:
  218. @example
  219. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  220. @end example
  221. @chapter Timeline editing
  222. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  223. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  224. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  225. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  226. next filter in the filtergraph.
  227. The expression accepts the following values:
  228. @table @samp
  229. @item t
  230. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  231. @item n
  232. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  233. @item pos
  234. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  235. @item w
  236. @item h
  237. width and height of the input frame if video
  238. @end table
  239. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  240. to re-define the expression.
  241. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  242. rules.
  243. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  244. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  245. @example
  246. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  247. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  248. @end example
  249. See @code{ffmpeg -filters} to view which filters have timeline support.
  250. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  251. @anchor{commands}
  252. @chapter Changing options at runtime with a command
  253. Some options can be changed during the operation of the filter using
  254. a command. These options are marked 'T' on the output of
  255. @command{ffmpeg} @option{-h filter=<name of filter>}.
  256. The name of the command is the name of the option and the argument is
  257. the new value.
  258. @anchor{framesync}
  259. @chapter Options for filters with several inputs (framesync)
  260. @c man begin OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  261. Some filters with several inputs support a common set of options.
  262. These options can only be set by name, not with the short notation.
  263. @table @option
  264. @item eof_action
  265. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  266. one of the following values:
  267. @table @option
  268. @item repeat
  269. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  270. @item endall
  271. End both streams.
  272. @item pass
  273. Pass the main input through.
  274. @end table
  275. @item shortest
  276. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  277. terminates. Default value is 0.
  278. @item repeatlast
  279. If set to 1, force the filter to extend the last frame of secondary streams
  280. until the end of the primary stream. A value of 0 disables this behavior.
  281. Default value is 1.
  282. @end table
  283. @c man end OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  284. @chapter Audio Filters
  285. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  286. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  287. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  288. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  289. build.
  290. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  291. @section acompressor
  292. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  293. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  294. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  295. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  296. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  297. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  298. but can also destroy a track completely).
  299. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  300. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  301. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  302. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  303. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  304. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  305. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  306. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  307. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  308. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  309. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  310. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  311. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  312. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  313. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  314. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  315. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  316. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  317. The filter accepts the following options:
  318. @table @option
  319. @item level_in
  320. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  321. @item mode
  322. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  323. Default is @code{downward}.
  324. @item threshold
  325. If a signal of stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  326. reduction.
  327. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  328. @item ratio
  329. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  330. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  331. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  332. @item attack
  333. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  334. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  335. @item release
  336. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  337. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  338. @item makeup
  339. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  340. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  341. @item knee
  342. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  343. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  344. @item link
  345. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  346. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  347. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  348. @item detection
  349. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  350. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  351. @item mix
  352. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  353. Range is between 0 and 1.
  354. @end table
  355. @section acontrast
  356. Simple audio dynamic range compression/expansion filter.
  357. The filter accepts the following options:
  358. @table @option
  359. @item contrast
  360. Set contrast. Default is 33. Allowed range is between 0 and 100.
  361. @end table
  362. @section acopy
  363. Copy the input audio source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  364. testing purposes.
  365. @section acrossfade
  366. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  367. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  368. The filter accepts the following options:
  369. @table @option
  370. @item nb_samples, ns
  371. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  372. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  373. silent. Default is 44100.
  374. @item duration, d
  375. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  376. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  377. for the accepted syntax.
  378. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  379. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  380. @item overlap, o
  381. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  382. @item curve1
  383. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  384. @item curve2
  385. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  386. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  387. @end table
  388. @subsection Examples
  389. @itemize
  390. @item
  391. Cross fade from one input to another:
  392. @example
  393. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  394. @end example
  395. @item
  396. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  397. @example
  398. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  399. @end example
  400. @end itemize
  401. @section acrossover
  402. Split audio stream into several bands.
  403. This filter splits audio stream into two or more frequency ranges.
  404. Summing all streams back will give flat output.
  405. The filter accepts the following options:
  406. @table @option
  407. @item split
  408. Set split frequencies. Those must be positive and increasing.
  409. @item order
  410. Set filter order, can be @var{2nd}, @var{4th} or @var{8th}.
  411. Default is @var{4th}.
  412. @end table
  413. @section acrusher
  414. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  415. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  416. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  417. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  418. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  419. This filter is able to even round to continuous values instead of discrete
  420. bit depths.
  421. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  422. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  423. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  424. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  425. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  426. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  427. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception,
  428. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  429. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  430. The filter accepts the following options:
  431. @table @option
  432. @item level_in
  433. Set level in.
  434. @item level_out
  435. Set level out.
  436. @item bits
  437. Set bit reduction.
  438. @item mix
  439. Set mixing amount.
  440. @item mode
  441. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  442. @item dc
  443. Set DC.
  444. @item aa
  445. Set anti-aliasing.
  446. @item samples
  447. Set sample reduction.
  448. @item lfo
  449. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  450. @item lforange
  451. Set LFO range.
  452. @item lforate
  453. Set LFO rate.
  454. @end table
  455. @section acue
  456. Delay audio filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. See the @ref{cue}
  457. filter.
  458. @section adeclick
  459. Remove impulsive noise from input audio.
  460. Samples detected as impulsive noise are replaced by interpolated samples using
  461. autoregressive modelling.
  462. @table @option
  463. @item w
  464. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to
  465. @code{100}. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  466. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  467. @item o
  468. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  469. @code{50} to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  470. Setting this to a very high value increases impulsive noise removal but makes
  471. whole process much slower.
  472. @item a
  473. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  474. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{2} percent. This option also
  475. controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  476. @item t
  477. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  478. Default value is @code{2}.
  479. This controls the strength of impulsive noise which is going to be removed.
  480. The lower value, the more samples will be detected as impulsive noise.
  481. @item b
  482. Set burst fusion, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is @code{0} to
  483. @code{10}. Default value is @code{2}.
  484. If any two samples detected as noise are spaced less than this value then any
  485. sample between those two samples will be also detected as noise.
  486. @item m
  487. Set overlap method.
  488. It accepts the following values:
  489. @table @option
  490. @item a
  491. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly
  492. changed with this method.
  493. @item s
  494. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  495. @end table
  496. Default value is @code{a}.
  497. @end table
  498. @section adeclip
  499. Remove clipped samples from input audio.
  500. Samples detected as clipped are replaced by interpolated samples using
  501. autoregressive modelling.
  502. @table @option
  503. @item w
  504. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to @code{100}.
  505. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  506. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  507. @item o
  508. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from @code{50}
  509. to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  510. @item a
  511. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  512. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{8} percent. This option also controls
  513. quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  514. @item t
  515. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  516. Default value is @code{10}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  517. @item n
  518. Set size of histogram used to detect clips. Allowed range is from @code{100} to @code{9999}.
  519. Default value is @code{1000}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  520. @item m
  521. Set overlap method.
  522. It accepts the following values:
  523. @table @option
  524. @item a
  525. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed
  526. with this method.
  527. @item s
  528. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  529. @end table
  530. Default value is @code{a}.
  531. @end table
  532. @section adelay
  533. Delay one or more audio channels.
  534. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  535. The filter accepts the following option:
  536. @table @option
  537. @item delays
  538. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  539. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  540. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  541. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  542. If you want instead to delay in seconds, append 's' to number.
  543. @item all
  544. Use last set delay for all remaining channels. By default is disabled.
  545. This option if enabled changes how option @code{delays} is interpreted.
  546. @end table
  547. @subsection Examples
  548. @itemize
  549. @item
  550. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  551. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  552. @example
  553. adelay=1500|0|500
  554. @end example
  555. @item
  556. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  557. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  558. @example
  559. adelay=0|500S|700S
  560. @end example
  561. @item
  562. Delay all channels by same number of samples:
  563. @example
  564. adelay=delays=64S:all=1
  565. @end example
  566. @end itemize
  567. @section aderivative, aintegral
  568. Compute derivative/integral of audio stream.
  569. Applying both filters one after another produces original audio.
  570. @section aecho
  571. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  572. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  573. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  574. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  575. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  576. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  577. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  578. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  579. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  580. @table @option
  581. @item in_gain
  582. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  583. @item out_gain
  584. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  585. @item delays
  586. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  587. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  588. Default is @code{1000}.
  589. @item decays
  590. Set list of loudness of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  591. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  592. Default is @code{0.5}.
  593. @end table
  594. @subsection Examples
  595. @itemize
  596. @item
  597. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  598. @example
  599. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  600. @end example
  601. @item
  602. If delay is very short, then it sounds like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  603. @example
  604. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  605. @end example
  606. @item
  607. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  608. @example
  609. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  610. @end example
  611. @item
  612. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  613. @example
  614. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  615. @end example
  616. @end itemize
  617. @section aemphasis
  618. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  619. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  620. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  621. this recording medium.
  622. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  623. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  624. The filter accepts the following options:
  625. @table @option
  626. @item level_in
  627. Set input gain.
  628. @item level_out
  629. Set output gain.
  630. @item mode
  631. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  632. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  633. @item type
  634. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  635. @table @option
  636. @item col
  637. select Columbia.
  638. @item emi
  639. select EMI.
  640. @item bsi
  641. select BSI (78RPM).
  642. @item riaa
  643. select RIAA.
  644. @item cd
  645. select Compact Disc (CD).
  646. @item 50fm
  647. select 50µs (FM).
  648. @item 75fm
  649. select 75µs (FM).
  650. @item 50kf
  651. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  652. @item 75kf
  653. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  654. @end table
  655. @end table
  656. @section aeval
  657. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  658. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  659. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  660. It accepts the following parameters:
  661. @table @option
  662. @item exprs
  663. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  664. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  665. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  666. output channels.
  667. @item channel_layout, c
  668. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  669. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  670. use by default the same input channel layout.
  671. @end table
  672. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  673. @table @option
  674. @item ch
  675. channel number of the current expression
  676. @item n
  677. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  678. @item s
  679. sample rate
  680. @item t
  681. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  682. @item nb_in_channels
  683. @item nb_out_channels
  684. input and output number of channels
  685. @item val(CH)
  686. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  687. @end table
  688. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  689. dedicated filter.
  690. @subsection Examples
  691. @itemize
  692. @item
  693. Half volume:
  694. @example
  695. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  696. @end example
  697. @item
  698. Invert phase of the second channel:
  699. @example
  700. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  701. @end example
  702. @end itemize
  703. @anchor{afade}
  704. @section afade
  705. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  706. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  707. @table @option
  708. @item type, t
  709. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  710. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  711. @item start_sample, ss
  712. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  713. effect. Default is 0.
  714. @item nb_samples, ns
  715. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  716. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  717. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  718. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  719. @item start_time, st
  720. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  721. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  722. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  723. for the accepted syntax.
  724. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  725. @item duration, d
  726. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  727. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  728. for the accepted syntax.
  729. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  730. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  731. the output audio will be silence.
  732. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  733. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  734. @item curve
  735. Set curve for fade transition.
  736. It accepts the following values:
  737. @table @option
  738. @item tri
  739. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  740. @item qsin
  741. select quarter of sine wave
  742. @item hsin
  743. select half of sine wave
  744. @item esin
  745. select exponential sine wave
  746. @item log
  747. select logarithmic
  748. @item ipar
  749. select inverted parabola
  750. @item qua
  751. select quadratic
  752. @item cub
  753. select cubic
  754. @item squ
  755. select square root
  756. @item cbr
  757. select cubic root
  758. @item par
  759. select parabola
  760. @item exp
  761. select exponential
  762. @item iqsin
  763. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  764. @item ihsin
  765. select inverted half of sine wave
  766. @item dese
  767. select double-exponential seat
  768. @item desi
  769. select double-exponential sigmoid
  770. @item losi
  771. select logistic sigmoid
  772. @item nofade
  773. no fade applied
  774. @end table
  775. @end table
  776. @subsection Examples
  777. @itemize
  778. @item
  779. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  780. @example
  781. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  782. @end example
  783. @item
  784. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  785. @example
  786. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  787. @end example
  788. @end itemize
  789. @section afftdn
  790. Denoise audio samples with FFT.
  791. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  792. @table @option
  793. @item nr
  794. Set the noise reduction in dB, allowed range is 0.01 to 97.
  795. Default value is 12 dB.
  796. @item nf
  797. Set the noise floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  798. Default value is -50 dB.
  799. @item nt
  800. Set the noise type.
  801. It accepts the following values:
  802. @table @option
  803. @item w
  804. Select white noise.
  805. @item v
  806. Select vinyl noise.
  807. @item s
  808. Select shellac noise.
  809. @item c
  810. Select custom noise, defined in @code{bn} option.
  811. Default value is white noise.
  812. @end table
  813. @item bn
  814. Set custom band noise for every one of 15 bands.
  815. Bands are separated by ' ' or '|'.
  816. @item rf
  817. Set the residual floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  818. Default value is -38 dB.
  819. @item tn
  820. Enable noise tracking. By default is disabled.
  821. With this enabled, noise floor is automatically adjusted.
  822. @item tr
  823. Enable residual tracking. By default is disabled.
  824. @item om
  825. Set the output mode.
  826. It accepts the following values:
  827. @table @option
  828. @item i
  829. Pass input unchanged.
  830. @item o
  831. Pass noise filtered out.
  832. @item n
  833. Pass only noise.
  834. Default value is @var{o}.
  835. @end table
  836. @end table
  837. @subsection Commands
  838. This filter supports the following commands:
  839. @table @option
  840. @item sample_noise, sn
  841. Start or stop measuring noise profile.
  842. Syntax for the command is : "start" or "stop" string.
  843. After measuring noise profile is stopped it will be
  844. automatically applied in filtering.
  845. @item noise_reduction, nr
  846. Change noise reduction. Argument is single float number.
  847. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_reduction}"
  848. @item noise_floor, nf
  849. Change noise floor. Argument is single float number.
  850. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_floor}"
  851. @item output_mode, om
  852. Change output mode operation.
  853. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  854. @end table
  855. @section afftfilt
  856. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  857. @table @option
  858. @item real
  859. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  860. by '|'. Default is "re".
  861. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  862. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  863. output channels.
  864. @item imag
  865. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  866. separated by '|'. Default is "im".
  867. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  868. constants and functions:
  869. @table @option
  870. @item sr
  871. sample rate
  872. @item b
  873. current frequency bin number
  874. @item nb
  875. number of available bins
  876. @item ch
  877. channel number of the current expression
  878. @item chs
  879. number of channels
  880. @item pts
  881. current frame pts
  882. @item re
  883. current real part of frequency bin of current channel
  884. @item im
  885. current imaginary part of frequency bin of current channel
  886. @item real(b, ch)
  887. Return the value of real part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  888. @item imag(b, ch)
  889. Return the value of imaginary part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  890. @end table
  891. @item win_size
  892. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 131072.
  893. Default is @code{4096}
  894. @item win_func
  895. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  896. @item overlap
  897. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  898. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  899. @end table
  900. @subsection Examples
  901. @itemize
  902. @item
  903. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  904. @example
  905. afftfilt="'real=re * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))':imag='im * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))'"
  906. @end example
  907. @item
  908. Apply robotize effect:
  909. @example
  910. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*sin(0)':imag='hypot(re,im)*cos(0)':win_size=512:overlap=0.75"
  911. @end example
  912. @item
  913. Apply whisper effect:
  914. @example
  915. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*cos((random(0)*2-1)*2*3.14)':imag='hypot(re,im)*sin((random(1)*2-1)*2*3.14)':win_size=128:overlap=0.8"
  916. @end example
  917. @end itemize
  918. @anchor{afir}
  919. @section afir
  920. Apply an arbitrary Frequency Impulse Response filter.
  921. This filter is designed for applying long FIR filters,
  922. up to 60 seconds long.
  923. It can be used as component for digital crossover filters,
  924. room equalization, cross talk cancellation, wavefield synthesis,
  925. auralization, ambiophonics, ambisonics and spatialization.
  926. This filter uses the second stream as FIR coefficients.
  927. If the second stream holds a single channel, it will be used
  928. for all input channels in the first stream, otherwise
  929. the number of channels in the second stream must be same as
  930. the number of channels in the first stream.
  931. It accepts the following parameters:
  932. @table @option
  933. @item dry
  934. Set dry gain. This sets input gain.
  935. @item wet
  936. Set wet gain. This sets final output gain.
  937. @item length
  938. Set Impulse Response filter length. Default is 1, which means whole IR is processed.
  939. @item gtype
  940. Enable applying gain measured from power of IR.
  941. Set which approach to use for auto gain measurement.
  942. @table @option
  943. @item none
  944. Do not apply any gain.
  945. @item peak
  946. select peak gain, very conservative approach. This is default value.
  947. @item dc
  948. select DC gain, limited application.
  949. @item gn
  950. select gain to noise approach, this is most popular one.
  951. @end table
  952. @item irgain
  953. Set gain to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.
  954. Allowed range is 0 to 1. This gain is applied after any gain applied with @var{gtype} option.
  955. @item irfmt
  956. Set format of IR stream. Can be @code{mono} or @code{input}.
  957. Default is @code{input}.
  958. @item maxir
  959. Set max allowed Impulse Response filter duration in seconds. Default is 30 seconds.
  960. Allowed range is 0.1 to 60 seconds.
  961. @item response
  962. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  963. By default it is disabled.
  964. @item channel
  965. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  966. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  967. @item size
  968. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  969. @item rate
  970. Set video stream frame rate. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  971. @item minp
  972. Set minimal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  973. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  974. Lower values decreases latency at cost of higher CPU usage.
  975. @item maxp
  976. Set maximal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  977. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  978. Lower values may increase CPU usage.
  979. @end table
  980. @subsection Examples
  981. @itemize
  982. @item
  983. Apply reverb to stream using mono IR file as second input, complete command using ffmpeg:
  984. @example
  985. ffmpeg -i input.wav -i middle_tunnel_1way_mono.wav -lavfi afir output.wav
  986. @end example
  987. @end itemize
  988. @anchor{aformat}
  989. @section aformat
  990. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  991. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  992. It accepts the following parameters:
  993. @table @option
  994. @item sample_fmts
  995. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  996. @item sample_rates
  997. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  998. @item channel_layouts
  999. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  1000. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1001. for the required syntax.
  1002. @end table
  1003. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  1004. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  1005. @example
  1006. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  1007. @end example
  1008. @section agate
  1009. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  1010. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  1011. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  1012. and dividing it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  1013. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  1014. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  1015. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  1016. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  1017. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  1018. has to rise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  1019. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  1020. @table @option
  1021. @item level_in
  1022. Set input level before filtering.
  1023. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  1024. @item mode
  1025. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  1026. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  1027. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  1028. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  1029. @item range
  1030. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  1031. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1032. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  1033. @item threshold
  1034. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  1035. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1036. @item ratio
  1037. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced.
  1038. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  1039. @item attack
  1040. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  1041. reduction stops.
  1042. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1043. @item release
  1044. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  1045. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  1046. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1047. @item makeup
  1048. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  1049. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  1050. @item knee
  1051. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  1052. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  1053. @item detection
  1054. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  1055. Default is @code{rms}. Can be @code{peak} or @code{rms}.
  1056. @item link
  1057. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  1058. the reduction.
  1059. Default is @code{average}. Can be @code{average} or @code{maximum}.
  1060. @end table
  1061. @section aiir
  1062. Apply an arbitrary Infinite Impulse Response filter.
  1063. It accepts the following parameters:
  1064. @table @option
  1065. @item z
  1066. Set numerator/zeros coefficients.
  1067. @item p
  1068. Set denominator/poles coefficients.
  1069. @item k
  1070. Set channels gains.
  1071. @item dry_gain
  1072. Set input gain.
  1073. @item wet_gain
  1074. Set output gain.
  1075. @item f
  1076. Set coefficients format.
  1077. @table @samp
  1078. @item tf
  1079. transfer function
  1080. @item zp
  1081. Z-plane zeros/poles, cartesian (default)
  1082. @item pr
  1083. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar radians
  1084. @item pd
  1085. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar degrees
  1086. @end table
  1087. @item r
  1088. Set kind of processing.
  1089. Can be @code{d} - direct or @code{s} - serial cascading. Default is @code{s}.
  1090. @item e
  1091. Set filtering precision.
  1092. @table @samp
  1093. @item dbl
  1094. double-precision floating-point (default)
  1095. @item flt
  1096. single-precision floating-point
  1097. @item i32
  1098. 32-bit integers
  1099. @item i16
  1100. 16-bit integers
  1101. @end table
  1102. @item mix
  1103. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1104. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1105. @item response
  1106. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  1107. By default it is disabled.
  1108. @item channel
  1109. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  1110. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1111. @item size
  1112. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1113. @end table
  1114. Coefficients in @code{tf} format are separated by spaces and are in ascending
  1115. order.
  1116. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are separated by spaces and order of coefficients
  1117. doesn't matter. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are complex numbers with @var{i}
  1118. imaginary unit.
  1119. Different coefficients and gains can be provided for every channel, in such case
  1120. use '|' to separate coefficients or gains. Last provided coefficients will be
  1121. used for all remaining channels.
  1122. @subsection Examples
  1123. @itemize
  1124. @item
  1125. Apply 2 pole elliptic notch at around 5000Hz for 48000 Hz sample rate:
  1126. @example
  1127. aiir=k=1:z=7.957584807809675810E-1 -2.575128568908332300 3.674839853930788710 -2.57512875289799137 7.957586296317130880E-1:p=1 -2.86950072432325953 3.63022088054647218 -2.28075678147272232 6.361362326477423500E-1:f=tf:r=d
  1128. @end example
  1129. @item
  1130. Same as above but in @code{zp} format:
  1131. @example
  1132. aiir=k=0.79575848078096756:z=0.80918701+0.58773007i 0.80918701-0.58773007i 0.80884700+0.58784055i 0.80884700-0.58784055i:p=0.63892345+0.59951235i 0.63892345-0.59951235i 0.79582691+0.44198673i 0.79582691-0.44198673i:f=zp:r=s
  1133. @end example
  1134. @end itemize
  1135. @section alimiter
  1136. The limiter prevents an input signal from rising over a desired threshold.
  1137. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  1138. It means that there is a small delay after the signal is processed. Keep in mind
  1139. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  1140. The filter accepts the following options:
  1141. @table @option
  1142. @item level_in
  1143. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  1144. @item level_out
  1145. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  1146. @item limit
  1147. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  1148. @item attack
  1149. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  1150. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  1151. @item release
  1152. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  1153. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  1154. @item asc
  1155. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  1156. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  1157. time.
  1158. @item asc_level
  1159. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  1160. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  1161. @item level
  1162. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  1163. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  1164. @end table
  1165. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  1166. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  1167. @section allpass
  1168. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  1169. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  1170. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  1171. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  1172. The filter accepts the following options:
  1173. @table @option
  1174. @item frequency, f
  1175. Set frequency in Hz.
  1176. @item width_type, t
  1177. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1178. @table @option
  1179. @item h
  1180. Hz
  1181. @item q
  1182. Q-Factor
  1183. @item o
  1184. octave
  1185. @item s
  1186. slope
  1187. @item k
  1188. kHz
  1189. @end table
  1190. @item width, w
  1191. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1192. @item mix, m
  1193. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1194. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1195. @item channels, c
  1196. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1197. @end table
  1198. @subsection Commands
  1199. This filter supports the following commands:
  1200. @table @option
  1201. @item frequency, f
  1202. Change allpass frequency.
  1203. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1204. @item width_type, t
  1205. Change allpass width_type.
  1206. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1207. @item width, w
  1208. Change allpass width.
  1209. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1210. @item mix, m
  1211. Change allpass mix.
  1212. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1213. @end table
  1214. @section aloop
  1215. Loop audio samples.
  1216. The filter accepts the following options:
  1217. @table @option
  1218. @item loop
  1219. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  1220. Default is 0.
  1221. @item size
  1222. Set maximal number of samples. Default is 0.
  1223. @item start
  1224. Set first sample of loop. Default is 0.
  1225. @end table
  1226. @anchor{amerge}
  1227. @section amerge
  1228. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  1229. The filter accepts the following options:
  1230. @table @option
  1231. @item inputs
  1232. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  1233. @end table
  1234. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  1235. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  1236. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  1237. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  1238. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  1239. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  1240. channels.
  1241. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  1242. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  1243. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  1244. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  1245. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  1246. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  1247. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  1248. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  1249. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  1250. shortest.
  1251. @subsection Examples
  1252. @itemize
  1253. @item
  1254. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  1255. @example
  1256. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  1257. @end example
  1258. @item
  1259. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  1260. @example
  1261. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  1262. @end example
  1263. @end itemize
  1264. @section amix
  1265. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  1266. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  1267. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  1268. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  1269. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  1270. For example
  1271. @example
  1272. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  1273. @end example
  1274. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  1275. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  1276. It accepts the following parameters:
  1277. @table @option
  1278. @item inputs
  1279. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  1280. @item duration
  1281. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  1282. @table @option
  1283. @item longest
  1284. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  1285. @item shortest
  1286. The duration of the shortest input.
  1287. @item first
  1288. The duration of the first input.
  1289. @end table
  1290. @item dropout_transition
  1291. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  1292. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  1293. @item weights
  1294. Specify weight of each input audio stream as sequence.
  1295. Each weight is separated by space. By default all inputs have same weight.
  1296. @end table
  1297. @section amultiply
  1298. Multiply first audio stream with second audio stream and store result
  1299. in output audio stream. Multiplication is done by multiplying each
  1300. sample from first stream with sample at same position from second stream.
  1301. With this element-wise multiplication one can create amplitude fades and
  1302. amplitude modulations.
  1303. @section anequalizer
  1304. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  1305. It accepts the following parameters:
  1306. @table @option
  1307. @item params
  1308. This option string is in format:
  1309. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  1310. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  1311. @table @option
  1312. @item chn
  1313. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  1314. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  1315. @item f
  1316. Set central frequency for band.
  1317. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  1318. @item w
  1319. Set band width in hertz.
  1320. @item g
  1321. Set band gain in dB.
  1322. @item t
  1323. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  1324. @table @samp
  1325. @item 0
  1326. Butterworth, this is default.
  1327. @item 1
  1328. Chebyshev type 1.
  1329. @item 2
  1330. Chebyshev type 2.
  1331. @end table
  1332. @end table
  1333. @item curves
  1334. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  1335. in video stream.
  1336. @item size
  1337. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1338. @item mgain
  1339. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1340. Setting this to a reasonable value makes it possible to display gain which is derived from
  1341. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  1342. when both are activated.
  1343. @item fscale
  1344. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  1345. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  1346. @item colors
  1347. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  1348. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  1349. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  1350. @end table
  1351. @subsection Examples
  1352. @itemize
  1353. @item
  1354. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  1355. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  1356. @example
  1357. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  1358. @end example
  1359. @end itemize
  1360. @subsection Commands
  1361. This filter supports the following commands:
  1362. @table @option
  1363. @item change
  1364. Alter existing filter parameters.
  1365. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  1366. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  1367. error is returned.
  1368. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  1369. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  1370. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  1371. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  1372. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  1373. @end table
  1374. @section anlmdn
  1375. Reduce broadband noise in audio samples using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  1376. Each sample is adjusted by looking for other samples with similar contexts. This
  1377. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  1378. @option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r} around the sample.
  1379. The filter accepts the following options:
  1380. @table @option
  1381. @item s
  1382. Set denoising strength. Allowed range is from 0.00001 to 10. Default value is 0.00001.
  1383. @item p
  1384. Set patch radius duration. Allowed range is from 1 to 100 milliseconds.
  1385. Default value is 2 milliseconds.
  1386. @item r
  1387. Set research radius duration. Allowed range is from 2 to 300 milliseconds.
  1388. Default value is 6 milliseconds.
  1389. @item o
  1390. Set the output mode.
  1391. It accepts the following values:
  1392. @table @option
  1393. @item i
  1394. Pass input unchanged.
  1395. @item o
  1396. Pass noise filtered out.
  1397. @item n
  1398. Pass only noise.
  1399. Default value is @var{o}.
  1400. @end table
  1401. @item m
  1402. Set smooth factor. Default value is @var{11}. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{15}.
  1403. @end table
  1404. @subsection Commands
  1405. This filter supports the following commands:
  1406. @table @option
  1407. @item s
  1408. Change denoise strength. Argument is single float number.
  1409. Syntax for the command is : "@var{s}"
  1410. @item o
  1411. Change output mode.
  1412. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  1413. @end table
  1414. @section anlms
  1415. Apply Normalized Least-Mean-Squares algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.
  1416. This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by finding the filter coefficients that
  1417. relate to producing the least mean square of the error signal (difference between the desired,
  1418. 2nd input audio stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio stream).
  1419. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1420. @table @option
  1421. @item order
  1422. Set filter order.
  1423. @item mu
  1424. Set filter mu.
  1425. @item eps
  1426. Set the filter eps.
  1427. @item leakage
  1428. Set the filter leakage.
  1429. @item out_mode
  1430. It accepts the following values:
  1431. @table @option
  1432. @item i
  1433. Pass the 1st input.
  1434. @item d
  1435. Pass the 2nd input.
  1436. @item o
  1437. Pass filtered samples.
  1438. @item n
  1439. Pass difference between desired and filtered samples.
  1440. Default value is @var{o}.
  1441. @end table
  1442. @end table
  1443. @subsection Examples
  1444. @itemize
  1445. @item
  1446. One of many usages of this filter is noise reduction, input audio is filtered
  1447. with same samples that are delayed by fixed amount, one such example for stereo audio is:
  1448. @example
  1449. asplit[a][b],[a]adelay=32S|32S[a],[b][a]anlms=order=128:leakage=0.0005:mu=.5:out_mode=o
  1450. @end example
  1451. @end itemize
  1452. @subsection Commands
  1453. This filter supports the same commands as options, excluding option @code{order}.
  1454. @section anull
  1455. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  1456. @section apad
  1457. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  1458. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  1459. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  1460. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1461. @table @option
  1462. @item packet_size
  1463. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  1464. @item pad_len
  1465. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  1466. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  1467. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  1468. @item whole_len
  1469. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  1470. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  1471. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  1472. with @option{pad_len}.
  1473. @item pad_dur
  1474. Specify the duration of samples of silence to add. See
  1475. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1476. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value.
  1477. @item whole_dur
  1478. Specify the minimum total duration in the output audio stream. See
  1479. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1480. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value. If the value is longer than
  1481. the input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached.
  1482. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{pad_dur}
  1483. @end table
  1484. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} nor @option{pad_dur}
  1485. nor @option{whole_dur} option is set, the filter will add silence to the end of
  1486. the input stream indefinitely.
  1487. @subsection Examples
  1488. @itemize
  1489. @item
  1490. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  1491. @example
  1492. apad=pad_len=1024
  1493. @end example
  1494. @item
  1495. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1496. the input with silence if required:
  1497. @example
  1498. apad=whole_len=10000
  1499. @end example
  1500. @item
  1501. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1502. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1503. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1504. option:
  1505. @example
  1506. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1507. @end example
  1508. @end itemize
  1509. @section aphaser
  1510. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1511. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1512. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1513. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1514. @table @option
  1515. @item in_gain
  1516. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1517. @item out_gain
  1518. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1519. @item delay
  1520. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1521. @item decay
  1522. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1523. @item speed
  1524. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1525. @item type
  1526. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1527. It accepts the following values:
  1528. @table @samp
  1529. @item triangular, t
  1530. @item sinusoidal, s
  1531. @end table
  1532. @end table
  1533. @section apulsator
  1534. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1535. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1536. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1537. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1538. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1539. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1540. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1541. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1542. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1543. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1544. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1545. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1546. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1547. The filter accepts the following options:
  1548. @table @option
  1549. @item level_in
  1550. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1551. @item level_out
  1552. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1553. @item mode
  1554. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1555. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1556. @item amount
  1557. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1558. @item offset_l
  1559. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1560. @item offset_r
  1561. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1562. @item width
  1563. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1564. @item timing
  1565. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1566. @item bpm
  1567. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1568. is set to bpm.
  1569. @item ms
  1570. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1571. is set to ms.
  1572. @item hz
  1573. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1574. if timing is set to hz.
  1575. @end table
  1576. @anchor{aresample}
  1577. @section aresample
  1578. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1579. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1580. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1581. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1582. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1583. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1584. The filter accepts the syntax
  1585. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1586. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1587. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1588. @ref{Resampler Options,,"Resampler Options" section in the
  1589. ffmpeg-resampler(1) manual,ffmpeg-resampler}
  1590. for the complete list of supported options.
  1591. @subsection Examples
  1592. @itemize
  1593. @item
  1594. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1595. @example
  1596. aresample=44100
  1597. @end example
  1598. @item
  1599. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1600. samples per second compensation:
  1601. @example
  1602. aresample=async=1000
  1603. @end example
  1604. @end itemize
  1605. @section areverse
  1606. Reverse an audio clip.
  1607. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1608. is suggested.
  1609. @subsection Examples
  1610. @itemize
  1611. @item
  1612. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1613. @example
  1614. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1615. @end example
  1616. @end itemize
  1617. @section arnndn
  1618. Reduce noise from speech using Recurrent Neural Networks.
  1619. This filter accepts the following options:
  1620. @table @option
  1621. @item model, m
  1622. Set train model file to load. This option is always required.
  1623. @end table
  1624. @section asetnsamples
  1625. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1626. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1627. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1628. signals its end.
  1629. The filter accepts the following options:
  1630. @table @option
  1631. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1632. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1633. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1634. Default value is 1024.
  1635. @item pad, p
  1636. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1637. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1638. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1639. @end table
  1640. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1641. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1642. @example
  1643. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1644. @end example
  1645. @section asetrate
  1646. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1647. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1648. The filter accepts the following options:
  1649. @table @option
  1650. @item sample_rate, r
  1651. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1652. @end table
  1653. @section ashowinfo
  1654. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1655. The input audio is not modified.
  1656. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1657. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1658. The following values are shown in the output:
  1659. @table @option
  1660. @item n
  1661. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1662. @item pts
  1663. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1664. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1665. @item pts_time
  1666. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1667. @item pos
  1668. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1669. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1670. @item fmt
  1671. The sample format.
  1672. @item chlayout
  1673. The channel layout.
  1674. @item rate
  1675. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1676. @item nb_samples
  1677. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1678. @item checksum
  1679. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1680. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1681. @item plane_checksums
  1682. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1683. @end table
  1684. @section asoftclip
  1685. Apply audio soft clipping.
  1686. Soft clipping is a type of distortion effect where the amplitude of a signal is saturated
  1687. along a smooth curve, rather than the abrupt shape of hard-clipping.
  1688. This filter accepts the following options:
  1689. @table @option
  1690. @item type
  1691. Set type of soft-clipping.
  1692. It accepts the following values:
  1693. @table @option
  1694. @item tanh
  1695. @item atan
  1696. @item cubic
  1697. @item exp
  1698. @item alg
  1699. @item quintic
  1700. @item sin
  1701. @end table
  1702. @item param
  1703. Set additional parameter which controls sigmoid function.
  1704. @end table
  1705. @section asr
  1706. Automatic Speech Recognition
  1707. This filter uses PocketSphinx for speech recognition. To enable
  1708. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  1709. @code{--enable-pocketsphinx}.
  1710. It accepts the following options:
  1711. @table @option
  1712. @item rate
  1713. Set sampling rate of input audio. Defaults is @code{16000}.
  1714. This need to match speech models, otherwise one will get poor results.
  1715. @item hmm
  1716. Set dictionary containing acoustic model files.
  1717. @item dict
  1718. Set pronunciation dictionary.
  1719. @item lm
  1720. Set language model file.
  1721. @item lmctl
  1722. Set language model set.
  1723. @item lmname
  1724. Set which language model to use.
  1725. @item logfn
  1726. Set output for log messages.
  1727. @end table
  1728. The filter exports recognized speech as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.asr.text}.
  1729. @anchor{astats}
  1730. @section astats
  1731. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1732. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1733. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1734. It accepts the following option:
  1735. @table @option
  1736. @item length
  1737. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1738. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 10]}.
  1739. @item metadata
  1740. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1741. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1742. disabled.
  1743. Available keys for each channel are:
  1744. DC_offset
  1745. Min_level
  1746. Max_level
  1747. Min_difference
  1748. Max_difference
  1749. Mean_difference
  1750. RMS_difference
  1751. Peak_level
  1752. RMS_peak
  1753. RMS_trough
  1754. Crest_factor
  1755. Flat_factor
  1756. Peak_count
  1757. Bit_depth
  1758. Dynamic_range
  1759. Zero_crossings
  1760. Zero_crossings_rate
  1761. Number_of_NaNs
  1762. Number_of_Infs
  1763. Number_of_denormals
  1764. and for Overall:
  1765. DC_offset
  1766. Min_level
  1767. Max_level
  1768. Min_difference
  1769. Max_difference
  1770. Mean_difference
  1771. RMS_difference
  1772. Peak_level
  1773. RMS_level
  1774. RMS_peak
  1775. RMS_trough
  1776. Flat_factor
  1777. Peak_count
  1778. Bit_depth
  1779. Number_of_samples
  1780. Number_of_NaNs
  1781. Number_of_Infs
  1782. Number_of_denormals
  1783. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1784. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1785. For description what each key means read below.
  1786. @item reset
  1787. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1788. Default is disabled.
  1789. @item measure_perchannel
  1790. Select the entries which need to be measured per channel. The metadata keys can
  1791. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1792. @option{none} disables all per channel measurement.
  1793. @item measure_overall
  1794. Select the entries which need to be measured overall. The metadata keys can
  1795. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1796. @option{none} disables all overall measurement.
  1797. @end table
  1798. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1799. @table @option
  1800. @item DC offset
  1801. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1802. @item Min level
  1803. Minimal sample level.
  1804. @item Max level
  1805. Maximal sample level.
  1806. @item Min difference
  1807. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1808. @item Max difference
  1809. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1810. @item Mean difference
  1811. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1812. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1813. @item RMS difference
  1814. Root Mean Square difference between two consecutive samples.
  1815. @item Peak level dB
  1816. @item RMS level dB
  1817. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1818. @item RMS peak dB
  1819. @item RMS trough dB
  1820. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1821. @item Crest factor
  1822. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1823. @item Flat factor
  1824. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1825. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1826. @item Peak count
  1827. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1828. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1829. @item Bit depth
  1830. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1831. @item Dynamic range
  1832. Measured dynamic range of audio in dB.
  1833. @item Zero crossings
  1834. Number of points where the waveform crosses the zero level axis.
  1835. @item Zero crossings rate
  1836. Rate of Zero crossings and number of audio samples.
  1837. @end table
  1838. @section atempo
  1839. Adjust audio tempo.
  1840. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1841. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1842. be in the [0.5, 100.0] range.
  1843. Note that tempo greater than 2 will skip some samples rather than
  1844. blend them in. If for any reason this is a concern it is always
  1845. possible to daisy-chain several instances of atempo to achieve the
  1846. desired product tempo.
  1847. @subsection Examples
  1848. @itemize
  1849. @item
  1850. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1851. @example
  1852. atempo=0.8
  1853. @end example
  1854. @item
  1855. To speed up audio to 300% tempo:
  1856. @example
  1857. atempo=3
  1858. @end example
  1859. @item
  1860. To speed up audio to 300% tempo by daisy-chaining two atempo instances:
  1861. @example
  1862. atempo=sqrt(3),atempo=sqrt(3)
  1863. @end example
  1864. @end itemize
  1865. @subsection Commands
  1866. This filter supports the following commands:
  1867. @table @option
  1868. @item tempo
  1869. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  1870. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  1871. @end table
  1872. @section atrim
  1873. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1874. It accepts the following parameters:
  1875. @table @option
  1876. @item start
  1877. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1878. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1879. @item end
  1880. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1881. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1882. the last sample in the output.
  1883. @item start_pts
  1884. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1885. instead of seconds.
  1886. @item end_pts
  1887. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1888. of seconds.
  1889. @item duration
  1890. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1891. @item start_sample
  1892. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1893. @item end_sample
  1894. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1895. @end table
  1896. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1897. duration specifications; see
  1898. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1899. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1900. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1901. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1902. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1903. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1904. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1905. atrim filter.
  1906. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1907. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1908. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1909. filters.
  1910. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1911. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1912. Examples:
  1913. @itemize
  1914. @item
  1915. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1916. @example
  1917. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1918. @end example
  1919. @item
  1920. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1921. @example
  1922. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1923. @end example
  1924. @end itemize
  1925. @section bandpass
  1926. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  1927. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  1928. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  1929. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  1930. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1931. The filter accepts the following options:
  1932. @table @option
  1933. @item frequency, f
  1934. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1935. @item csg
  1936. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  1937. @item width_type, t
  1938. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1939. @table @option
  1940. @item h
  1941. Hz
  1942. @item q
  1943. Q-Factor
  1944. @item o
  1945. octave
  1946. @item s
  1947. slope
  1948. @item k
  1949. kHz
  1950. @end table
  1951. @item width, w
  1952. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1953. @item mix, m
  1954. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1955. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1956. @item channels, c
  1957. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1958. @end table
  1959. @subsection Commands
  1960. This filter supports the following commands:
  1961. @table @option
  1962. @item frequency, f
  1963. Change bandpass frequency.
  1964. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1965. @item width_type, t
  1966. Change bandpass width_type.
  1967. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1968. @item width, w
  1969. Change bandpass width.
  1970. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1971. @item mix, m
  1972. Change bandpass mix.
  1973. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1974. @end table
  1975. @section bandreject
  1976. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  1977. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  1978. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1979. The filter accepts the following options:
  1980. @table @option
  1981. @item frequency, f
  1982. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1983. @item width_type, t
  1984. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1985. @table @option
  1986. @item h
  1987. Hz
  1988. @item q
  1989. Q-Factor
  1990. @item o
  1991. octave
  1992. @item s
  1993. slope
  1994. @item k
  1995. kHz
  1996. @end table
  1997. @item width, w
  1998. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1999. @item mix, m
  2000. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2001. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2002. @item channels, c
  2003. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2004. @end table
  2005. @subsection Commands
  2006. This filter supports the following commands:
  2007. @table @option
  2008. @item frequency, f
  2009. Change bandreject frequency.
  2010. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2011. @item width_type, t
  2012. Change bandreject width_type.
  2013. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2014. @item width, w
  2015. Change bandreject width.
  2016. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2017. @item mix, m
  2018. Change bandreject mix.
  2019. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2020. @end table
  2021. @section bass, lowshelf
  2022. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2023. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2024. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2025. The filter accepts the following options:
  2026. @table @option
  2027. @item gain, g
  2028. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  2029. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  2030. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2031. @item frequency, f
  2032. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2033. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2034. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  2035. @item width_type, t
  2036. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2037. @table @option
  2038. @item h
  2039. Hz
  2040. @item q
  2041. Q-Factor
  2042. @item o
  2043. octave
  2044. @item s
  2045. slope
  2046. @item k
  2047. kHz
  2048. @end table
  2049. @item width, w
  2050. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2051. @item mix, m
  2052. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2053. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2054. @item channels, c
  2055. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2056. @end table
  2057. @subsection Commands
  2058. This filter supports the following commands:
  2059. @table @option
  2060. @item frequency, f
  2061. Change bass frequency.
  2062. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2063. @item width_type, t
  2064. Change bass width_type.
  2065. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2066. @item width, w
  2067. Change bass width.
  2068. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2069. @item gain, g
  2070. Change bass gain.
  2071. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2072. @item mix, m
  2073. Change bass mix.
  2074. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2075. @end table
  2076. @section biquad
  2077. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  2078. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  2079. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  2080. and @var{channels}, @var{c} specify which channels to filter, by default all
  2081. available are filtered.
  2082. @subsection Commands
  2083. This filter supports the following commands:
  2084. @table @option
  2085. @item a0
  2086. @item a1
  2087. @item a2
  2088. @item b0
  2089. @item b1
  2090. @item b2
  2091. Change biquad parameter.
  2092. Syntax for the command is : "@var{value}"
  2093. @item mix, m
  2094. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2095. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2096. @end table
  2097. @section bs2b
  2098. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  2099. stereo audio records.
  2100. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2101. @code{--enable-libbs2b}.
  2102. It accepts the following parameters:
  2103. @table @option
  2104. @item profile
  2105. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  2106. @table @option
  2107. @item default
  2108. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  2109. @item cmoy
  2110. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  2111. @item jmeier
  2112. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  2113. @end table
  2114. @item fcut
  2115. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  2116. @item feed
  2117. Feed level (in Hz).
  2118. @end table
  2119. @section channelmap
  2120. Remap input channels to new locations.
  2121. It accepts the following parameters:
  2122. @table @option
  2123. @item map
  2124. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2125. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  2126. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  2127. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  2128. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  2129. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  2130. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  2131. @item channel_layout
  2132. The channel layout of the output stream.
  2133. @end table
  2134. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  2135. output channels, preserving indices.
  2136. @subsection Examples
  2137. @itemize
  2138. @item
  2139. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  2140. @example
  2141. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  2142. @end example
  2143. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  2144. the input.
  2145. @item
  2146. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  2147. @example
  2148. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  2149. @end example
  2150. @end itemize
  2151. @section channelsplit
  2152. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  2153. It accepts the following parameters:
  2154. @table @option
  2155. @item channel_layout
  2156. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  2157. @item channels
  2158. A channel layout describing the channels to be extracted as separate output streams
  2159. or "all" to extract each input channel as a separate stream. The default is "all".
  2160. Choosing channels not present in channel layout in the input will result in an error.
  2161. @end table
  2162. @subsection Examples
  2163. @itemize
  2164. @item
  2165. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  2166. @example
  2167. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  2168. @end example
  2169. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  2170. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  2171. @item
  2172. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  2173. @example
  2174. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  2175. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  2176. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  2177. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  2178. side_right.wav
  2179. @end example
  2180. @item
  2181. Extract only LFE from a 5.1 WAV file:
  2182. @example
  2183. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1:channels=LFE[LFE]'
  2184. -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav
  2185. @end example
  2186. @end itemize
  2187. @section chorus
  2188. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  2189. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  2190. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  2191. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  2192. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  2193. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  2194. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  2195. off key.
  2196. It accepts the following parameters:
  2197. @table @option
  2198. @item in_gain
  2199. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  2200. @item out_gain
  2201. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  2202. @item delays
  2203. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  2204. @item decays
  2205. Set decays.
  2206. @item speeds
  2207. Set speeds.
  2208. @item depths
  2209. Set depths.
  2210. @end table
  2211. @subsection Examples
  2212. @itemize
  2213. @item
  2214. A single delay:
  2215. @example
  2216. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  2217. @end example
  2218. @item
  2219. Two delays:
  2220. @example
  2221. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  2222. @end example
  2223. @item
  2224. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  2225. @example
  2226. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  2227. @end example
  2228. @end itemize
  2229. @section compand
  2230. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  2231. It accepts the following parameters:
  2232. @table @option
  2233. @item attacks
  2234. @item decays
  2235. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  2236. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  2237. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  2238. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  2239. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  2240. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  2241. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  2242. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  2243. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  2244. @item points
  2245. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  2246. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  2247. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  2248. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  2249. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  2250. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  2251. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  2252. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20|1/0}.
  2253. @item soft-knee
  2254. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  2255. @item gain
  2256. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  2257. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  2258. It defaults to 0.
  2259. @item volume
  2260. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  2261. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  2262. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  2263. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  2264. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  2265. @item delay
  2266. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  2267. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  2268. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  2269. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  2270. @end table
  2271. @subsection Examples
  2272. @itemize
  2273. @item
  2274. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  2275. noisy environment:
  2276. @example
  2277. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  2278. @end example
  2279. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  2280. @example
  2281. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  2282. @end example
  2283. @item
  2284. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  2285. @example
  2286. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  2287. @end example
  2288. @item
  2289. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  2290. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  2291. @example
  2292. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  2293. @end example
  2294. @item
  2295. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  2296. @example
  2297. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  2298. @end example
  2299. @item
  2300. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  2301. @example
  2302. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  2303. @end example
  2304. @item
  2305. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  2306. @example
  2307. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  2308. @end example
  2309. @item
  2310. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  2311. @example
  2312. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  2313. @end example
  2314. @item
  2315. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  2316. @example
  2317. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  2318. @end example
  2319. @item
  2320. Compressor/Gate:
  2321. @example
  2322. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  2323. @end example
  2324. @item
  2325. Expander:
  2326. @example
  2327. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  2328. @end example
  2329. @item
  2330. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  2331. @example
  2332. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  2333. @end example
  2334. @item
  2335. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  2336. @example
  2337. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  2338. @end example
  2339. @item
  2340. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  2341. @example
  2342. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  2343. @end example
  2344. @item
  2345. Soft limiter:
  2346. @example
  2347. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  2348. @end example
  2349. @end itemize
  2350. @section compensationdelay
  2351. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  2352. positions of microphones or speakers.
  2353. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  2354. different locations. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  2355. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  2356. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  2357. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that a distance of
  2358. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone capture the signal in
  2359. antiphase to the other microphone. That makes the final mix sound moody.
  2360. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  2361. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  2362. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  2363. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  2364. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  2365. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  2366. The filter accepts the following parameters:
  2367. @table @option
  2368. @item mm
  2369. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  2370. Default is 0.
  2371. @item cm
  2372. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  2373. Default is 0.
  2374. @item m
  2375. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  2376. Default is 0.
  2377. @item dry
  2378. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  2379. Default is 0.
  2380. @item wet
  2381. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  2382. Default is 1.
  2383. @item temp
  2384. Set temperature in degrees Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  2385. Default is 20.
  2386. @end table
  2387. @section crossfeed
  2388. Apply headphone crossfeed filter.
  2389. Crossfeed is the process of blending the left and right channels of stereo
  2390. audio recording.
  2391. It is mainly used to reduce extreme stereo separation of low frequencies.
  2392. The intent is to produce more speaker like sound to the listener.
  2393. The filter accepts the following options:
  2394. @table @option
  2395. @item strength
  2396. Set strength of crossfeed. Default is 0.2. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2397. This sets gain of low shelf filter for side part of stereo image.
  2398. Default is -6dB. Max allowed is -30db when strength is set to 1.
  2399. @item range
  2400. Set soundstage wideness. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2401. This sets cut off frequency of low shelf filter. Default is cut off near
  2402. 1550 Hz. With range set to 1 cut off frequency is set to 2100 Hz.
  2403. @item level_in
  2404. Set input gain. Default is 0.9.
  2405. @item level_out
  2406. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  2407. @end table
  2408. @section crystalizer
  2409. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  2410. The filter accepts the following options:
  2411. @table @option
  2412. @item i
  2413. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  2414. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  2415. @item c
  2416. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2417. @end table
  2418. @section dcshift
  2419. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  2420. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  2421. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  2422. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  2423. a signal has a DC offset.
  2424. @table @option
  2425. @item shift
  2426. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  2427. the audio.
  2428. @item limitergain
  2429. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  2430. used to prevent clipping.
  2431. @end table
  2432. @section deesser
  2433. Apply de-essing to the audio samples.
  2434. @table @option
  2435. @item i
  2436. Set intensity for triggering de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2437. Default is 0.
  2438. @item m
  2439. Set amount of ducking on treble part of sound. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2440. Default is 0.5.
  2441. @item f
  2442. How much of original frequency content to keep when de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2443. Default is 0.5.
  2444. @item s
  2445. Set the output mode.
  2446. It accepts the following values:
  2447. @table @option
  2448. @item i
  2449. Pass input unchanged.
  2450. @item o
  2451. Pass ess filtered out.
  2452. @item e
  2453. Pass only ess.
  2454. Default value is @var{o}.
  2455. @end table
  2456. @end table
  2457. @section drmeter
  2458. Measure audio dynamic range.
  2459. DR values of 14 and higher is found in very dynamic material. DR of 8 to 13
  2460. is found in transition material. And anything less that 8 have very poor dynamics
  2461. and is very compressed.
  2462. The filter accepts the following options:
  2463. @table @option
  2464. @item length
  2465. Set window length in seconds used to split audio into segments of equal length.
  2466. Default is 3 seconds.
  2467. @end table
  2468. @section dynaudnorm
  2469. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  2470. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  2471. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  2472. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  2473. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  2474. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  2475. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  2476. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  2477. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  2478. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  2479. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  2480. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  2481. @table @option
  2482. @item framelen, f
  2483. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  2484. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  2485. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  2486. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  2487. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  2488. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  2489. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  2490. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  2491. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  2492. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  2493. been found to give good results with most files.
  2494. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  2495. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  2496. @item gausssize, g
  2497. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  2498. number. Default is 31.
  2499. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  2500. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  2501. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  2502. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  2503. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  2504. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  2505. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  2506. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  2507. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  2508. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2509. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  2510. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2511. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  2512. @item peak, p
  2513. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  2514. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  2515. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  2516. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  2517. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  2518. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  2519. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  2520. @item maxgain, m
  2521. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  2522. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  2523. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  2524. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  2525. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  2526. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  2527. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  2528. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  2529. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  2530. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  2531. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  2532. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  2533. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  2534. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  2535. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  2536. value.
  2537. @item targetrms, r
  2538. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  2539. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  2540. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  2541. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  2542. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  2543. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  2544. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  2545. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  2546. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  2547. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  2548. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  2549. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  2550. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  2551. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  2552. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  2553. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  2554. @item coupling, n
  2555. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  2556. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  2557. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  2558. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  2559. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  2560. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  2561. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  2562. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  2563. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  2564. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  2565. @item correctdc, c
  2566. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  2567. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  2568. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  2569. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  2570. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  2571. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  2572. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  2573. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  2574. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  2575. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  2576. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  2577. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  2578. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  2579. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  2580. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  2581. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  2582. between neighbouring frames.
  2583. @item altboundary, b
  2584. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  2585. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  2586. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  2587. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  2588. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  2589. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  2590. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  2591. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  2592. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  2593. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  2594. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  2595. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  2596. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  2597. @item compress, s
  2598. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  2599. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  2600. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  2601. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  2602. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  2603. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  2604. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  2605. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  2606. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  2607. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  2608. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  2609. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  2610. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  2611. frame.
  2612. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  2613. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  2614. @end table
  2615. @section earwax
  2616. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  2617. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  2618. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  2619. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  2620. the listener (standard for speakers).
  2621. Ported from SoX.
  2622. @section equalizer
  2623. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  2624. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  2625. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  2626. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  2627. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  2628. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  2629. The filter accepts the following options:
  2630. @table @option
  2631. @item frequency, f
  2632. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  2633. @item width_type, t
  2634. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2635. @table @option
  2636. @item h
  2637. Hz
  2638. @item q
  2639. Q-Factor
  2640. @item o
  2641. octave
  2642. @item s
  2643. slope
  2644. @item k
  2645. kHz
  2646. @end table
  2647. @item width, w
  2648. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2649. @item gain, g
  2650. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  2651. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2652. @item mix, m
  2653. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2654. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2655. @item channels, c
  2656. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2657. @end table
  2658. @subsection Examples
  2659. @itemize
  2660. @item
  2661. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  2662. @example
  2663. equalizer=f=1000:t=h:width=200:g=-10
  2664. @end example
  2665. @item
  2666. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  2667. @example
  2668. equalizer=f=1000:t=q:w=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:t=q:w=2:g=-5
  2669. @end example
  2670. @end itemize
  2671. @subsection Commands
  2672. This filter supports the following commands:
  2673. @table @option
  2674. @item frequency, f
  2675. Change equalizer frequency.
  2676. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2677. @item width_type, t
  2678. Change equalizer width_type.
  2679. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2680. @item width, w
  2681. Change equalizer width.
  2682. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2683. @item gain, g
  2684. Change equalizer gain.
  2685. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2686. @item mix, m
  2687. Change equalizer mix.
  2688. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2689. @end table
  2690. @section extrastereo
  2691. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  2692. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  2693. The filter accepts the following options:
  2694. @table @option
  2695. @item m
  2696. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  2697. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  2698. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  2699. @item c
  2700. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2701. @end table
  2702. @section firequalizer
  2703. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  2704. The filter accepts the following option:
  2705. @table @option
  2706. @item gain
  2707. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  2708. @table @option
  2709. @item f
  2710. the evaluated frequency
  2711. @item sr
  2712. sample rate
  2713. @item ch
  2714. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2715. @item chid
  2716. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  2717. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2718. @item chs
  2719. number of channels
  2720. @item chlayout
  2721. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  2722. @end table
  2723. and functions:
  2724. @table @option
  2725. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  2726. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  2727. @item cubic_interpolate(f)
  2728. same as gain_interpolate, but smoother
  2729. @end table
  2730. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  2731. @item gain_entry
  2732. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  2733. contain functions:
  2734. @table @option
  2735. @item entry(f, g)
  2736. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  2737. @end table
  2738. This option is also available as command.
  2739. @item delay
  2740. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  2741. Default is @code{0.01}.
  2742. @item accuracy
  2743. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  2744. Default is @code{5}.
  2745. @item wfunc
  2746. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  2747. @table @option
  2748. @item rectangular
  2749. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  2750. @item hann
  2751. hann window (default)
  2752. @item hamming
  2753. hamming window
  2754. @item blackman
  2755. blackman window
  2756. @item nuttall3
  2757. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2758. @item mnuttall3
  2759. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  2760. @item nuttall
  2761. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2762. @item bnuttall
  2763. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2764. @item bharris
  2765. blackman-harris window
  2766. @item tukey
  2767. tukey window
  2768. @end table
  2769. @item fixed
  2770. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2771. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2772. @item multi
  2773. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2774. @item zero_phase
  2775. Enable zero phase mode by subtracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2776. Default is disabled.
  2777. @item scale
  2778. Set scale used by gain. Acceptable values are:
  2779. @table @option
  2780. @item linlin
  2781. linear frequency, linear gain
  2782. @item linlog
  2783. linear frequency, logarithmic (in dB) gain (default)
  2784. @item loglin
  2785. logarithmic (in octave scale where 20 Hz is 0) frequency, linear gain
  2786. @item loglog
  2787. logarithmic frequency, logarithmic gain
  2788. @end table
  2789. @item dumpfile
  2790. Set file for dumping, suitable for gnuplot.
  2791. @item dumpscale
  2792. Set scale for dumpfile. Acceptable values are same with scale option.
  2793. Default is linlog.
  2794. @item fft2
  2795. Enable 2-channel convolution using complex FFT. This improves speed significantly.
  2796. Default is disabled.
  2797. @item min_phase
  2798. Enable minimum phase impulse response. Default is disabled.
  2799. @end table
  2800. @subsection Examples
  2801. @itemize
  2802. @item
  2803. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2804. @example
  2805. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2806. @end example
  2807. @item
  2808. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2809. @example
  2810. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2811. @end example
  2812. @item
  2813. custom equalization:
  2814. @example
  2815. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2816. @end example
  2817. @item
  2818. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2819. @example
  2820. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2821. @end example
  2822. @item
  2823. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2824. @example
  2825. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2826. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2827. @end example
  2828. @end itemize
  2829. @section flanger
  2830. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2831. The filter accepts the following options:
  2832. @table @option
  2833. @item delay
  2834. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2835. @item depth
  2836. Set added sweep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2837. @item regen
  2838. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2839. Default value is 0.
  2840. @item width
  2841. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2842. Default value is 71.
  2843. @item speed
  2844. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2845. @item shape
  2846. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2847. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2848. @item phase
  2849. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2850. Default value is 25.
  2851. @item interp
  2852. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2853. Default is @var{linear}.
  2854. @end table
  2855. @section haas
  2856. Apply Haas effect to audio.
  2857. Note that this makes most sense to apply on mono signals.
  2858. With this filter applied to mono signals it give some directionality and
  2859. stretches its stereo image.
  2860. The filter accepts the following options:
  2861. @table @option
  2862. @item level_in
  2863. Set input level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB
  2864. @item level_out
  2865. Set output level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB.
  2866. @item side_gain
  2867. Set gain applied to side part of signal. By default is @var{1}.
  2868. @item middle_source
  2869. Set kind of middle source. Can be one of the following:
  2870. @table @samp
  2871. @item left
  2872. Pick left channel.
  2873. @item right
  2874. Pick right channel.
  2875. @item mid
  2876. Pick middle part signal of stereo image.
  2877. @item side
  2878. Pick side part signal of stereo image.
  2879. @end table
  2880. @item middle_phase
  2881. Change middle phase. By default is disabled.
  2882. @item left_delay
  2883. Set left channel delay. By default is @var{2.05} milliseconds.
  2884. @item left_balance
  2885. Set left channel balance. By default is @var{-1}.
  2886. @item left_gain
  2887. Set left channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2888. @item left_phase
  2889. Change left phase. By default is disabled.
  2890. @item right_delay
  2891. Set right channel delay. By defaults is @var{2.12} milliseconds.
  2892. @item right_balance
  2893. Set right channel balance. By default is @var{1}.
  2894. @item right_gain
  2895. Set right channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2896. @item right_phase
  2897. Change right phase. By default is enabled.
  2898. @end table
  2899. @section hdcd
  2900. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  2901. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  2902. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  2903. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  2904. @example
  2905. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  2906. @end example
  2907. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  2908. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  2909. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  2910. @example
  2911. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  2912. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -c:a pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  2913. @end example
  2914. The filter accepts the following options:
  2915. @table @option
  2916. @item disable_autoconvert
  2917. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  2918. @item process_stereo
  2919. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  2920. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  2921. @item cdt_ms
  2922. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  2923. @item force_pe
  2924. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  2925. @item analyze_mode
  2926. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  2927. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  2928. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  2929. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  2930. Modes are:
  2931. @table @samp
  2932. @item 0, off
  2933. Disabled
  2934. @item 1, lle
  2935. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  2936. @item 2, pe
  2937. Samples where peak extend occurs
  2938. @item 3, cdt
  2939. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  2940. @item 4, tgm
  2941. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  2942. @end table
  2943. @end table
  2944. @section headphone
  2945. Apply head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  2946. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones.
  2947. The HRIRs are provided via additional streams, for each channel
  2948. one stereo input stream is needed.
  2949. The filter accepts the following options:
  2950. @table @option
  2951. @item map
  2952. Set mapping of input streams for convolution.
  2953. The argument is a '|'-separated list of channel names in order as they
  2954. are given as additional stream inputs for filter.
  2955. This also specify number of input streams. Number of input streams
  2956. must be not less than number of channels in first stream plus one.
  2957. @item gain
  2958. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  2959. @item type
  2960. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  2961. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  2962. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  2963. Default is @var{freq}.
  2964. @item lfe
  2965. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  2966. @item size
  2967. Set size of frame in number of samples which will be processed at once.
  2968. Default value is @var{1024}. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.
  2969. @item hrir
  2970. Set format of hrir stream.
  2971. Default value is @var{stereo}. Alternative value is @var{multich}.
  2972. If value is set to @var{stereo}, number of additional streams should
  2973. be greater or equal to number of input channels in first input stream.
  2974. Also each additional stream should have stereo number of channels.
  2975. If value is set to @var{multich}, number of additional streams should
  2976. be exactly one. Also number of input channels of additional stream
  2977. should be equal or greater than twice number of channels of first input
  2978. stream.
  2979. @end table
  2980. @subsection Examples
  2981. @itemize
  2982. @item
  2983. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  2984. each amovie filter use stereo file with IR coefficients as input.
  2985. The files give coefficients for each position of virtual loudspeaker:
  2986. @example
  2987. ffmpeg -i input.wav
  2988. -filter_complex "amovie=azi_270_ele_0_DFC.wav[sr];amovie=azi_90_ele_0_DFC.wav[sl];amovie=azi_225_ele_0_DFC.wav[br];amovie=azi_135_ele_0_DFC.wav[bl];amovie=azi_0_ele_0_DFC.wav,asplit[fc][lfe];amovie=azi_35_ele_0_DFC.wav[fl];amovie=azi_325_ele_0_DFC.wav[fr];[0:a][fl][fr][fc][lfe][bl][br][sl][sr]headphone=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR"
  2989. output.wav
  2990. @end example
  2991. @item
  2992. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  2993. but now in @var{multich} @var{hrir} format.
  2994. @example
  2995. ffmpeg -i input.wav -filter_complex "amovie=minp.wav[hrirs];[0:a][hrirs]headphone=map=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR:hrir=multich"
  2996. output.wav
  2997. @end example
  2998. @end itemize
  2999. @section highpass
  3000. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3001. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  3002. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3003. The filter accepts the following options:
  3004. @table @option
  3005. @item frequency, f
  3006. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  3007. @item poles, p
  3008. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3009. @item width_type, t
  3010. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3011. @table @option
  3012. @item h
  3013. Hz
  3014. @item q
  3015. Q-Factor
  3016. @item o
  3017. octave
  3018. @item s
  3019. slope
  3020. @item k
  3021. kHz
  3022. @end table
  3023. @item width, w
  3024. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3025. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3026. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3027. @item mix, m
  3028. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3029. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3030. @item channels, c
  3031. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3032. @end table
  3033. @subsection Commands
  3034. This filter supports the following commands:
  3035. @table @option
  3036. @item frequency, f
  3037. Change highpass frequency.
  3038. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3039. @item width_type, t
  3040. Change highpass width_type.
  3041. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3042. @item width, w
  3043. Change highpass width.
  3044. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3045. @item mix, m
  3046. Change highpass mix.
  3047. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3048. @end table
  3049. @section join
  3050. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  3051. It accepts the following parameters:
  3052. @table @option
  3053. @item inputs
  3054. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  3055. @item channel_layout
  3056. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  3057. @item map
  3058. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  3059. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  3060. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  3061. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  3062. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  3063. channel.
  3064. @end table
  3065. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  3066. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  3067. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  3068. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  3069. @example
  3070. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  3071. @end example
  3072. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  3073. @example
  3074. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  3075. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  3076. out
  3077. @end example
  3078. @section ladspa
  3079. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  3080. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3081. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  3082. @table @option
  3083. @item file, f
  3084. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  3085. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  3086. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  3087. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  3088. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  3089. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  3090. @item plugin, p
  3091. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  3092. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  3093. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  3094. @item controls, c
  3095. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3096. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3097. threshold or gain).
  3098. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  3099. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  3100. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3101. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  3102. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  3103. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3104. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3105. their valid ranges are printed.
  3106. @item sample_rate, s
  3107. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3108. zero inputs.
  3109. @item nb_samples, n
  3110. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3111. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3112. @item duration, d
  3113. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3114. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3115. for the accepted syntax.
  3116. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3117. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3118. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3119. supposed to be generated forever.
  3120. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3121. @end table
  3122. @subsection Examples
  3123. @itemize
  3124. @item
  3125. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  3126. @example
  3127. ladspa=file=amp
  3128. @end example
  3129. @item
  3130. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  3131. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  3132. @example
  3133. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  3134. @end example
  3135. @item
  3136. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  3137. plugin library:
  3138. @example
  3139. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  3140. @end example
  3141. @item
  3142. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  3143. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  3144. @example
  3145. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  3146. @end example
  3147. @item
  3148. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  3149. @example
  3150. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  3151. @end example
  3152. @item
  3153. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  3154. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3155. @example
  3156. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  3157. @end example
  3158. @item
  3159. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  3160. @example
  3161. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  3162. @end example
  3163. @item
  3164. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  3165. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3166. @example
  3167. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  3168. @end example
  3169. @item
  3170. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  3171. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3172. @example
  3173. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  3174. @end example
  3175. @item
  3176. Reduce stereo image using @code{Narrower} from the @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite}
  3177. (CAPS) library:
  3178. @example
  3179. ladspa=caps:Narrower
  3180. @end example
  3181. @item
  3182. Another white noise, now using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3183. @example
  3184. ladspa=caps:White:.2
  3185. @end example
  3186. @item
  3187. Some fractal noise, using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3188. @example
  3189. ladspa=caps:Fractal:c=c1=1
  3190. @end example
  3191. @item
  3192. Dynamic volume normalization using @code{VLevel} plugin:
  3193. @example
  3194. ladspa=vlevel-ladspa:vlevel_mono
  3195. @end example
  3196. @end itemize
  3197. @subsection Commands
  3198. This filter supports the following commands:
  3199. @table @option
  3200. @item cN
  3201. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  3202. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  3203. @end table
  3204. @section loudnorm
  3205. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  3206. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  3207. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak. To accurately detect true peaks,
  3208. the audio stream will be upsampled to 192 kHz unless the normalization mode is linear.
  3209. Use the @code{-ar} option or @code{aresample} filter to explicitly set an output sample rate.
  3210. The filter accepts the following options:
  3211. @table @option
  3212. @item I, i
  3213. Set integrated loudness target.
  3214. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  3215. @item LRA, lra
  3216. Set loudness range target.
  3217. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  3218. @item TP, tp
  3219. Set maximum true peak.
  3220. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  3221. @item measured_I, measured_i
  3222. Measured IL of input file.
  3223. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3224. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  3225. Measured LRA of input file.
  3226. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  3227. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  3228. Measured true peak of input file.
  3229. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  3230. @item measured_thresh
  3231. Measured threshold of input file.
  3232. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3233. @item offset
  3234. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  3235. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  3236. @item linear
  3237. Normalize linearly if possible.
  3238. measured_I, measured_LRA, measured_TP, and measured_thresh must also
  3239. to be specified in order to use this mode.
  3240. Options are true or false. Default is true.
  3241. @item dual_mono
  3242. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  3243. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  3244. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  3245. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  3246. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  3247. @item print_format
  3248. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  3249. Default value is none.
  3250. @end table
  3251. @section lowpass
  3252. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3253. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  3254. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3255. The filter accepts the following options:
  3256. @table @option
  3257. @item frequency, f
  3258. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  3259. @item poles, p
  3260. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3261. @item width_type, t
  3262. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3263. @table @option
  3264. @item h
  3265. Hz
  3266. @item q
  3267. Q-Factor
  3268. @item o
  3269. octave
  3270. @item s
  3271. slope
  3272. @item k
  3273. kHz
  3274. @end table
  3275. @item width, w
  3276. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3277. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3278. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3279. @item mix, m
  3280. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3281. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3282. @item channels, c
  3283. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3284. @end table
  3285. @subsection Examples
  3286. @itemize
  3287. @item
  3288. Lowpass only LFE channel, it LFE is not present it does nothing:
  3289. @example
  3290. lowpass=c=LFE
  3291. @end example
  3292. @end itemize
  3293. @subsection Commands
  3294. This filter supports the following commands:
  3295. @table @option
  3296. @item frequency, f
  3297. Change lowpass frequency.
  3298. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3299. @item width_type, t
  3300. Change lowpass width_type.
  3301. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3302. @item width, w
  3303. Change lowpass width.
  3304. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3305. @item mix, m
  3306. Change lowpass mix.
  3307. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3308. @end table
  3309. @section lv2
  3310. Load a LV2 (LADSPA Version 2) plugin.
  3311. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3312. @code{--enable-lv2}.
  3313. @table @option
  3314. @item plugin, p
  3315. Specifies the plugin URI. You may need to escape ':'.
  3316. @item controls, c
  3317. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3318. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3319. threshold or gain).
  3320. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3321. their valid ranges are printed.
  3322. @item sample_rate, s
  3323. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3324. zero inputs.
  3325. @item nb_samples, n
  3326. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3327. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3328. @item duration, d
  3329. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3330. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3331. for the accepted syntax.
  3332. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3333. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3334. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3335. supposed to be generated forever.
  3336. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3337. @end table
  3338. @subsection Examples
  3339. @itemize
  3340. @item
  3341. Apply bass enhancer plugin from Calf:
  3342. @example
  3343. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/BassEnhancer:c=amount=2
  3344. @end example
  3345. @item
  3346. Apply vinyl plugin from Calf:
  3347. @example
  3348. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/Vinyl:c=drone=0.2|aging=0.5
  3349. @end example
  3350. @item
  3351. Apply bit crusher plugin from ArtyFX:
  3352. @example
  3353. lv2=p=http\\\\://www.openavproductions.com/artyfx#bitta:c=crush=0.3
  3354. @end example
  3355. @end itemize
  3356. @section mcompand
  3357. Multiband Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  3358. The input audio is divided into bands using 4th order Linkwitz-Riley IIRs.
  3359. This is akin to the crossover of a loudspeaker, and results in flat frequency
  3360. response when absent compander action.
  3361. It accepts the following parameters:
  3362. @table @option
  3363. @item args
  3364. This option syntax is:
  3365. attack,decay,[attack,decay..] soft-knee points crossover_frequency [delay [initial_volume [gain]]] | attack,decay ...
  3366. For explanation of each item refer to compand filter documentation.
  3367. @end table
  3368. @anchor{pan}
  3369. @section pan
  3370. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  3371. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  3372. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  3373. stream.
  3374. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  3375. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  3376. @table @option
  3377. @item l
  3378. output channel layout or number of channels
  3379. @item outdef
  3380. output channel specification, of the form:
  3381. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[(+-)[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  3382. @item out_name
  3383. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  3384. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  3385. @item gain
  3386. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  3387. @item in_name
  3388. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  3389. named and numbered input channels
  3390. @end table
  3391. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  3392. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  3393. avoiding clipping noise.
  3394. @subsection Mixing examples
  3395. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  3396. factor for the left channel:
  3397. @example
  3398. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  3399. @end example
  3400. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  3401. 7-channels surround:
  3402. @example
  3403. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  3404. @end example
  3405. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  3406. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  3407. needs.
  3408. @subsection Remapping examples
  3409. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  3410. @itemize
  3411. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  3412. @item only one input per channel output,
  3413. @end itemize
  3414. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  3415. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  3416. remapping.
  3417. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  3418. dropping the extra channels:
  3419. @example
  3420. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  3421. @end example
  3422. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  3423. and keep the input channel layout:
  3424. @example
  3425. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  3426. @end example
  3427. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  3428. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  3429. @example
  3430. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  3431. @end example
  3432. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  3433. front left and right:
  3434. @example
  3435. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  3436. @end example
  3437. @section replaygain
  3438. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  3439. outputs it unchanged.
  3440. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  3441. @section resample
  3442. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  3443. not meant to be used directly.
  3444. @section rubberband
  3445. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  3446. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3447. @code{--enable-librubberband}.
  3448. The filter accepts the following options:
  3449. @table @option
  3450. @item tempo
  3451. Set tempo scale factor.
  3452. @item pitch
  3453. Set pitch scale factor.
  3454. @item transients
  3455. Set transients detector.
  3456. Possible values are:
  3457. @table @var
  3458. @item crisp
  3459. @item mixed
  3460. @item smooth
  3461. @end table
  3462. @item detector
  3463. Set detector.
  3464. Possible values are:
  3465. @table @var
  3466. @item compound
  3467. @item percussive
  3468. @item soft
  3469. @end table
  3470. @item phase
  3471. Set phase.
  3472. Possible values are:
  3473. @table @var
  3474. @item laminar
  3475. @item independent
  3476. @end table
  3477. @item window
  3478. Set processing window size.
  3479. Possible values are:
  3480. @table @var
  3481. @item standard
  3482. @item short
  3483. @item long
  3484. @end table
  3485. @item smoothing
  3486. Set smoothing.
  3487. Possible values are:
  3488. @table @var
  3489. @item off
  3490. @item on
  3491. @end table
  3492. @item formant
  3493. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  3494. Possible values are:
  3495. @table @var
  3496. @item shifted
  3497. @item preserved
  3498. @end table
  3499. @item pitchq
  3500. Set pitch quality.
  3501. Possible values are:
  3502. @table @var
  3503. @item quality
  3504. @item speed
  3505. @item consistency
  3506. @end table
  3507. @item channels
  3508. Set channels.
  3509. Possible values are:
  3510. @table @var
  3511. @item apart
  3512. @item together
  3513. @end table
  3514. @end table
  3515. @subsection Commands
  3516. This filter supports the following commands:
  3517. @table @option
  3518. @item tempo
  3519. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  3520. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  3521. @item pitch
  3522. Change filter pitch scale factor.
  3523. Syntax for the command is : "@var{pitch}"
  3524. @end table
  3525. @section sidechaincompress
  3526. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  3527. detected signal using second input signal.
  3528. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3529. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3530. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  3531. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  3532. The filter accepts the following options:
  3533. @table @option
  3534. @item level_in
  3535. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3536. @item mode
  3537. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3538. Default is @code{downward}.
  3539. @item threshold
  3540. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  3541. reduction of first stream.
  3542. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  3543. @item ratio
  3544. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  3545. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  3546. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  3547. @item attack
  3548. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3549. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  3550. @item release
  3551. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  3552. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  3553. @item makeup
  3554. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  3555. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  3556. @item knee
  3557. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3558. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  3559. @item link
  3560. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  3561. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  3562. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  3563. @item detection
  3564. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  3565. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  3566. @item level_sc
  3567. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3568. @item mix
  3569. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  3570. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3571. @end table
  3572. @subsection Examples
  3573. @itemize
  3574. @item
  3575. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  3576. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  3577. merged with 2nd input:
  3578. @example
  3579. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  3580. @end example
  3581. @end itemize
  3582. @section sidechaingate
  3583. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  3584. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  3585. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  3586. threshold.
  3587. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  3588. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  3589. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  3590. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  3591. guitar.
  3592. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3593. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3594. The filter accepts the following options:
  3595. @table @option
  3596. @item level_in
  3597. Set input level before filtering.
  3598. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3599. @item mode
  3600. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3601. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  3602. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  3603. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  3604. @item range
  3605. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  3606. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3607. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  3608. @item threshold
  3609. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  3610. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3611. @item ratio
  3612. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  3613. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  3614. @item attack
  3615. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3616. reduction stops.
  3617. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3618. @item release
  3619. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  3620. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  3621. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3622. @item makeup
  3623. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  3624. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  3625. @item knee
  3626. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3627. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  3628. @item detection
  3629. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  3630. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  3631. @item link
  3632. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  3633. the reduction.
  3634. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  3635. @item level_sc
  3636. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3637. @end table
  3638. @section silencedetect
  3639. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  3640. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  3641. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  3642. minimum detected noise duration.
  3643. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds.
  3644. The filter accepts the following options:
  3645. @table @option
  3646. @item noise, n
  3647. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  3648. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  3649. @item duration, d
  3650. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  3651. @item mono, m
  3652. Process each channel separately, instead of combined. By default is disabled.
  3653. @end table
  3654. @subsection Examples
  3655. @itemize
  3656. @item
  3657. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  3658. @example
  3659. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  3660. @end example
  3661. @item
  3662. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  3663. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  3664. @example
  3665. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  3666. @end example
  3667. @end itemize
  3668. @section silenceremove
  3669. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  3670. The filter accepts the following options:
  3671. @table @option
  3672. @item start_periods
  3673. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  3674. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  3675. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  3676. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  3677. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  3678. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  3679. Default value is @code{0}.
  3680. @item start_duration
  3681. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  3682. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  3683. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  3684. @item start_threshold
  3685. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  3686. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  3687. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  3688. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3689. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3690. @item start_silence
  3691. Specify max duration of silence at beginning that will be kept after
  3692. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3693. as silence.
  3694. @item start_mode
  3695. Specify mode of detection of silence end in start of multi-channel audio.
  3696. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3697. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3698. stopped trimming of silence.
  3699. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3700. stopped trimming of silence.
  3701. @item stop_periods
  3702. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  3703. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  3704. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  3705. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  3706. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  3707. in the middle of the audio.
  3708. Default value is @code{0}.
  3709. @item stop_duration
  3710. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  3711. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  3712. the audio.
  3713. Default value is @code{0}.
  3714. @item stop_threshold
  3715. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  3716. the end of audio.
  3717. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3718. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3719. @item stop_silence
  3720. Specify max duration of silence at end that will be kept after
  3721. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3722. as silence.
  3723. @item stop_mode
  3724. Specify mode of detection of silence start in end of multi-channel audio.
  3725. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3726. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3727. stopped trimming of silence.
  3728. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3729. stopped trimming of silence.
  3730. @item detection
  3731. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  3732. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  3733. Default value is @code{rms}.
  3734. @item window
  3735. Set duration in number of seconds used to calculate size of window in number
  3736. of samples for detecting silence.
  3737. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  3738. @end table
  3739. @subsection Examples
  3740. @itemize
  3741. @item
  3742. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  3743. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  3744. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  3745. @example
  3746. silenceremove=start_periods=1:start_duration=5:start_threshold=0.02
  3747. @end example
  3748. @item
  3749. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  3750. second of silence in audio:
  3751. @example
  3752. silenceremove=stop_periods=-1:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB
  3753. @end example
  3754. @item
  3755. Trim all digital silence samples, using peak detection, from beginning to end
  3756. where there is more than 0 samples of digital silence in audio and digital
  3757. silence is detected in all channels at same positions in stream:
  3758. @example
  3759. silenceremove=window=0:detection=peak:stop_mode=all:start_mode=all:stop_periods=-1:stop_threshold=0
  3760. @end example
  3761. @end itemize
  3762. @section sofalizer
  3763. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3764. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  3765. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  3766. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  3767. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  3768. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  3769. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3770. @code{--enable-libmysofa}.
  3771. The filter accepts the following options:
  3772. @table @option
  3773. @item sofa
  3774. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  3775. @item gain
  3776. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3777. @item rotation
  3778. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3779. @item elevation
  3780. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3781. @item radius
  3782. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  3783. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  3784. @item type
  3785. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3786. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3787. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3788. Default is @var{freq}.
  3789. @item speakers
  3790. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  3791. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  3792. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  3793. azimuth and elevation in degrees.
  3794. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  3795. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  3796. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  3797. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  3798. @item lfegain
  3799. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3800. @item framesize
  3801. Set custom frame size in number of samples. Default is 1024.
  3802. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000. Only used if option @samp{type}
  3803. is set to @var{freq}.
  3804. @item normalize
  3805. Should all IRs be normalized upon importing SOFA file.
  3806. By default is enabled.
  3807. @item interpolate
  3808. Should nearest IRs be interpolated with neighbor IRs if exact position
  3809. does not match. By default is disabled.
  3810. @item minphase
  3811. Minphase all IRs upon loading of SOFA file. By default is disabled.
  3812. @item anglestep
  3813. Set neighbor search angle step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3814. @item radstep
  3815. Set neighbor search radius step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3816. @end table
  3817. @subsection Examples
  3818. @itemize
  3819. @item
  3820. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  3821. @example
  3822. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  3823. @end example
  3824. @item
  3825. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  3826. @example
  3827. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  3828. @end example
  3829. @item
  3830. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, back left and back right
  3831. and also with custom gain:
  3832. @example
  3833. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|BL 135|BR 225:gain=28"
  3834. @end example
  3835. @end itemize
  3836. @section stereotools
  3837. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  3838. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  3839. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  3840. The filter accepts the following options:
  3841. @table @option
  3842. @item level_in
  3843. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3844. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3845. @item level_out
  3846. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3847. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3848. @item balance_in
  3849. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3850. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3851. @item balance_out
  3852. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3853. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3854. @item softclip
  3855. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  3856. clipping. Disabled by default.
  3857. @item mutel
  3858. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3859. @item muter
  3860. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3861. @item phasel
  3862. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3863. @item phaser
  3864. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3865. @item mode
  3866. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  3867. @table @samp
  3868. @item lr>lr
  3869. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  3870. @item lr>ms
  3871. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  3872. @item ms>lr
  3873. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  3874. @item lr>ll
  3875. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  3876. @item lr>rr
  3877. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  3878. @item lr>l+r
  3879. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  3880. @item lr>rl
  3881. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  3882. @item ms>ll
  3883. Mid/Side to Left/Left.
  3884. @item ms>rr
  3885. Mid/Side to Right/Right.
  3886. @end table
  3887. @item slev
  3888. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  3889. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3890. @item sbal
  3891. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  3892. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3893. @item mlev
  3894. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  3895. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3896. @item mpan
  3897. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3898. @item base
  3899. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  3900. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3901. @item delay
  3902. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  3903. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  3904. @item sclevel
  3905. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  3906. @item phase
  3907. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  3908. @item bmode_in, bmode_out
  3909. Set balance mode for balance_in/balance_out option.
  3910. Can be one of the following:
  3911. @table @samp
  3912. @item balance
  3913. Classic balance mode. Attenuate one channel at time.
  3914. Gain is raised up to 1.
  3915. @item amplitude
  3916. Similar as classic mode above but gain is raised up to 2.
  3917. @item power
  3918. Equal power distribution, from -6dB to +6dB range.
  3919. @end table
  3920. @end table
  3921. @subsection Examples
  3922. @itemize
  3923. @item
  3924. Apply karaoke like effect:
  3925. @example
  3926. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  3927. @end example
  3928. @item
  3929. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  3930. @example
  3931. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  3932. @end example
  3933. @end itemize
  3934. @section stereowiden
  3935. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  3936. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  3937. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  3938. The filter accepts the following options:
  3939. @table @option
  3940. @item delay
  3941. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  3942. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  3943. @item feedback
  3944. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  3945. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  3946. effect. Default is 0.3.
  3947. @item crossfeed
  3948. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  3949. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  3950. channels. Default is 0.3.
  3951. @item drymix
  3952. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  3953. @end table
  3954. @section superequalizer
  3955. Apply 18 band equalizer.
  3956. The filter accepts the following options:
  3957. @table @option
  3958. @item 1b
  3959. Set 65Hz band gain.
  3960. @item 2b
  3961. Set 92Hz band gain.
  3962. @item 3b
  3963. Set 131Hz band gain.
  3964. @item 4b
  3965. Set 185Hz band gain.
  3966. @item 5b
  3967. Set 262Hz band gain.
  3968. @item 6b
  3969. Set 370Hz band gain.
  3970. @item 7b
  3971. Set 523Hz band gain.
  3972. @item 8b
  3973. Set 740Hz band gain.
  3974. @item 9b
  3975. Set 1047Hz band gain.
  3976. @item 10b
  3977. Set 1480Hz band gain.
  3978. @item 11b
  3979. Set 2093Hz band gain.
  3980. @item 12b
  3981. Set 2960Hz band gain.
  3982. @item 13b
  3983. Set 4186Hz band gain.
  3984. @item 14b
  3985. Set 5920Hz band gain.
  3986. @item 15b
  3987. Set 8372Hz band gain.
  3988. @item 16b
  3989. Set 11840Hz band gain.
  3990. @item 17b
  3991. Set 16744Hz band gain.
  3992. @item 18b
  3993. Set 20000Hz band gain.
  3994. @end table
  3995. @section surround
  3996. Apply audio surround upmix filter.
  3997. This filter allows to produce multichannel output from audio stream.
  3998. The filter accepts the following options:
  3999. @table @option
  4000. @item chl_out
  4001. Set output channel layout. By default, this is @var{5.1}.
  4002. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4003. for the required syntax.
  4004. @item chl_in
  4005. Set input channel layout. By default, this is @var{stereo}.
  4006. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4007. for the required syntax.
  4008. @item level_in
  4009. Set input volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4010. @item level_out
  4011. Set output volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4012. @item lfe
  4013. Enable LFE channel output if output channel layout has it. By default, this is enabled.
  4014. @item lfe_low
  4015. Set LFE low cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{128} Hz.
  4016. @item lfe_high
  4017. Set LFE high cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{256} Hz.
  4018. @item lfe_mode
  4019. Set LFE mode, can be @var{add} or @var{sub}. Default is @var{add}.
  4020. In @var{add} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output.
  4021. In @var{sub} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output but
  4022. also all non-LFE output channels are subtracted with output LFE channel.
  4023. @item angle
  4024. Set angle of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{360}.
  4025. Default is @var{90}.
  4026. @item fc_in
  4027. Set front center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4028. @item fc_out
  4029. Set front center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4030. @item fl_in
  4031. Set front left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4032. @item fl_out
  4033. Set front left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4034. @item fr_in
  4035. Set front right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4036. @item fr_out
  4037. Set front right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4038. @item sl_in
  4039. Set side left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4040. @item sl_out
  4041. Set side left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4042. @item sr_in
  4043. Set side right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4044. @item sr_out
  4045. Set side right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4046. @item bl_in
  4047. Set back left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4048. @item bl_out
  4049. Set back left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4050. @item br_in
  4051. Set back right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4052. @item br_out
  4053. Set back right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4054. @item bc_in
  4055. Set back center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4056. @item bc_out
  4057. Set back center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4058. @item lfe_in
  4059. Set LFE input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4060. @item lfe_out
  4061. Set LFE output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4062. @item allx
  4063. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for all channels.
  4064. @item ally
  4065. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for all channels.
  4066. @item fcx, flx, frx, blx, brx, slx, srx, bcx
  4067. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for each channel.
  4068. @item fcy, fly, fry, bly, bry, sly, sry, bcy
  4069. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for each channel.
  4070. @item win_size
  4071. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  4072. @item win_func
  4073. Set window function.
  4074. It accepts the following values:
  4075. @table @samp
  4076. @item rect
  4077. @item bartlett
  4078. @item hann, hanning
  4079. @item hamming
  4080. @item blackman
  4081. @item welch
  4082. @item flattop
  4083. @item bharris
  4084. @item bnuttall
  4085. @item bhann
  4086. @item sine
  4087. @item nuttall
  4088. @item lanczos
  4089. @item gauss
  4090. @item tukey
  4091. @item dolph
  4092. @item cauchy
  4093. @item parzen
  4094. @item poisson
  4095. @item bohman
  4096. @end table
  4097. Default is @code{hann}.
  4098. @item overlap
  4099. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  4100. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.5}.
  4101. @end table
  4102. @section treble, highshelf
  4103. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  4104. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  4105. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  4106. The filter accepts the following options:
  4107. @table @option
  4108. @item gain, g
  4109. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  4110. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  4111. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  4112. @item frequency, f
  4113. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  4114. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  4115. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  4116. @item width_type, t
  4117. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  4118. @table @option
  4119. @item h
  4120. Hz
  4121. @item q
  4122. Q-Factor
  4123. @item o
  4124. octave
  4125. @item s
  4126. slope
  4127. @item k
  4128. kHz
  4129. @end table
  4130. @item width, w
  4131. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  4132. @item mix, m
  4133. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  4134. Range is between 0 and 1.
  4135. @item channels, c
  4136. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  4137. @end table
  4138. @subsection Commands
  4139. This filter supports the following commands:
  4140. @table @option
  4141. @item frequency, f
  4142. Change treble frequency.
  4143. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  4144. @item width_type, t
  4145. Change treble width_type.
  4146. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  4147. @item width, w
  4148. Change treble width.
  4149. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  4150. @item gain, g
  4151. Change treble gain.
  4152. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  4153. @item mix, m
  4154. Change treble mix.
  4155. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  4156. @end table
  4157. @section tremolo
  4158. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  4159. The filter accepts the following options:
  4160. @table @option
  4161. @item f
  4162. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  4163. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  4164. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  4165. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  4166. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4167. @item d
  4168. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4169. Default value is 0.5.
  4170. @end table
  4171. @section vibrato
  4172. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  4173. The filter accepts the following options:
  4174. @table @option
  4175. @item f
  4176. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  4177. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4178. @item d
  4179. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4180. Default value is 0.5.
  4181. @end table
  4182. @section volume
  4183. Adjust the input audio volume.
  4184. It accepts the following parameters:
  4185. @table @option
  4186. @item volume
  4187. Set audio volume expression.
  4188. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  4189. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  4190. @example
  4191. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  4192. @end example
  4193. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  4194. @item precision
  4195. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  4196. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  4197. precision of the volume scaling.
  4198. @table @option
  4199. @item fixed
  4200. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  4201. @item float
  4202. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  4203. @item double
  4204. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  4205. @end table
  4206. @item replaygain
  4207. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  4208. @table @option
  4209. @item drop
  4210. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  4211. @item ignore
  4212. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  4213. @item track
  4214. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  4215. @item album
  4216. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  4217. @end table
  4218. @item replaygain_preamp
  4219. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  4220. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  4221. @item eval
  4222. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  4223. It accepts the following values:
  4224. @table @samp
  4225. @item once
  4226. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  4227. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  4228. @item frame
  4229. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  4230. @end table
  4231. Default value is @samp{once}.
  4232. @end table
  4233. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  4234. @table @option
  4235. @item n
  4236. frame number (starting at zero)
  4237. @item nb_channels
  4238. number of channels
  4239. @item nb_consumed_samples
  4240. number of samples consumed by the filter
  4241. @item nb_samples
  4242. number of samples in the current frame
  4243. @item pos
  4244. original frame position in the file
  4245. @item pts
  4246. frame PTS
  4247. @item sample_rate
  4248. sample rate
  4249. @item startpts
  4250. PTS at start of stream
  4251. @item startt
  4252. time at start of stream
  4253. @item t
  4254. frame time
  4255. @item tb
  4256. timestamp timebase
  4257. @item volume
  4258. last set volume value
  4259. @end table
  4260. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  4261. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  4262. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  4263. @subsection Commands
  4264. This filter supports the following commands:
  4265. @table @option
  4266. @item volume
  4267. Modify the volume expression.
  4268. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4269. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4270. value.
  4271. @item replaygain_noclip
  4272. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  4273. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  4274. @end table
  4275. @subsection Examples
  4276. @itemize
  4277. @item
  4278. Halve the input audio volume:
  4279. @example
  4280. volume=volume=0.5
  4281. volume=volume=1/2
  4282. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  4283. @end example
  4284. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  4285. omitted, for example like in:
  4286. @example
  4287. volume=0.5
  4288. @end example
  4289. @item
  4290. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  4291. @example
  4292. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  4293. @end example
  4294. @item
  4295. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  4296. @example
  4297. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  4298. @end example
  4299. @end itemize
  4300. @section volumedetect
  4301. Detect the volume of the input video.
  4302. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  4303. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  4304. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  4305. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  4306. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  4307. the samples).
  4308. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  4309. @subsection Examples
  4310. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  4311. @example
  4312. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  4313. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  4314. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  4315. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  4316. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  4317. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  4318. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  4319. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  4320. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  4321. @end example
  4322. It means that:
  4323. @itemize
  4324. @item
  4325. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  4326. @item
  4327. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  4328. @item
  4329. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  4330. @end itemize
  4331. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  4332. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  4333. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  4334. @chapter Audio Sources
  4335. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  4336. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  4337. @section abuffer
  4338. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  4339. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  4340. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  4341. It accepts the following parameters:
  4342. @table @option
  4343. @item time_base
  4344. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  4345. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  4346. @item sample_rate
  4347. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  4348. @item sample_fmt
  4349. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  4350. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  4351. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  4352. @item channel_layout
  4353. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  4354. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  4355. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  4356. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  4357. @item channels
  4358. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  4359. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  4360. must be consistent.
  4361. @end table
  4362. @subsection Examples
  4363. @example
  4364. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  4365. @end example
  4366. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  4367. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  4368. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  4369. equivalent to:
  4370. @example
  4371. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  4372. @end example
  4373. @section aevalsrc
  4374. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  4375. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  4376. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  4377. audio signal.
  4378. This source accepts the following options:
  4379. @table @option
  4380. @item exprs
  4381. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  4382. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  4383. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  4384. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  4385. @item channel_layout, c
  4386. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  4387. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  4388. @item duration, d
  4389. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  4390. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4391. for the accepted syntax.
  4392. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  4393. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  4394. complete frame.
  4395. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  4396. supposed to be generated forever.
  4397. @item nb_samples, n
  4398. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  4399. default to 1024.
  4400. @item sample_rate, s
  4401. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  4402. @end table
  4403. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  4404. @table @option
  4405. @item n
  4406. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  4407. @item t
  4408. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  4409. @item s
  4410. sample rate
  4411. @end table
  4412. @subsection Examples
  4413. @itemize
  4414. @item
  4415. Generate silence:
  4416. @example
  4417. aevalsrc=0
  4418. @end example
  4419. @item
  4420. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  4421. 8000 Hz:
  4422. @example
  4423. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  4424. @end example
  4425. @item
  4426. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  4427. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  4428. @example
  4429. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  4430. @end example
  4431. @item
  4432. Generate white noise:
  4433. @example
  4434. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  4435. @end example
  4436. @item
  4437. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  4438. @example
  4439. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  4440. @end example
  4441. @item
  4442. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  4443. @example
  4444. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  4445. @end example
  4446. @end itemize
  4447. @section anullsrc
  4448. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  4449. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  4450. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  4451. synth filter).
  4452. This source accepts the following options:
  4453. @table @option
  4454. @item channel_layout, cl
  4455. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  4456. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  4457. is "stereo".
  4458. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  4459. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  4460. channel layout values.
  4461. @item sample_rate, r
  4462. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  4463. @item nb_samples, n
  4464. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  4465. @end table
  4466. @subsection Examples
  4467. @itemize
  4468. @item
  4469. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  4470. @example
  4471. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  4472. @end example
  4473. @item
  4474. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  4475. @example
  4476. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  4477. @end example
  4478. @end itemize
  4479. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  4480. @section flite
  4481. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  4482. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4483. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  4484. Note that versions of the flite library prior to 2.0 are not thread-safe.
  4485. The filter accepts the following options:
  4486. @table @option
  4487. @item list_voices
  4488. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  4489. immediately. Default value is 0.
  4490. @item nb_samples, n
  4491. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  4492. @item textfile
  4493. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  4494. @item text
  4495. Set the text to speak.
  4496. @item voice, v
  4497. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  4498. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  4499. @end table
  4500. @subsection Examples
  4501. @itemize
  4502. @item
  4503. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  4504. standard flite voice:
  4505. @example
  4506. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  4507. @end example
  4508. @item
  4509. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  4510. @example
  4511. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4512. @end example
  4513. @item
  4514. Input text to ffmpeg:
  4515. @example
  4516. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4517. @end example
  4518. @item
  4519. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  4520. the @code{lavfi} device:
  4521. @example
  4522. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  4523. @end example
  4524. @end itemize
  4525. For more information about libflite, check:
  4526. @url{http://www.festvox.org/flite/}
  4527. @section anoisesrc
  4528. Generate a noise audio signal.
  4529. The filter accepts the following options:
  4530. @table @option
  4531. @item sample_rate, r
  4532. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  4533. @item amplitude, a
  4534. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  4535. is 1.0.
  4536. @item duration, d
  4537. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  4538. results in noise with an infinite length.
  4539. @item color, colour, c
  4540. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, brown,
  4541. blue and violet. Default color is white.
  4542. @item seed, s
  4543. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  4544. @item nb_samples, n
  4545. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  4546. @end table
  4547. @subsection Examples
  4548. @itemize
  4549. @item
  4550. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  4551. @example
  4552. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  4553. @end example
  4554. @end itemize
  4555. @section hilbert
  4556. Generate odd-tap Hilbert transform FIR coefficients.
  4557. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for phase-shifting
  4558. the signal by 90 degrees.
  4559. This is used in many matrix coding schemes and for analytic signal generation.
  4560. The process is often written as a multiplication by i (or j), the imaginary unit.
  4561. The filter accepts the following options:
  4562. @table @option
  4563. @item sample_rate, s
  4564. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4565. @item taps, t
  4566. Set length of FIR filter, default is 22051.
  4567. @item nb_samples, n
  4568. Set number of samples per each frame.
  4569. @item win_func, w
  4570. Set window function to be used when generating FIR coefficients.
  4571. @end table
  4572. @section sinc
  4573. Generate a sinc kaiser-windowed low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, or band-reject FIR coefficients.
  4574. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4575. The filter accepts the following options:
  4576. @table @option
  4577. @item sample_rate, r
  4578. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4579. @item nb_samples, n
  4580. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4581. @item hp
  4582. Set high-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4583. @item lp
  4584. Set low-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4585. If high-pass frequency is lower than low-pass frequency and low-pass frequency
  4586. is higher than 0 then filter will create band-pass filter coefficients,
  4587. otherwise band-reject filter coefficients.
  4588. @item phase
  4589. Set filter phase response. Default is 50. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.
  4590. @item beta
  4591. Set Kaiser window beta.
  4592. @item att
  4593. Set stop-band attenuation. Default is 120dB, allowed range is from 40 to 180 dB.
  4594. @item round
  4595. Enable rounding, by default is disabled.
  4596. @item hptaps
  4597. Set number of taps for high-pass filter.
  4598. @item lptaps
  4599. Set number of taps for low-pass filter.
  4600. @end table
  4601. @section sine
  4602. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  4603. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  4604. The filter accepts the following options:
  4605. @table @option
  4606. @item frequency, f
  4607. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  4608. @item beep_factor, b
  4609. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  4610. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  4611. @item sample_rate, r
  4612. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  4613. @item duration, d
  4614. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  4615. @item samples_per_frame
  4616. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  4617. The expression can contain the following constants:
  4618. @table @option
  4619. @item n
  4620. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  4621. @item pts
  4622. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  4623. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  4624. @item t
  4625. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  4626. @item TB
  4627. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  4628. @end table
  4629. Default is @code{1024}.
  4630. @end table
  4631. @subsection Examples
  4632. @itemize
  4633. @item
  4634. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  4635. @example
  4636. sine
  4637. @end example
  4638. @item
  4639. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  4640. @example
  4641. sine=220:4:d=5
  4642. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  4643. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  4644. @end example
  4645. @item
  4646. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  4647. pattern:
  4648. @example
  4649. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  4650. @end example
  4651. @end itemize
  4652. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  4653. @chapter Audio Sinks
  4654. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  4655. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  4656. @section abuffersink
  4657. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  4658. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  4659. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  4660. or the options system.
  4661. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  4662. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  4663. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  4664. @section anullsink
  4665. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  4666. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  4667. tools.
  4668. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  4669. @chapter Video Filters
  4670. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  4671. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  4672. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  4673. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  4674. build.
  4675. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  4676. @section addroi
  4677. Mark a region of interest in a video frame.
  4678. The frame data is passed through unchanged, but metadata is attached
  4679. to the frame indicating regions of interest which can affect the
  4680. behaviour of later encoding. Multiple regions can be marked by
  4681. applying the filter multiple times.
  4682. @table @option
  4683. @item x
  4684. Region distance in pixels from the left edge of the frame.
  4685. @item y
  4686. Region distance in pixels from the top edge of the frame.
  4687. @item w
  4688. Region width in pixels.
  4689. @item h
  4690. Region height in pixels.
  4691. The parameters @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are expressions,
  4692. and may contain the following variables:
  4693. @table @option
  4694. @item iw
  4695. Width of the input frame.
  4696. @item ih
  4697. Height of the input frame.
  4698. @end table
  4699. @item qoffset
  4700. Quantisation offset to apply within the region.
  4701. This must be a real value in the range -1 to +1. A value of zero
  4702. indicates no quality change. A negative value asks for better quality
  4703. (less quantisation), while a positive value asks for worse quality
  4704. (greater quantisation).
  4705. The range is calibrated so that the extreme values indicate the
  4706. largest possible offset - if the rest of the frame is encoded with the
  4707. worst possible quality, an offset of -1 indicates that this region
  4708. should be encoded with the best possible quality anyway. Intermediate
  4709. values are then interpolated in some codec-dependent way.
  4710. For example, in 10-bit H.264 the quantisation parameter varies between
  4711. -12 and 51. A typical qoffset value of -1/10 therefore indicates that
  4712. this region should be encoded with a QP around one-tenth of the full
  4713. range better than the rest of the frame. So, if most of the frame
  4714. were to be encoded with a QP of around 30, this region would get a QP
  4715. of around 24 (an offset of approximately -1/10 * (51 - -12) = -6.3).
  4716. An extreme value of -1 would indicate that this region should be
  4717. encoded with the best possible quality regardless of the treatment of
  4718. the rest of the frame - that is, should be encoded at a QP of -12.
  4719. @item clear
  4720. If set to true, remove any existing regions of interest marked on the
  4721. frame before adding the new one.
  4722. @end table
  4723. @subsection Examples
  4724. @itemize
  4725. @item
  4726. Mark the centre quarter of the frame as interesting.
  4727. @example
  4728. addroi=iw/4:ih/4:iw/2:ih/2:-1/10
  4729. @end example
  4730. @item
  4731. Mark the 100-pixel-wide region on the left edge of the frame as very
  4732. uninteresting (to be encoded at much lower quality than the rest of
  4733. the frame).
  4734. @example
  4735. addroi=0:0:100:ih:+1/5
  4736. @end example
  4737. @end itemize
  4738. @section alphaextract
  4739. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  4740. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  4741. @section alphamerge
  4742. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  4743. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  4744. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  4745. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  4746. channel.
  4747. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  4748. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  4749. @example
  4750. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  4751. @end example
  4752. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  4753. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  4754. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  4755. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  4756. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  4757. @section amplify
  4758. Amplify differences between current pixel and pixels of adjacent frames in
  4759. same pixel location.
  4760. This filter accepts the following options:
  4761. @table @option
  4762. @item radius
  4763. Set frame radius. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 63.
  4764. For example radius of 3 will instruct filter to calculate average of 7 frames.
  4765. @item factor
  4766. Set factor to amplify difference. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4767. @item threshold
  4768. Set threshold for difference amplification. Any difference greater or equal to
  4769. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 10.
  4770. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4771. @item tolerance
  4772. Set tolerance for difference amplification. Any difference lower to
  4773. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 0.
  4774. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4775. @item low
  4776. Set lower limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4777. This option controls maximum possible value that will decrease source pixel value.
  4778. @item high
  4779. Set high limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4780. This option controls maximum possible value that will increase source pixel value.
  4781. @item planes
  4782. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  4783. @end table
  4784. @subsection Commands
  4785. This filter supports the following @ref{commands} that corresponds to option of same name:
  4786. @table @option
  4787. @item factor
  4788. @item threshold
  4789. @item tolerance
  4790. @item low
  4791. @item high
  4792. @item planes
  4793. @end table
  4794. @section ass
  4795. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  4796. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  4797. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  4798. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  4799. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  4800. @table @option
  4801. @item shaping
  4802. Set the shaping engine
  4803. Available values are:
  4804. @table @samp
  4805. @item auto
  4806. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  4807. @item simple
  4808. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  4809. @item complex
  4810. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  4811. @end table
  4812. The default is @code{auto}.
  4813. @end table
  4814. @section atadenoise
  4815. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  4816. The filter accepts the following options:
  4817. @table @option
  4818. @item 0a
  4819. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  4820. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4821. @item 0b
  4822. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  4823. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4824. @item 1a
  4825. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4826. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4827. @item 1b
  4828. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4829. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4830. @item 2a
  4831. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4832. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4833. @item 2b
  4834. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4835. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4836. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  4837. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  4838. @item s
  4839. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 9. Must be odd
  4840. number in range [5, 129].
  4841. @item p
  4842. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  4843. @item a
  4844. Set what variant of algorithm filter will use for averaging. Default is @code{p} parallel.
  4845. Alternatively can be set to @code{s} serial.
  4846. Parallel can be faster then serial, while other way around is never true.
  4847. Parallel will abort early on first change being greater then thresholds, while serial
  4848. will continue processing other side of frames if they are equal or bellow thresholds.
  4849. @end table
  4850. @section avgblur
  4851. Apply average blur filter.
  4852. The filter accepts the following options:
  4853. @table @option
  4854. @item sizeX
  4855. Set horizontal radius size.
  4856. @item planes
  4857. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  4858. @item sizeY
  4859. Set vertical radius size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  4860. Default is @code{0}.
  4861. @end table
  4862. @subsection Commands
  4863. This filter supports same commands as options.
  4864. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4865. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4866. value.
  4867. @section bbox
  4868. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  4869. luminance plane.
  4870. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  4871. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  4872. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  4873. log.
  4874. The filter accepts the following option:
  4875. @table @option
  4876. @item min_val
  4877. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  4878. @end table
  4879. @section bitplanenoise
  4880. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  4881. The filter accepts the following options:
  4882. @table @option
  4883. @item bitplane
  4884. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  4885. @item filter
  4886. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  4887. Default is disabled.
  4888. @end table
  4889. @section blackdetect
  4890. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  4891. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  4892. recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
  4893. duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
  4894. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  4895. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  4896. The filter accepts the following options:
  4897. @table @option
  4898. @item black_min_duration, d
  4899. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  4900. be a non-negative floating point number.
  4901. Default value is 2.0.
  4902. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  4903. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  4904. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  4905. @example
  4906. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  4907. @end example
  4908. for which a picture is considered black.
  4909. Default value is 0.98.
  4910. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  4911. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  4912. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  4913. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  4914. the following equation:
  4915. @example
  4916. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  4917. @end example
  4918. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  4919. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  4920. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  4921. Default value is 0.10.
  4922. @end table
  4923. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  4924. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  4925. @example
  4926. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  4927. @end example
  4928. @section blackframe
  4929. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  4930. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  4931. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  4932. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  4933. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  4934. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  4935. This filter exports frame metadata @code{lavfi.blackframe.pblack}.
  4936. The value represents the percentage of pixels in the picture that
  4937. are below the threshold value.
  4938. It accepts the following parameters:
  4939. @table @option
  4940. @item amount
  4941. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  4942. @code{98}.
  4943. @item threshold, thresh
  4944. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  4945. @code{32}.
  4946. @end table
  4947. @section blend, tblend
  4948. Blend two video frames into each other.
  4949. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  4950. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  4951. "bottom" layer. By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.
  4952. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  4953. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  4954. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  4955. A description of the accepted options follows.
  4956. @table @option
  4957. @item c0_mode
  4958. @item c1_mode
  4959. @item c2_mode
  4960. @item c3_mode
  4961. @item all_mode
  4962. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  4963. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  4964. Available values for component modes are:
  4965. @table @samp
  4966. @item addition
  4967. @item grainmerge
  4968. @item and
  4969. @item average
  4970. @item burn
  4971. @item darken
  4972. @item difference
  4973. @item grainextract
  4974. @item divide
  4975. @item dodge
  4976. @item freeze
  4977. @item exclusion
  4978. @item extremity
  4979. @item glow
  4980. @item hardlight
  4981. @item hardmix
  4982. @item heat
  4983. @item lighten
  4984. @item linearlight
  4985. @item multiply
  4986. @item multiply128
  4987. @item negation
  4988. @item normal
  4989. @item or
  4990. @item overlay
  4991. @item phoenix
  4992. @item pinlight
  4993. @item reflect
  4994. @item screen
  4995. @item softlight
  4996. @item subtract
  4997. @item vividlight
  4998. @item xor
  4999. @end table
  5000. @item c0_opacity
  5001. @item c1_opacity
  5002. @item c2_opacity
  5003. @item c3_opacity
  5004. @item all_opacity
  5005. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5006. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  5007. @item c0_expr
  5008. @item c1_expr
  5009. @item c2_expr
  5010. @item c3_expr
  5011. @item all_expr
  5012. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5013. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  5014. The expressions can use the following variables:
  5015. @table @option
  5016. @item N
  5017. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  5018. @item X
  5019. @item Y
  5020. the coordinates of the current sample
  5021. @item W
  5022. @item H
  5023. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  5024. @item SW
  5025. @item SH
  5026. Width and height scale for the plane being filtered. It is the
  5027. ratio between the dimensions of the current plane to the luma plane,
  5028. e.g. for a @code{yuv420p} frame, the values are @code{1,1} for
  5029. the luma plane and @code{0.5,0.5} for the chroma planes.
  5030. @item T
  5031. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  5032. @item TOP, A
  5033. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  5034. @item BOTTOM, B
  5035. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  5036. @end table
  5037. @end table
  5038. The @code{blend} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5039. @subsection Examples
  5040. @itemize
  5041. @item
  5042. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  5043. @example
  5044. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  5045. @end example
  5046. @item
  5047. Apply linear horizontal transition from top layer to bottom layer:
  5048. @example
  5049. blend=all_expr='A*(X/W)+B*(1-X/W)'
  5050. @end example
  5051. @item
  5052. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  5053. @example
  5054. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  5055. @end example
  5056. @item
  5057. Apply uncover left effect:
  5058. @example
  5059. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  5060. @end example
  5061. @item
  5062. Apply uncover down effect:
  5063. @example
  5064. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  5065. @end example
  5066. @item
  5067. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  5068. @example
  5069. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  5070. @end example
  5071. @item
  5072. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  5073. @example
  5074. blend=all_expr='if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)'
  5075. @end example
  5076. @item
  5077. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  5078. @example
  5079. tblend=all_mode=grainextract
  5080. @end example
  5081. @end itemize
  5082. @section bm3d
  5083. Denoise frames using Block-Matching 3D algorithm.
  5084. The filter accepts the following options.
  5085. @table @option
  5086. @item sigma
  5087. Set denoising strength. Default value is 1.
  5088. Allowed range is from 0 to 999.9.
  5089. The denoising algorithm is very sensitive to sigma, so adjust it
  5090. according to the source.
  5091. @item block
  5092. Set local patch size. This sets dimensions in 2D.
  5093. @item bstep
  5094. Set sliding step for processing blocks. Default value is 4.
  5095. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  5096. Smaller values allows processing more reference blocks and is slower.
  5097. @item group
  5098. Set maximal number of similar blocks for 3rd dimension. Default value is 1.
  5099. When set to 1, no block matching is done. Larger values allows more blocks
  5100. in single group.
  5101. Allowed range is from 1 to 256.
  5102. @item range
  5103. Set radius for search block matching. Default is 9.
  5104. Allowed range is from 1 to INT32_MAX.
  5105. @item mstep
  5106. Set step between two search locations for block matching. Default is 1.
  5107. Allowed range is from 1 to 64. Smaller is slower.
  5108. @item thmse
  5109. Set threshold of mean square error for block matching. Valid range is 0 to
  5110. INT32_MAX.
  5111. @item hdthr
  5112. Set thresholding parameter for hard thresholding in 3D transformed domain.
  5113. Larger values results in stronger hard-thresholding filtering in frequency
  5114. domain.
  5115. @item estim
  5116. Set filtering estimation mode. Can be @code{basic} or @code{final}.
  5117. Default is @code{basic}.
  5118. @item ref
  5119. If enabled, filter will use 2nd stream for block matching.
  5120. Default is disabled for @code{basic} value of @var{estim} option,
  5121. and always enabled if value of @var{estim} is @code{final}.
  5122. @item planes
  5123. Set planes to filter. Default is all available except alpha.
  5124. @end table
  5125. @subsection Examples
  5126. @itemize
  5127. @item
  5128. Basic filtering with bm3d:
  5129. @example
  5130. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic
  5131. @end example
  5132. @item
  5133. Same as above, but filtering only luma:
  5134. @example
  5135. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic:planes=1
  5136. @end example
  5137. @item
  5138. Same as above, but with both estimation modes:
  5139. @example
  5140. split[a][b],[a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5141. @end example
  5142. @item
  5143. Same as above, but prefilter with @ref{nlmeans} filter instead:
  5144. @example
  5145. split[a][b],[a]nlmeans=s=3:r=7:p=3[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5146. @end example
  5147. @end itemize
  5148. @section boxblur
  5149. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  5150. It accepts the following parameters:
  5151. @table @option
  5152. @item luma_radius, lr
  5153. @item luma_power, lp
  5154. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5155. @item chroma_power, cp
  5156. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5157. @item alpha_power, ap
  5158. @end table
  5159. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5160. @table @option
  5161. @item luma_radius, lr
  5162. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5163. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5164. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  5165. corresponding input plane.
  5166. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  5167. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  5168. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  5169. planes.
  5170. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  5171. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  5172. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  5173. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  5174. @table @option
  5175. @item w
  5176. @item h
  5177. The input width and height in pixels.
  5178. @item cw
  5179. @item ch
  5180. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  5181. @item hsub
  5182. @item vsub
  5183. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  5184. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5185. @end table
  5186. @item luma_power, lp
  5187. @item chroma_power, cp
  5188. @item alpha_power, ap
  5189. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  5190. corresponding plane.
  5191. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  5192. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  5193. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  5194. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  5195. @end table
  5196. @subsection Examples
  5197. @itemize
  5198. @item
  5199. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  5200. set to 2:
  5201. @example
  5202. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  5203. boxblur=2:1
  5204. @end example
  5205. @item
  5206. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  5207. @example
  5208. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  5209. @end example
  5210. @item
  5211. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  5212. @example
  5213. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  5214. @end example
  5215. @end itemize
  5216. @section bwdif
  5217. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  5218. Deinterlacing Filter").
  5219. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  5220. interpolation algorithms.
  5221. It accepts the following parameters:
  5222. @table @option
  5223. @item mode
  5224. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  5225. @table @option
  5226. @item 0, send_frame
  5227. Output one frame for each frame.
  5228. @item 1, send_field
  5229. Output one frame for each field.
  5230. @end table
  5231. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  5232. @item parity
  5233. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  5234. of the following values:
  5235. @table @option
  5236. @item 0, tff
  5237. Assume the top field is first.
  5238. @item 1, bff
  5239. Assume the bottom field is first.
  5240. @item -1, auto
  5241. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  5242. @end table
  5243. The default value is @code{auto}.
  5244. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  5245. top field first will be assumed.
  5246. @item deint
  5247. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  5248. values:
  5249. @table @option
  5250. @item 0, all
  5251. Deinterlace all frames.
  5252. @item 1, interlaced
  5253. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  5254. @end table
  5255. The default value is @code{all}.
  5256. @end table
  5257. @section chromahold
  5258. Remove all color information for all colors except for certain one.
  5259. The filter accepts the following options:
  5260. @table @option
  5261. @item color
  5262. The color which will not be replaced with neutral chroma.
  5263. @item similarity
  5264. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5265. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5266. @item blend
  5267. Blend percentage.
  5268. 0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.
  5269. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5270. @item yuv
  5271. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5272. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5273. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5274. @end table
  5275. @section chromakey
  5276. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  5277. The filter accepts the following options:
  5278. @table @option
  5279. @item color
  5280. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5281. @item similarity
  5282. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5283. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5284. @item blend
  5285. Blend percentage.
  5286. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5287. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5288. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5289. @item yuv
  5290. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5291. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5292. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5293. @end table
  5294. @subsection Examples
  5295. @itemize
  5296. @item
  5297. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5298. @example
  5299. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  5300. @end example
  5301. @item
  5302. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  5303. @example
  5304. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  5305. @end example
  5306. @end itemize
  5307. @section chromashift
  5308. Shift chroma pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  5309. The filter accepts the following options:
  5310. @table @option
  5311. @item cbh
  5312. Set amount to shift chroma-blue horizontally.
  5313. @item cbv
  5314. Set amount to shift chroma-blue vertically.
  5315. @item crh
  5316. Set amount to shift chroma-red horizontally.
  5317. @item crv
  5318. Set amount to shift chroma-red vertically.
  5319. @item edge
  5320. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  5321. @end table
  5322. @section ciescope
  5323. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  5324. The filter accepts the following options:
  5325. @table @option
  5326. @item system
  5327. Set color system.
  5328. @table @samp
  5329. @item ntsc, 470m
  5330. @item ebu, 470bg
  5331. @item smpte
  5332. @item 240m
  5333. @item apple
  5334. @item widergb
  5335. @item cie1931
  5336. @item rec709, hdtv
  5337. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  5338. @item dcip3
  5339. @end table
  5340. @item cie
  5341. Set CIE system.
  5342. @table @samp
  5343. @item xyy
  5344. @item ucs
  5345. @item luv
  5346. @end table
  5347. @item gamuts
  5348. Set what gamuts to draw.
  5349. See @code{system} option for available values.
  5350. @item size, s
  5351. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  5352. @item intensity, i
  5353. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  5354. @item contrast
  5355. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  5356. @item corrgamma
  5357. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  5358. @item showwhite
  5359. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  5360. @item gamma
  5361. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  5362. @end table
  5363. @section codecview
  5364. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  5365. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  5366. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  5367. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  5368. The filter accepts the following option:
  5369. @table @option
  5370. @item mv
  5371. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  5372. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  5373. @table @samp
  5374. @item pf
  5375. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  5376. @item bf
  5377. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5378. @item bb
  5379. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5380. @end table
  5381. @item qp
  5382. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  5383. @item mv_type, mvt
  5384. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  5385. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  5386. @table @samp
  5387. @item fp
  5388. forward predicted MVs
  5389. @item bp
  5390. backward predicted MVs
  5391. @end table
  5392. @item frame_type, ft
  5393. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  5394. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  5395. @table @samp
  5396. @item if
  5397. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  5398. @item pf
  5399. predicted frames (P-frames)
  5400. @item bf
  5401. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  5402. @end table
  5403. @end table
  5404. @subsection Examples
  5405. @itemize
  5406. @item
  5407. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5408. @example
  5409. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  5410. @end example
  5411. @item
  5412. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5413. @example
  5414. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  5415. @end example
  5416. @end itemize
  5417. @section colorbalance
  5418. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  5419. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  5420. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  5421. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  5422. value towards the complementary color.
  5423. The filter accepts the following options:
  5424. @table @option
  5425. @item rs
  5426. @item gs
  5427. @item bs
  5428. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  5429. @item rm
  5430. @item gm
  5431. @item bm
  5432. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  5433. @item rh
  5434. @item gh
  5435. @item bh
  5436. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  5437. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5438. @end table
  5439. @subsection Examples
  5440. @itemize
  5441. @item
  5442. Add red color cast to shadows:
  5443. @example
  5444. colorbalance=rs=.3
  5445. @end example
  5446. @end itemize
  5447. @section colorchannelmixer
  5448. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  5449. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  5450. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  5451. modify is red, the output value will be:
  5452. @example
  5453. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  5454. @end example
  5455. The filter accepts the following options:
  5456. @table @option
  5457. @item rr
  5458. @item rg
  5459. @item rb
  5460. @item ra
  5461. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  5462. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  5463. @item gr
  5464. @item gg
  5465. @item gb
  5466. @item ga
  5467. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  5468. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  5469. @item br
  5470. @item bg
  5471. @item bb
  5472. @item ba
  5473. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  5474. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  5475. @item ar
  5476. @item ag
  5477. @item ab
  5478. @item aa
  5479. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  5480. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  5481. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  5482. @end table
  5483. @subsection Examples
  5484. @itemize
  5485. @item
  5486. Convert source to grayscale:
  5487. @example
  5488. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  5489. @end example
  5490. @item
  5491. Simulate sepia tones:
  5492. @example
  5493. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  5494. @end example
  5495. @end itemize
  5496. @subsection Commands
  5497. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5498. @section colorkey
  5499. RGB colorspace color keying.
  5500. The filter accepts the following options:
  5501. @table @option
  5502. @item color
  5503. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5504. @item similarity
  5505. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5506. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5507. @item blend
  5508. Blend percentage.
  5509. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5510. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5511. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5512. @end table
  5513. @subsection Examples
  5514. @itemize
  5515. @item
  5516. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5517. @example
  5518. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  5519. @end example
  5520. @item
  5521. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  5522. @example
  5523. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  5524. @end example
  5525. @end itemize
  5526. @section colorhold
  5527. Remove all color information for all RGB colors except for certain one.
  5528. The filter accepts the following options:
  5529. @table @option
  5530. @item color
  5531. The color which will not be replaced with neutral gray.
  5532. @item similarity
  5533. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5534. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5535. @item blend
  5536. Blend percentage. 0.0 makes pixels fully gray.
  5537. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5538. @end table
  5539. @section colorlevels
  5540. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  5541. The filter accepts the following options:
  5542. @table @option
  5543. @item rimin
  5544. @item gimin
  5545. @item bimin
  5546. @item aimin
  5547. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  5548. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5549. @item rimax
  5550. @item gimax
  5551. @item bimax
  5552. @item aimax
  5553. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  5554. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5555. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  5556. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  5557. @item romin
  5558. @item gomin
  5559. @item bomin
  5560. @item aomin
  5561. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  5562. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5563. @item romax
  5564. @item gomax
  5565. @item bomax
  5566. @item aomax
  5567. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  5568. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5569. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  5570. @end table
  5571. @subsection Examples
  5572. @itemize
  5573. @item
  5574. Make video output darker:
  5575. @example
  5576. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  5577. @end example
  5578. @item
  5579. Increase contrast:
  5580. @example
  5581. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  5582. @end example
  5583. @item
  5584. Make video output lighter:
  5585. @example
  5586. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  5587. @end example
  5588. @item
  5589. Increase brightness:
  5590. @example
  5591. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  5592. @end example
  5593. @end itemize
  5594. @section colormatrix
  5595. Convert color matrix.
  5596. The filter accepts the following options:
  5597. @table @option
  5598. @item src
  5599. @item dst
  5600. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  5601. specified.
  5602. The accepted values are:
  5603. @table @samp
  5604. @item bt709
  5605. BT.709
  5606. @item fcc
  5607. FCC
  5608. @item bt601
  5609. BT.601
  5610. @item bt470
  5611. BT.470
  5612. @item bt470bg
  5613. BT.470BG
  5614. @item smpte170m
  5615. SMPTE-170M
  5616. @item smpte240m
  5617. SMPTE-240M
  5618. @item bt2020
  5619. BT.2020
  5620. @end table
  5621. @end table
  5622. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5623. @example
  5624. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  5625. @end example
  5626. @section colorspace
  5627. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  5628. Input video needs to have an even size.
  5629. The filter accepts the following options:
  5630. @table @option
  5631. @anchor{all}
  5632. @item all
  5633. Specify all color properties at once.
  5634. The accepted values are:
  5635. @table @samp
  5636. @item bt470m
  5637. BT.470M
  5638. @item bt470bg
  5639. BT.470BG
  5640. @item bt601-6-525
  5641. BT.601-6 525
  5642. @item bt601-6-625
  5643. BT.601-6 625
  5644. @item bt709
  5645. BT.709
  5646. @item smpte170m
  5647. SMPTE-170M
  5648. @item smpte240m
  5649. SMPTE-240M
  5650. @item bt2020
  5651. BT.2020
  5652. @end table
  5653. @anchor{space}
  5654. @item space
  5655. Specify output colorspace.
  5656. The accepted values are:
  5657. @table @samp
  5658. @item bt709
  5659. BT.709
  5660. @item fcc
  5661. FCC
  5662. @item bt470bg
  5663. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5664. @item smpte170m
  5665. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5666. @item smpte240m
  5667. SMPTE-240M
  5668. @item ycgco
  5669. YCgCo
  5670. @item bt2020ncl
  5671. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  5672. @end table
  5673. @anchor{trc}
  5674. @item trc
  5675. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  5676. The accepted values are:
  5677. @table @samp
  5678. @item bt709
  5679. BT.709
  5680. @item bt470m
  5681. BT.470M
  5682. @item bt470bg
  5683. BT.470BG
  5684. @item gamma22
  5685. Constant gamma of 2.2
  5686. @item gamma28
  5687. Constant gamma of 2.8
  5688. @item smpte170m
  5689. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  5690. @item smpte240m
  5691. SMPTE-240M
  5692. @item srgb
  5693. SRGB
  5694. @item iec61966-2-1
  5695. iec61966-2-1
  5696. @item iec61966-2-4
  5697. iec61966-2-4
  5698. @item xvycc
  5699. xvycc
  5700. @item bt2020-10
  5701. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  5702. @item bt2020-12
  5703. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  5704. @end table
  5705. @anchor{primaries}
  5706. @item primaries
  5707. Specify output color primaries.
  5708. The accepted values are:
  5709. @table @samp
  5710. @item bt709
  5711. BT.709
  5712. @item bt470m
  5713. BT.470M
  5714. @item bt470bg
  5715. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5716. @item smpte170m
  5717. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5718. @item smpte240m
  5719. SMPTE-240M
  5720. @item film
  5721. film
  5722. @item smpte431
  5723. SMPTE-431
  5724. @item smpte432
  5725. SMPTE-432
  5726. @item bt2020
  5727. BT.2020
  5728. @item jedec-p22
  5729. JEDEC P22 phosphors
  5730. @end table
  5731. @anchor{range}
  5732. @item range
  5733. Specify output color range.
  5734. The accepted values are:
  5735. @table @samp
  5736. @item tv
  5737. TV (restricted) range
  5738. @item mpeg
  5739. MPEG (restricted) range
  5740. @item pc
  5741. PC (full) range
  5742. @item jpeg
  5743. JPEG (full) range
  5744. @end table
  5745. @item format
  5746. Specify output color format.
  5747. The accepted values are:
  5748. @table @samp
  5749. @item yuv420p
  5750. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  5751. @item yuv420p10
  5752. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  5753. @item yuv420p12
  5754. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  5755. @item yuv422p
  5756. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  5757. @item yuv422p10
  5758. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  5759. @item yuv422p12
  5760. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  5761. @item yuv444p
  5762. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  5763. @item yuv444p10
  5764. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  5765. @item yuv444p12
  5766. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  5767. @end table
  5768. @item fast
  5769. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  5770. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  5771. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  5772. @item dither
  5773. Specify dithering mode.
  5774. The accepted values are:
  5775. @table @samp
  5776. @item none
  5777. No dithering
  5778. @item fsb
  5779. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  5780. @end table
  5781. @item wpadapt
  5782. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  5783. The accepted values are:
  5784. @table @samp
  5785. @item bradford
  5786. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  5787. @item vonkries
  5788. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  5789. @item identity
  5790. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  5791. @end table
  5792. @item iall
  5793. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  5794. @item ispace
  5795. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  5796. @item iprimaries
  5797. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  5798. @item itrc
  5799. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  5800. @item irange
  5801. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  5802. @end table
  5803. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  5804. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  5805. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  5806. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  5807. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  5808. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  5809. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  5810. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  5811. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5812. @example
  5813. colorspace=smpte240m
  5814. @end example
  5815. @section convolution
  5816. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 or horizontal/vertical up to 49 elements.
  5817. The filter accepts the following options:
  5818. @table @option
  5819. @item 0m
  5820. @item 1m
  5821. @item 2m
  5822. @item 3m
  5823. Set matrix for each plane.
  5824. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed integers in @var{square} mode,
  5825. and from 1 to 49 odd number of signed integers in @var{row} mode.
  5826. @item 0rdiv
  5827. @item 1rdiv
  5828. @item 2rdiv
  5829. @item 3rdiv
  5830. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  5831. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  5832. @item 0bias
  5833. @item 1bias
  5834. @item 2bias
  5835. @item 3bias
  5836. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  5837. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  5838. @item 0mode
  5839. @item 1mode
  5840. @item 2mode
  5841. @item 3mode
  5842. Set matrix mode for each plane. Can be @var{square}, @var{row} or @var{column}.
  5843. Default is @var{square}.
  5844. @end table
  5845. @subsection Examples
  5846. @itemize
  5847. @item
  5848. Apply sharpen:
  5849. @example
  5850. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  5851. @end example
  5852. @item
  5853. Apply blur:
  5854. @example
  5855. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  5856. @end example
  5857. @item
  5858. Apply edge enhance:
  5859. @example
  5860. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  5861. @end example
  5862. @item
  5863. Apply edge detect:
  5864. @example
  5865. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  5866. @end example
  5867. @item
  5868. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  5869. @example
  5870. convolution="1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0"
  5871. @end example
  5872. @item
  5873. Apply emboss:
  5874. @example
  5875. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  5876. @end example
  5877. @end itemize
  5878. @section convolve
  5879. Apply 2D convolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  5880. as impulse.
  5881. The filter accepts the following options:
  5882. @table @option
  5883. @item planes
  5884. Set which planes to process.
  5885. @item impulse
  5886. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  5887. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  5888. @end table
  5889. The @code{convolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5890. @section copy
  5891. Copy the input video source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  5892. testing purposes.
  5893. @anchor{coreimage}
  5894. @section coreimage
  5895. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  5896. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  5897. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  5898. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  5899. the respective OSX.
  5900. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  5901. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  5902. with its options.
  5903. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  5904. @table @option
  5905. @item list_filters
  5906. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  5907. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  5908. values.
  5909. @example
  5910. list_filters=true
  5911. @end example
  5912. @item filter
  5913. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  5914. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  5915. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  5916. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  5917. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  5918. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  5919. filter.
  5920. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  5921. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  5922. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  5923. @example
  5924. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  5925. @end example
  5926. @item output_rect
  5927. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  5928. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  5929. @example
  5930. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  5931. @end example
  5932. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  5933. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  5934. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  5935. @example
  5936. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  5937. @end example
  5938. @end table
  5939. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  5940. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  5941. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  5942. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  5943. usable as intended.
  5944. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  5945. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  5946. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  5947. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  5948. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  5949. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  5950. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  5951. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  5952. output image.
  5953. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  5954. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  5955. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  5956. @subsection Examples
  5957. @itemize
  5958. @item
  5959. List all filters available:
  5960. @example
  5961. coreimage=list_filters=true
  5962. @end example
  5963. @item
  5964. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  5965. @example
  5966. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  5967. @end example
  5968. @item
  5969. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  5970. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  5971. @example
  5972. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  5973. @end example
  5974. @item
  5975. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  5976. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  5977. @example
  5978. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  5979. @end example
  5980. @end itemize
  5981. @section cover_rect
  5982. Cover a rectangular object
  5983. It accepts the following options:
  5984. @table @option
  5985. @item cover
  5986. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  5987. @item mode
  5988. Set covering mode.
  5989. It accepts the following values:
  5990. @table @samp
  5991. @item cover
  5992. cover it by the supplied image
  5993. @item blur
  5994. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  5995. @end table
  5996. Default value is @var{blur}.
  5997. @end table
  5998. @subsection Examples
  5999. @itemize
  6000. @item
  6001. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6002. @example
  6003. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6004. @end example
  6005. @end itemize
  6006. @section crop
  6007. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  6008. It accepts the following parameters:
  6009. @table @option
  6010. @item w, out_w
  6011. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  6012. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6013. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  6014. @item h, out_h
  6015. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  6016. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6017. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  6018. @item x
  6019. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  6020. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  6021. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6022. @item y
  6023. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  6024. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  6025. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6026. @item keep_aspect
  6027. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  6028. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  6029. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  6030. @item exact
  6031. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  6032. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  6033. It defaults to 0.
  6034. @end table
  6035. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  6036. expressions containing the following constants:
  6037. @table @option
  6038. @item x
  6039. @item y
  6040. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  6041. each new frame.
  6042. @item in_w
  6043. @item in_h
  6044. The input width and height.
  6045. @item iw
  6046. @item ih
  6047. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  6048. @item out_w
  6049. @item out_h
  6050. The output (cropped) width and height.
  6051. @item ow
  6052. @item oh
  6053. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6054. @item a
  6055. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  6056. @item sar
  6057. input sample aspect ratio
  6058. @item dar
  6059. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  6060. @item hsub
  6061. @item vsub
  6062. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6063. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6064. @item n
  6065. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  6066. @item pos
  6067. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  6068. @item t
  6069. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  6070. @end table
  6071. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  6072. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  6073. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  6074. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6075. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  6076. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  6077. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  6078. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  6079. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  6080. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  6081. @subsection Examples
  6082. @itemize
  6083. @item
  6084. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  6085. @example
  6086. crop=100:100:12:34
  6087. @end example
  6088. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  6089. @example
  6090. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  6091. @end example
  6092. @item
  6093. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  6094. @example
  6095. crop=100:100
  6096. @end example
  6097. @item
  6098. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  6099. @example
  6100. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  6101. @end example
  6102. @item
  6103. Crop the input video central square:
  6104. @example
  6105. crop=out_w=in_h
  6106. crop=in_h
  6107. @end example
  6108. @item
  6109. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  6110. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  6111. corner of the input image.
  6112. @example
  6113. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  6114. @end example
  6115. @item
  6116. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  6117. the top and bottom borders
  6118. @example
  6119. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  6120. @end example
  6121. @item
  6122. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  6123. @example
  6124. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  6125. @end example
  6126. @item
  6127. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  6128. @example
  6129. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  6130. @end example
  6131. @item
  6132. Apply trembling effect:
  6133. @example
  6134. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  6135. @end example
  6136. @item
  6137. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  6138. @example
  6139. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  6140. @end example
  6141. @item
  6142. Set x depending on the value of y:
  6143. @example
  6144. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  6145. @end example
  6146. @end itemize
  6147. @subsection Commands
  6148. This filter supports the following commands:
  6149. @table @option
  6150. @item w, out_w
  6151. @item h, out_h
  6152. @item x
  6153. @item y
  6154. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  6155. in the input video.
  6156. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6157. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6158. value.
  6159. @end table
  6160. @section cropdetect
  6161. Auto-detect the crop size.
  6162. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  6163. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  6164. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  6165. It accepts the following parameters:
  6166. @table @option
  6167. @item limit
  6168. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  6169. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  6170. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  6171. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  6172. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  6173. @item round
  6174. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  6175. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  6176. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  6177. encoding to most video codecs.
  6178. @item reset_count, reset
  6179. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  6180. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  6181. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  6182. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  6183. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  6184. playback.
  6185. @end table
  6186. @anchor{cue}
  6187. @section cue
  6188. Delay video filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. The filter first
  6189. passes on @option{preroll} amount of frames, then it buffers at most
  6190. @option{buffer} amount of frames and waits for the cue. After reaching the cue
  6191. it forwards the buffered frames and also any subsequent frames coming in its
  6192. input.
  6193. The filter can be used synchronize the output of multiple ffmpeg processes for
  6194. realtime output devices like decklink. By putting the delay in the filtering
  6195. chain and pre-buffering frames the process can pass on data to output almost
  6196. immediately after the target wallclock timestamp is reached.
  6197. Perfect frame accuracy cannot be guaranteed, but the result is good enough for
  6198. some use cases.
  6199. @table @option
  6200. @item cue
  6201. The cue timestamp expressed in a UNIX timestamp in microseconds. Default is 0.
  6202. @item preroll
  6203. The duration of content to pass on as preroll expressed in seconds. Default is 0.
  6204. @item buffer
  6205. The maximum duration of content to buffer before waiting for the cue expressed
  6206. in seconds. Default is 0.
  6207. @end table
  6208. @anchor{curves}
  6209. @section curves
  6210. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  6211. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  6212. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  6213. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  6214. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  6215. the output frame.
  6216. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  6217. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  6218. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  6219. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  6220. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  6221. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  6222. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  6223. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  6224. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  6225. The filter accepts the following options:
  6226. @table @option
  6227. @item preset
  6228. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  6229. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  6230. options takes priority on the preset values.
  6231. Available presets are:
  6232. @table @samp
  6233. @item none
  6234. @item color_negative
  6235. @item cross_process
  6236. @item darker
  6237. @item increase_contrast
  6238. @item lighter
  6239. @item linear_contrast
  6240. @item medium_contrast
  6241. @item negative
  6242. @item strong_contrast
  6243. @item vintage
  6244. @end table
  6245. Default is @code{none}.
  6246. @item master, m
  6247. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  6248. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  6249. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  6250. post-processing LUT.
  6251. @item red, r
  6252. Set the key points for the red component.
  6253. @item green, g
  6254. Set the key points for the green component.
  6255. @item blue, b
  6256. Set the key points for the blue component.
  6257. @item all
  6258. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  6259. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  6260. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  6261. @option{all} setting.
  6262. @item psfile
  6263. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  6264. @item plot
  6265. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  6266. @end table
  6267. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  6268. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  6269. @subsection Examples
  6270. @itemize
  6271. @item
  6272. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  6273. @example
  6274. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  6275. @end example
  6276. @item
  6277. Vintage effect:
  6278. @example
  6279. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  6280. @end example
  6281. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  6282. @table @var
  6283. @item red
  6284. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  6285. @item green
  6286. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  6287. @item blue
  6288. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  6289. @end table
  6290. @item
  6291. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  6292. @example
  6293. curves=preset=vintage
  6294. @end example
  6295. @item
  6296. Or simply:
  6297. @example
  6298. curves=vintage
  6299. @end example
  6300. @item
  6301. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  6302. @example
  6303. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  6304. @end example
  6305. @item
  6306. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  6307. and @command{gnuplot}:
  6308. @example
  6309. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  6310. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  6311. @end example
  6312. @end itemize
  6313. @section datascope
  6314. Video data analysis filter.
  6315. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  6316. The filter accepts the following options:
  6317. @table @option
  6318. @item size, s
  6319. Set output video size.
  6320. @item x
  6321. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  6322. @item y
  6323. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  6324. @item mode
  6325. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  6326. @table @samp
  6327. @item mono
  6328. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  6329. @item color
  6330. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  6331. background.
  6332. @item color2
  6333. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  6334. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  6335. @end table
  6336. @item axis
  6337. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  6338. @item opacity
  6339. Set background opacity.
  6340. @end table
  6341. @section dctdnoiz
  6342. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  6343. This filter is not designed for real time.
  6344. The filter accepts the following options:
  6345. @table @option
  6346. @item sigma, s
  6347. Set the noise sigma constant.
  6348. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  6349. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  6350. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  6351. Default is @code{0}.
  6352. @item overlap
  6353. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  6354. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  6355. risk of various artefacts.
  6356. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  6357. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  6358. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  6359. @item expr, e
  6360. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  6361. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  6362. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  6363. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  6364. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  6365. variable.
  6366. @item n
  6367. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  6368. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  6369. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  6370. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  6371. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  6372. better de-noising.
  6373. @end table
  6374. @subsection Examples
  6375. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  6376. @example
  6377. dctdnoiz=4.5
  6378. @end example
  6379. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  6380. @example
  6381. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  6382. @end example
  6383. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  6384. @example
  6385. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  6386. @end example
  6387. @section deband
  6388. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  6389. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  6390. The filter accepts the following options:
  6391. @table @option
  6392. @item 1thr
  6393. @item 2thr
  6394. @item 3thr
  6395. @item 4thr
  6396. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  6397. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  6398. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  6399. it will be considered as banded.
  6400. @item range, r
  6401. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  6402. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  6403. will be used.
  6404. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  6405. @item direction, d
  6406. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  6407. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  6408. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  6409. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  6410. column.
  6411. @item blur, b
  6412. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  6413. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  6414. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  6415. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  6416. @item coupling, c
  6417. If enabled, current pixel is changed if and only if all pixel components are banded,
  6418. e.g. banding detection threshold is triggered for all color components.
  6419. The default is disabled.
  6420. @end table
  6421. @section deblock
  6422. Remove blocking artifacts from input video.
  6423. The filter accepts the following options:
  6424. @table @option
  6425. @item filter
  6426. Set filter type, can be @var{weak} or @var{strong}. Default is @var{strong}.
  6427. This controls what kind of deblocking is applied.
  6428. @item block
  6429. Set size of block, allowed range is from 4 to 512. Default is @var{8}.
  6430. @item alpha
  6431. @item beta
  6432. @item gamma
  6433. @item delta
  6434. Set blocking detection thresholds. Allowed range is 0 to 1.
  6435. Defaults are: @var{0.098} for @var{alpha} and @var{0.05} for the rest.
  6436. Using higher threshold gives more deblocking strength.
  6437. Setting @var{alpha} controls threshold detection at exact edge of block.
  6438. Remaining options controls threshold detection near the edge. Each one for
  6439. below/above or left/right. Setting any of those to @var{0} disables
  6440. deblocking.
  6441. @item planes
  6442. Set planes to filter. Default is to filter all available planes.
  6443. @end table
  6444. @subsection Examples
  6445. @itemize
  6446. @item
  6447. Deblock using weak filter and block size of 4 pixels.
  6448. @example
  6449. deblock=filter=weak:block=4
  6450. @end example
  6451. @item
  6452. Deblock using strong filter, block size of 4 pixels and custom thresholds for
  6453. deblocking more edges.
  6454. @example
  6455. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05
  6456. @end example
  6457. @item
  6458. Similar as above, but filter only first plane.
  6459. @example
  6460. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=1
  6461. @end example
  6462. @item
  6463. Similar as above, but filter only second and third plane.
  6464. @example
  6465. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=6
  6466. @end example
  6467. @end itemize
  6468. @anchor{decimate}
  6469. @section decimate
  6470. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  6471. The filter accepts the following options:
  6472. @table @option
  6473. @item cycle
  6474. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  6475. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  6476. Default is @code{5}.
  6477. @item dupthresh
  6478. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  6479. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  6480. is @code{1.1}
  6481. @item scthresh
  6482. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  6483. @item blockx
  6484. @item blocky
  6485. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  6486. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  6487. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  6488. @item ppsrc
  6489. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  6490. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  6491. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  6492. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  6493. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  6494. @code{0}.
  6495. @item chroma
  6496. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  6497. @code{1}.
  6498. @end table
  6499. @section deconvolve
  6500. Apply 2D deconvolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6501. as impulse.
  6502. The filter accepts the following options:
  6503. @table @option
  6504. @item planes
  6505. Set which planes to process.
  6506. @item impulse
  6507. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6508. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6509. @item noise
  6510. Set noise when doing divisions. Default is @var{0.0000001}. Useful when width
  6511. and height are not same and not power of 2 or if stream prior to convolving
  6512. had noise.
  6513. @end table
  6514. The @code{deconvolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6515. @section dedot
  6516. Reduce cross-luminance (dot-crawl) and cross-color (rainbows) from video.
  6517. It accepts the following options:
  6518. @table @option
  6519. @item m
  6520. Set mode of operation. Can be combination of @var{dotcrawl} for cross-luminance reduction and/or
  6521. @var{rainbows} for cross-color reduction.
  6522. @item lt
  6523. Set spatial luma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6524. @item tl
  6525. Set tolerance for temporal luma. Higher values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6526. @item tc
  6527. Set tolerance for chroma temporal variation. Higher values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6528. @item ct
  6529. Set temporal chroma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6530. @end table
  6531. @section deflate
  6532. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  6533. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6534. only values lower than the pixel.
  6535. It accepts the following options:
  6536. @table @option
  6537. @item threshold0
  6538. @item threshold1
  6539. @item threshold2
  6540. @item threshold3
  6541. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6542. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6543. @end table
  6544. @section deflicker
  6545. Remove temporal frame luminance variations.
  6546. It accepts the following options:
  6547. @table @option
  6548. @item size, s
  6549. Set moving-average filter size in frames. Default is 5. Allowed range is 2 - 129.
  6550. @item mode, m
  6551. Set averaging mode to smooth temporal luminance variations.
  6552. Available values are:
  6553. @table @samp
  6554. @item am
  6555. Arithmetic mean
  6556. @item gm
  6557. Geometric mean
  6558. @item hm
  6559. Harmonic mean
  6560. @item qm
  6561. Quadratic mean
  6562. @item cm
  6563. Cubic mean
  6564. @item pm
  6565. Power mean
  6566. @item median
  6567. Median
  6568. @end table
  6569. @item bypass
  6570. Do not actually modify frame. Useful when one only wants metadata.
  6571. @end table
  6572. @section dejudder
  6573. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  6574. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  6575. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  6576. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  6577. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  6578. rate video.
  6579. The option available in this filter is:
  6580. @table @option
  6581. @item cycle
  6582. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  6583. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  6584. @table @samp
  6585. @item 4
  6586. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  6587. @item 5
  6588. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  6589. @item 20
  6590. If a mixture of the two.
  6591. @end table
  6592. The default is @samp{4}.
  6593. @end table
  6594. @section delogo
  6595. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  6596. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  6597. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  6598. It accepts the following parameters:
  6599. @table @option
  6600. @item x
  6601. @item y
  6602. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  6603. specified.
  6604. @item w
  6605. @item h
  6606. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  6607. specified.
  6608. @item band, t
  6609. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  6610. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  6611. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  6612. is not recommended.
  6613. @item show
  6614. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  6615. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  6616. The default value is 0.
  6617. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  6618. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  6619. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  6620. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  6621. @end table
  6622. @subsection Examples
  6623. @itemize
  6624. @item
  6625. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  6626. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  6627. @example
  6628. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  6629. @end example
  6630. @end itemize
  6631. @section derain
  6632. Remove the rain in the input image/video by applying the derain methods based on
  6633. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  6634. @itemize
  6635. @item
  6636. Recurrent Squeeze-and-Excitation Context Aggregation Net (RESCAN).
  6637. See @url{http://openaccess.thecvf.com/content_ECCV_2018/papers/Xia_Li_Recurrent_Squeeze-and-Excitation_Context_ECCV_2018_paper.pdf}.
  6638. @end itemize
  6639. Training as well as model generation scripts are provided in
  6640. the repository at @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/derain_filter.git}.
  6641. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  6642. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6643. The filter accepts the following options:
  6644. @table @option
  6645. @item filter_type
  6646. Specify which filter to use. This option accepts the following values:
  6647. @table @samp
  6648. @item derain
  6649. Derain filter. To conduct derain filter, you need to use a derain model.
  6650. @item dehaze
  6651. Dehaze filter. To conduct dehaze filter, you need to use a dehaze model.
  6652. @end table
  6653. Default value is @samp{derain}.
  6654. @item dnn_backend
  6655. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6656. the following values:
  6657. @table @samp
  6658. @item native
  6659. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6660. @item tensorflow
  6661. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6662. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6663. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6664. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6665. @end table
  6666. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6667. @item model
  6668. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6669. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6670. backend can load files for only its format.
  6671. @end table
  6672. @section deshake
  6673. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  6674. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  6675. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  6676. The filter accepts the following options:
  6677. @table @option
  6678. @item x
  6679. @item y
  6680. @item w
  6681. @item h
  6682. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  6683. vectors.
  6684. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  6685. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  6686. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  6687. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  6688. box.
  6689. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  6690. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  6691. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  6692. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  6693. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  6694. Default - search the whole frame.
  6695. @item rx
  6696. @item ry
  6697. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  6698. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  6699. @item edge
  6700. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  6701. frame. Available values are:
  6702. @table @samp
  6703. @item blank, 0
  6704. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  6705. @item original, 1
  6706. Original image at blank locations
  6707. @item clamp, 2
  6708. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  6709. @item mirror, 3
  6710. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  6711. @end table
  6712. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  6713. @item blocksize
  6714. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  6715. default 8.
  6716. @item contrast
  6717. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  6718. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  6719. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  6720. @item search
  6721. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  6722. @table @samp
  6723. @item exhaustive, 0
  6724. Set exhaustive search
  6725. @item less, 1
  6726. Set less exhaustive search.
  6727. @end table
  6728. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  6729. @item filename
  6730. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  6731. specified file.
  6732. @end table
  6733. @section despill
  6734. Remove unwanted contamination of foreground colors, caused by reflected color of
  6735. greenscreen or bluescreen.
  6736. This filter accepts the following options:
  6737. @table @option
  6738. @item type
  6739. Set what type of despill to use.
  6740. @item mix
  6741. Set how spillmap will be generated.
  6742. @item expand
  6743. Set how much to get rid of still remaining spill.
  6744. @item red
  6745. Controls amount of red in spill area.
  6746. @item green
  6747. Controls amount of green in spill area.
  6748. Should be -1 for greenscreen.
  6749. @item blue
  6750. Controls amount of blue in spill area.
  6751. Should be -1 for bluescreen.
  6752. @item brightness
  6753. Controls brightness of spill area, preserving colors.
  6754. @item alpha
  6755. Modify alpha from generated spillmap.
  6756. @end table
  6757. @section detelecine
  6758. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  6759. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  6760. to the telecine filter.
  6761. This filter accepts the following options:
  6762. @table @option
  6763. @item first_field
  6764. @table @samp
  6765. @item top, t
  6766. top field first
  6767. @item bottom, b
  6768. bottom field first
  6769. The default value is @code{top}.
  6770. @end table
  6771. @item pattern
  6772. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  6773. The default value is @code{23}.
  6774. @item start_frame
  6775. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  6776. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  6777. @end table
  6778. @section dilation
  6779. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  6780. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  6781. It accepts the following options:
  6782. @table @option
  6783. @item threshold0
  6784. @item threshold1
  6785. @item threshold2
  6786. @item threshold3
  6787. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6788. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6789. @item coordinates
  6790. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  6791. pixels are used.
  6792. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  6793. 1 2 3
  6794. 4 5
  6795. 6 7 8
  6796. @end table
  6797. @section displace
  6798. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  6799. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  6800. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  6801. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  6802. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  6803. along the y-axis.
  6804. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  6805. displacement map will be used.
  6806. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  6807. A description of the accepted options follows.
  6808. @table @option
  6809. @item edge
  6810. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  6811. Available values are:
  6812. @table @samp
  6813. @item blank
  6814. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  6815. @item smear
  6816. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  6817. @item wrap
  6818. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  6819. @item mirror
  6820. Out of range pixels will be replaced with mirrored pixels.
  6821. @end table
  6822. Default is @samp{smear}.
  6823. @end table
  6824. @subsection Examples
  6825. @itemize
  6826. @item
  6827. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  6828. @example
  6829. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  6830. @end example
  6831. @item
  6832. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  6833. @example
  6834. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  6835. @end example
  6836. @end itemize
  6837. @section drawbox
  6838. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  6839. It accepts the following parameters:
  6840. @table @option
  6841. @item x
  6842. @item y
  6843. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  6844. @item width, w
  6845. @item height, h
  6846. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  6847. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  6848. @item color, c
  6849. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  6850. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  6851. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  6852. video with inverted luma.
  6853. @item thickness, t
  6854. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge.
  6855. A value of @code{fill} will create a filled box. Default value is @code{3}.
  6856. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  6857. @item replace
  6858. Applicable if the input has alpha. With value @code{1}, the pixels of the painted box
  6859. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  6860. Default is @code{0}, which composites the box onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  6861. @end table
  6862. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  6863. following constants:
  6864. @table @option
  6865. @item dar
  6866. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  6867. @item hsub
  6868. @item vsub
  6869. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6870. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6871. @item in_h, ih
  6872. @item in_w, iw
  6873. The input width and height.
  6874. @item sar
  6875. The input sample aspect ratio.
  6876. @item x
  6877. @item y
  6878. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  6879. @item w
  6880. @item h
  6881. The width and height of the drawn box.
  6882. @item t
  6883. The thickness of the drawn box.
  6884. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  6885. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  6886. @end table
  6887. @subsection Examples
  6888. @itemize
  6889. @item
  6890. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  6891. @example
  6892. drawbox
  6893. @end example
  6894. @item
  6895. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  6896. @example
  6897. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  6898. @end example
  6899. The previous example can be specified as:
  6900. @example
  6901. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  6902. @end example
  6903. @item
  6904. Fill the box with pink color:
  6905. @example
  6906. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=fill
  6907. @end example
  6908. @item
  6909. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  6910. @example
  6911. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  6912. @end example
  6913. @end itemize
  6914. @subsection Commands
  6915. This filter supports same commands as options.
  6916. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6917. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6918. value.
  6919. @section drawgrid
  6920. Draw a grid on the input image.
  6921. It accepts the following parameters:
  6922. @table @option
  6923. @item x
  6924. @item y
  6925. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  6926. @item width, w
  6927. @item height, h
  6928. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  6929. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  6930. framed. Default to 0.
  6931. @item color, c
  6932. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  6933. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  6934. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  6935. video with inverted luma.
  6936. @item thickness, t
  6937. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  6938. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  6939. @item replace
  6940. Applicable if the input has alpha. With @code{1} the pixels of the painted grid
  6941. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  6942. Default is @code{0}, which composites the grid onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  6943. @end table
  6944. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  6945. following constants:
  6946. @table @option
  6947. @item dar
  6948. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  6949. @item hsub
  6950. @item vsub
  6951. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6952. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6953. @item in_h, ih
  6954. @item in_w, iw
  6955. The input grid cell width and height.
  6956. @item sar
  6957. The input sample aspect ratio.
  6958. @item x
  6959. @item y
  6960. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  6961. @item w
  6962. @item h
  6963. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  6964. @item t
  6965. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  6966. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  6967. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  6968. @end table
  6969. @subsection Examples
  6970. @itemize
  6971. @item
  6972. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  6973. @example
  6974. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  6975. @end example
  6976. @item
  6977. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  6978. @example
  6979. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  6980. @end example
  6981. @end itemize
  6982. @subsection Commands
  6983. This filter supports same commands as options.
  6984. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6985. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6986. value.
  6987. @anchor{drawtext}
  6988. @section drawtext
  6989. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  6990. libfreetype library.
  6991. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  6992. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  6993. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  6994. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  6995. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  6996. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  6997. @subsection Syntax
  6998. It accepts the following parameters:
  6999. @table @option
  7000. @item box
  7001. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  7002. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  7003. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  7004. @item boxborderw
  7005. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  7006. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  7007. @item boxcolor
  7008. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  7009. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7010. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  7011. @item line_spacing
  7012. Set the line spacing in pixels of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{box}.
  7013. The default value of @var{line_spacing} is 0.
  7014. @item borderw
  7015. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  7016. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  7017. @item bordercolor
  7018. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  7019. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7020. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  7021. @item expansion
  7022. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  7023. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  7024. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  7025. below for details.
  7026. @item basetime
  7027. Set a start time for the count. Value is in microseconds. Only applied
  7028. in the deprecated strftime expansion mode. To emulate in normal expansion
  7029. mode use the @code{pts} function, supplying the start time (in seconds)
  7030. as the second argument.
  7031. @item fix_bounds
  7032. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  7033. @item fontcolor
  7034. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  7035. the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7036. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  7037. @item fontcolor_expr
  7038. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  7039. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  7040. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  7041. @item font
  7042. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  7043. @item fontfile
  7044. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  7045. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  7046. @item alpha
  7047. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  7048. be a number between 0.0 and 1.0.
  7049. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} as well.
  7050. The default value is 1.
  7051. Please see @var{fontcolor_expr}.
  7052. @item fontsize
  7053. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  7054. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  7055. @item text_shaping
  7056. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  7057. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  7058. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  7059. By default 1 (if supported).
  7060. @item ft_load_flags
  7061. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  7062. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  7063. a combination of the following values:
  7064. @table @var
  7065. @item default
  7066. @item no_scale
  7067. @item no_hinting
  7068. @item render
  7069. @item no_bitmap
  7070. @item vertical_layout
  7071. @item force_autohint
  7072. @item crop_bitmap
  7073. @item pedantic
  7074. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  7075. @item no_recurse
  7076. @item ignore_transform
  7077. @item monochrome
  7078. @item linear_design
  7079. @item no_autohint
  7080. @end table
  7081. Default value is "default".
  7082. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  7083. libfreetype flags.
  7084. @item shadowcolor
  7085. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  7086. syntax of this option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  7087. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7088. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  7089. @item shadowx
  7090. @item shadowy
  7091. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  7092. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  7093. values. The default value for both is "0".
  7094. @item start_number
  7095. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  7096. is "0".
  7097. @item tabsize
  7098. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  7099. Default value is 4.
  7100. @item timecode
  7101. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  7102. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  7103. option must be specified.
  7104. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  7105. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only). Value will be rounded to nearest
  7106. integer. Minimum value is "1".
  7107. Drop-frame timecode is supported for frame rates 30 & 60.
  7108. @item tc24hmax
  7109. If set to 1, the output of the timecode option will wrap around at 24 hours.
  7110. Default is 0 (disabled).
  7111. @item text
  7112. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  7113. encoded characters.
  7114. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  7115. @var{textfile}.
  7116. @item textfile
  7117. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  7118. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  7119. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  7120. parameter @var{text}.
  7121. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  7122. @item reload
  7123. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  7124. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  7125. @item x
  7126. @item y
  7127. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  7128. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  7129. output image.
  7130. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  7131. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  7132. @end table
  7133. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  7134. following constants and functions:
  7135. @table @option
  7136. @item dar
  7137. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  7138. @item hsub
  7139. @item vsub
  7140. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7141. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7142. @item line_h, lh
  7143. the height of each text line
  7144. @item main_h, h, H
  7145. the input height
  7146. @item main_w, w, W
  7147. the input width
  7148. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  7149. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  7150. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  7151. glyphs.
  7152. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  7153. upwards.
  7154. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  7155. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  7156. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  7157. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  7158. upwards.
  7159. @item max_glyph_h
  7160. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  7161. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  7162. @var{descent}.
  7163. @item max_glyph_w
  7164. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  7165. contained in the rendered text
  7166. @item n
  7167. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7168. @item rand(min, max)
  7169. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  7170. @item sar
  7171. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7172. @item t
  7173. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7174. @item text_h, th
  7175. the height of the rendered text
  7176. @item text_w, tw
  7177. the width of the rendered text
  7178. @item x
  7179. @item y
  7180. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  7181. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  7182. to each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  7183. @item pict_type
  7184. A one character description of the current frame's picture type.
  7185. @item pkt_pos
  7186. The current packet's position in the input file or stream
  7187. (in bytes, from the start of the input). A value of -1 indicates
  7188. this info is not available.
  7189. @item pkt_duration
  7190. The current packet's duration, in seconds.
  7191. @item pkt_size
  7192. The current packet's size (in bytes).
  7193. @end table
  7194. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  7195. @subsection Text expansion
  7196. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  7197. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  7198. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  7199. feature is deprecated.
  7200. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  7201. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  7202. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  7203. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  7204. the second character.
  7205. Sequences of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  7206. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  7207. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  7208. they should be escaped.
  7209. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  7210. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  7211. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  7212. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  7213. problems.
  7214. The following functions are available:
  7215. @table @command
  7216. @item expr, e
  7217. The expression evaluation result.
  7218. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  7219. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  7220. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  7221. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  7222. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  7223. value.
  7224. @item expr_int_format, eif
  7225. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  7226. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  7227. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  7228. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  7229. @code{printf} function.
  7230. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  7231. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  7232. @item gmtime
  7233. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  7234. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7235. @item localtime
  7236. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  7237. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7238. @item metadata
  7239. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  7240. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  7241. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  7242. metadata key is not found or empty.
  7243. Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries
  7244. starting with TAG included within each frame section
  7245. printed by running @code{ffprobe -show_frames}.
  7246. String metadata generated in filters leading to
  7247. the drawtext filter are also available.
  7248. @item n, frame_num
  7249. The frame number, starting from 0.
  7250. @item pict_type
  7251. A one character description of the current picture type.
  7252. @item pts
  7253. The timestamp of the current frame.
  7254. It can take up to three arguments.
  7255. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  7256. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  7257. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  7258. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  7259. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  7260. local time zone time.
  7261. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  7262. If the format is set to @code{hms}, a third argument @code{24HH} may be
  7263. supplied to present the hour part of the formatted timestamp in 24h format
  7264. (00-23).
  7265. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  7266. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  7267. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  7268. @end table
  7269. @subsection Commands
  7270. This filter supports altering parameters via commands:
  7271. @table @option
  7272. @item reinit
  7273. Alter existing filter parameters.
  7274. Syntax for the argument is the same as for filter invocation, e.g.
  7275. @example
  7276. fontsize=56:fontcolor=green:text='Hello World'
  7277. @end example
  7278. Full filter invocation with sendcmd would look like this:
  7279. @example
  7280. sendcmd=c='56.0 drawtext reinit fontsize=56\:fontcolor=green\:text=Hello\\ World'
  7281. @end example
  7282. @end table
  7283. If the entire argument can't be parsed or applied as valid values then the filter will
  7284. continue with its existing parameters.
  7285. @subsection Examples
  7286. @itemize
  7287. @item
  7288. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  7289. optional parameters.
  7290. @example
  7291. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  7292. @end example
  7293. @item
  7294. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  7295. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  7296. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  7297. opacity of 20%.
  7298. @example
  7299. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  7300. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  7301. @end example
  7302. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  7303. within the parameter list.
  7304. @item
  7305. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  7306. @example
  7307. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  7308. @end example
  7309. @item
  7310. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  7311. @example
  7312. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  7313. @end example
  7314. @item
  7315. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  7316. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  7317. with no newlines.
  7318. @example
  7319. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  7320. @end example
  7321. @item
  7322. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  7323. @example
  7324. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  7325. @end example
  7326. @item
  7327. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  7328. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  7329. @example
  7330. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  7331. @end example
  7332. @item
  7333. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  7334. @example
  7335. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  7336. @end example
  7337. @item
  7338. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  7339. @example
  7340. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  7341. @end example
  7342. @item
  7343. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  7344. @example
  7345. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  7346. @end example
  7347. @item
  7348. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  7349. @example
  7350. #!/bin/sh
  7351. DS=1.0 # display start
  7352. DE=10.0 # display end
  7353. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  7354. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  7355. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  7356. @end example
  7357. @item
  7358. Horizontally align multiple separate texts. Note that @option{max_glyph_a}
  7359. and the @option{fontsize} value are included in the @option{y} offset.
  7360. @example
  7361. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=DOG:fontsize=24:x=10:y=20+24-max_glyph_a,
  7362. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=cow:fontsize=24:x=80:y=20+24-max_glyph_a
  7363. @end example
  7364. @end itemize
  7365. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  7366. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  7367. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  7368. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  7369. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  7370. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  7371. @section edgedetect
  7372. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  7373. The filter accepts the following options:
  7374. @table @option
  7375. @item low
  7376. @item high
  7377. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  7378. algorithm.
  7379. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  7380. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  7381. by the low threshold.
  7382. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  7383. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  7384. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  7385. is @code{50/255}.
  7386. @item mode
  7387. Define the drawing mode.
  7388. @table @samp
  7389. @item wires
  7390. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  7391. @item colormix
  7392. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  7393. @item canny
  7394. Apply Canny edge detector on all selected planes.
  7395. @end table
  7396. Default value is @var{wires}.
  7397. @item planes
  7398. Select planes for filtering. By default all available planes are filtered.
  7399. @end table
  7400. @subsection Examples
  7401. @itemize
  7402. @item
  7403. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  7404. @example
  7405. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  7406. @end example
  7407. @item
  7408. Painting effect without thresholding:
  7409. @example
  7410. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  7411. @end example
  7412. @end itemize
  7413. @section elbg
  7414. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  7415. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  7416. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  7417. of distinct output colors.
  7418. This filter accepts the following options.
  7419. @table @option
  7420. @item codebook_length, l
  7421. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  7422. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  7423. @item nb_steps, n
  7424. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  7425. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  7426. computation time. Default value is 1.
  7427. @item seed, s
  7428. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  7429. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  7430. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  7431. @item pal8
  7432. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  7433. length greater than 256.
  7434. @end table
  7435. @section entropy
  7436. Measure graylevel entropy in histogram of color channels of video frames.
  7437. It accepts the following parameters:
  7438. @table @option
  7439. @item mode
  7440. Can be either @var{normal} or @var{diff}. Default is @var{normal}.
  7441. @var{diff} mode measures entropy of histogram delta values, absolute differences
  7442. between neighbour histogram values.
  7443. @end table
  7444. @section eq
  7445. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  7446. The filter accepts the following options:
  7447. @table @option
  7448. @item contrast
  7449. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  7450. @code{-1000.0} to @code{1000.0}. The default value is "1".
  7451. @item brightness
  7452. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  7453. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  7454. @item saturation
  7455. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  7456. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  7457. @item gamma
  7458. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  7459. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7460. @item gamma_r
  7461. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  7462. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7463. @item gamma_g
  7464. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  7465. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7466. @item gamma_b
  7467. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  7468. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7469. @item gamma_weight
  7470. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  7471. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  7472. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  7473. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  7474. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  7475. full strength. Default is "1".
  7476. @item eval
  7477. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  7478. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  7479. It accepts the following values:
  7480. @table @samp
  7481. @item init
  7482. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7483. when a command is processed
  7484. @item frame
  7485. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7486. @end table
  7487. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7488. @end table
  7489. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  7490. @table @option
  7491. @item n
  7492. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  7493. @item pos
  7494. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  7495. unspecified
  7496. @item r
  7497. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  7498. @item t
  7499. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7500. @end table
  7501. @subsection Commands
  7502. The filter supports the following commands:
  7503. @table @option
  7504. @item contrast
  7505. Set the contrast expression.
  7506. @item brightness
  7507. Set the brightness expression.
  7508. @item saturation
  7509. Set the saturation expression.
  7510. @item gamma
  7511. Set the gamma expression.
  7512. @item gamma_r
  7513. Set the gamma_r expression.
  7514. @item gamma_g
  7515. Set gamma_g expression.
  7516. @item gamma_b
  7517. Set gamma_b expression.
  7518. @item gamma_weight
  7519. Set gamma_weight expression.
  7520. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7521. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7522. value.
  7523. @end table
  7524. @section erosion
  7525. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  7526. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  7527. It accepts the following options:
  7528. @table @option
  7529. @item threshold0
  7530. @item threshold1
  7531. @item threshold2
  7532. @item threshold3
  7533. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7534. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7535. @item coordinates
  7536. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7537. pixels are used.
  7538. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7539. 1 2 3
  7540. 4 5
  7541. 6 7 8
  7542. @end table
  7543. @section extractplanes
  7544. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  7545. separate grayscale video streams.
  7546. The filter accepts the following option:
  7547. @table @option
  7548. @item planes
  7549. Set plane(s) to extract.
  7550. Available values for planes are:
  7551. @table @samp
  7552. @item y
  7553. @item u
  7554. @item v
  7555. @item a
  7556. @item r
  7557. @item g
  7558. @item b
  7559. @end table
  7560. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  7561. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  7562. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  7563. @end table
  7564. @subsection Examples
  7565. @itemize
  7566. @item
  7567. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  7568. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  7569. @example
  7570. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  7571. @end example
  7572. @end itemize
  7573. @section fade
  7574. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  7575. It accepts the following parameters:
  7576. @table @option
  7577. @item type, t
  7578. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  7579. effect.
  7580. Default is @code{in}.
  7581. @item start_frame, s
  7582. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  7583. effect at. Default is 0.
  7584. @item nb_frames, n
  7585. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  7586. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  7587. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  7588. selected @option{color}.
  7589. Default is 25.
  7590. @item alpha
  7591. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  7592. Default value is 0.
  7593. @item start_time, st
  7594. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  7595. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  7596. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  7597. @item duration, d
  7598. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  7599. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  7600. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  7601. selected @option{color}.
  7602. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  7603. (nb_frames is used by default).
  7604. @item color, c
  7605. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  7606. @end table
  7607. @subsection Examples
  7608. @itemize
  7609. @item
  7610. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  7611. @example
  7612. fade=in:0:30
  7613. @end example
  7614. The command above is equivalent to:
  7615. @example
  7616. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  7617. @end example
  7618. @item
  7619. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  7620. @example
  7621. fade=out:155:45
  7622. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  7623. @end example
  7624. @item
  7625. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  7626. @example
  7627. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  7628. @end example
  7629. @item
  7630. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  7631. @example
  7632. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  7633. @end example
  7634. @item
  7635. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  7636. @example
  7637. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  7638. @end example
  7639. @item
  7640. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  7641. @example
  7642. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  7643. @end example
  7644. @end itemize
  7645. @section fftdnoiz
  7646. Denoise frames using 3D FFT (frequency domain filtering).
  7647. The filter accepts the following options:
  7648. @table @option
  7649. @item sigma
  7650. Set the noise sigma constant. This sets denoising strength.
  7651. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 30.
  7652. Using very high sigma with low overlap may give blocking artifacts.
  7653. @item amount
  7654. Set amount of denoising. By default all detected noise is reduced.
  7655. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  7656. @item block
  7657. Set size of block, Default is 4, can be 3, 4, 5 or 6.
  7658. Actual size of block in pixels is 2 to power of @var{block}, so by default
  7659. block size in pixels is 2^4 which is 16.
  7660. @item overlap
  7661. Set block overlap. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0.2 to 0.8.
  7662. @item prev
  7663. Set number of previous frames to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7664. @item next
  7665. Set number of next frames to to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7666. @item planes
  7667. Set planes which will be filtered, by default are all available filtered
  7668. except alpha.
  7669. @end table
  7670. @section fftfilt
  7671. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  7672. @table @option
  7673. @item dc_Y
  7674. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  7675. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  7676. value is set to @code{0}.
  7677. @item dc_U
  7678. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  7679. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7680. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7681. @item dc_V
  7682. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  7683. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7684. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7685. @item weight_Y
  7686. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  7687. @item weight_U
  7688. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  7689. @item weight_V
  7690. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  7691. @item eval
  7692. Set when the expressions are evaluated.
  7693. It accepts the following values:
  7694. @table @samp
  7695. @item init
  7696. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization.
  7697. @item frame
  7698. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  7699. @end table
  7700. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7701. The filter accepts the following variables:
  7702. @item X
  7703. @item Y
  7704. The coordinates of the current sample.
  7705. @item W
  7706. @item H
  7707. The width and height of the image.
  7708. @item N
  7709. The number of input frame, starting from 0.
  7710. @end table
  7711. @subsection Examples
  7712. @itemize
  7713. @item
  7714. High-pass:
  7715. @example
  7716. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  7717. @end example
  7718. @item
  7719. Low-pass:
  7720. @example
  7721. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  7722. @end example
  7723. @item
  7724. Sharpen:
  7725. @example
  7726. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  7727. @end example
  7728. @item
  7729. Blur:
  7730. @example
  7731. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  7732. @end example
  7733. @end itemize
  7734. @section field
  7735. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  7736. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  7737. non-interlaced.
  7738. The filter accepts the following options:
  7739. @table @option
  7740. @item type
  7741. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  7742. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  7743. @code{bottom}).
  7744. @end table
  7745. @section fieldhint
  7746. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  7747. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  7748. @table @option
  7749. @item hint
  7750. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  7751. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  7752. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  7753. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  7754. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  7755. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  7756. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  7757. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  7758. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  7759. it will be marked same as input frame.
  7760. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  7761. @item mode
  7762. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  7763. @end table
  7764. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  7765. @example
  7766. 0,0 - # first frame
  7767. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  7768. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  7769. 1,0 -
  7770. 0,0 -
  7771. 0,0 -
  7772. 1,0 -
  7773. 1,0 -
  7774. 1,0 -
  7775. 0,0 -
  7776. 0,0 -
  7777. 1,0 -
  7778. 1,0 -
  7779. 1,0 -
  7780. 0,0 -
  7781. @end example
  7782. @section fieldmatch
  7783. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  7784. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  7785. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  7786. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  7787. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  7788. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  7789. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  7790. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  7791. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  7792. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  7793. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  7794. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  7795. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  7796. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  7797. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  7798. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  7799. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  7800. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  7801. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  7802. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  7803. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  7804. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  7805. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  7806. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  7807. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  7808. The filter accepts the following options:
  7809. @table @option
  7810. @item order
  7811. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  7812. @table @samp
  7813. @item auto
  7814. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  7815. @item bff
  7816. Assume bottom field first.
  7817. @item tff
  7818. Assume top field first.
  7819. @end table
  7820. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  7821. stream.
  7822. Default value is @var{auto}.
  7823. @item mode
  7824. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  7825. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  7826. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  7827. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  7828. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  7829. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  7830. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  7831. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  7832. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  7833. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  7834. Available values are:
  7835. @table @samp
  7836. @item pc
  7837. 2-way matching (p/c)
  7838. @item pc_n
  7839. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  7840. @item pc_u
  7841. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  7842. @item pc_n_ub
  7843. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  7844. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  7845. @item pcn
  7846. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  7847. @item pcn_ub
  7848. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  7849. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  7850. @end table
  7851. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  7852. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  7853. @var{top}).
  7854. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  7855. the slowest.
  7856. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  7857. @item ppsrc
  7858. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  7859. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  7860. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  7861. VFM/TFM.
  7862. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  7863. @item field
  7864. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  7865. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  7866. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  7867. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  7868. @table @samp
  7869. @item auto
  7870. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  7871. @item bottom
  7872. Match from the bottom field.
  7873. @item top
  7874. Match from the top field.
  7875. @end table
  7876. Default value is @var{auto}.
  7877. @item mchroma
  7878. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  7879. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  7880. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  7881. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  7882. the cost of some accuracy.
  7883. Default value is @code{1}.
  7884. @item y0
  7885. @item y1
  7886. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  7887. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  7888. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  7889. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  7890. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  7891. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  7892. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  7893. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  7894. @item scthresh
  7895. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  7896. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  7897. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  7898. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  7899. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  7900. @item combmatch
  7901. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  7902. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  7903. final match. Available values are:
  7904. @table @samp
  7905. @item none
  7906. No final matching based on combed scores.
  7907. @item sc
  7908. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  7909. @item full
  7910. Use combed scores all the time.
  7911. @end table
  7912. Default is @var{sc}.
  7913. @item combdbg
  7914. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  7915. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  7916. Available values are:
  7917. @table @samp
  7918. @item none
  7919. No forced calculation.
  7920. @item pcn
  7921. Force p/c/n calculations.
  7922. @item pcnub
  7923. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  7924. @end table
  7925. Default value is @var{none}.
  7926. @item cthresh
  7927. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  7928. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  7929. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  7930. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  7931. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  7932. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  7933. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  7934. Default value is @code{9}.
  7935. @item chroma
  7936. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  7937. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  7938. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  7939. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  7940. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  7941. Default value is @code{0}.
  7942. @item blockx
  7943. @item blocky
  7944. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  7945. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  7946. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  7947. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  7948. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  7949. to 512.
  7950. Default value is @code{16}.
  7951. @item combpel
  7952. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  7953. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  7954. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  7955. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  7956. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  7957. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  7958. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  7959. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  7960. Default value is @code{80}.
  7961. @end table
  7962. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  7963. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  7964. @subsubsection p/c/n
  7965. We assume the following telecined stream:
  7966. @example
  7967. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  7968. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  7969. @end example
  7970. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  7971. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  7972. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  7973. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  7974. @example
  7975. Input stream:
  7976. T 1 2 2 3 4
  7977. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  7978. Matches: c c n n c
  7979. Output stream:
  7980. T 1 2 3 4 4
  7981. B 1 2 3 4 4
  7982. @end example
  7983. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  7984. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  7985. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  7986. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  7987. looks like this:
  7988. @example
  7989. Input stream:
  7990. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  7991. B 1 2 3 4 4
  7992. Matches: c c p p c
  7993. Output stream:
  7994. T 1 2 2 3 4
  7995. B 1 2 2 3 4
  7996. @end example
  7997. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  7998. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  7999. @itemize
  8000. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  8001. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  8002. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  8003. @end itemize
  8004. @subsubsection u/b
  8005. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  8006. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  8007. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  8008. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  8009. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  8010. @example
  8011. Match: c p n b u
  8012. x x x x x
  8013. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8014. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8015. x x x x x
  8016. Output frames:
  8017. 2 1 2 2 2
  8018. 2 2 2 1 3
  8019. @end example
  8020. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  8021. @example
  8022. Match: c p n b u
  8023. x x x x x
  8024. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8025. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8026. x x x x x
  8027. Output frames:
  8028. 2 2 2 1 2
  8029. 2 1 3 2 2
  8030. @end example
  8031. @subsection Examples
  8032. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  8033. @example
  8034. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  8035. @end example
  8036. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  8037. @example
  8038. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  8039. @end example
  8040. @section fieldorder
  8041. Transform the field order of the input video.
  8042. It accepts the following parameters:
  8043. @table @option
  8044. @item order
  8045. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  8046. for bottom field first.
  8047. @end table
  8048. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  8049. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  8050. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  8051. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  8052. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  8053. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  8054. not alter the incoming video.
  8055. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  8056. which is bottom field first.
  8057. For example:
  8058. @example
  8059. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  8060. @end example
  8061. @section fifo, afifo
  8062. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  8063. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  8064. framework.
  8065. It does not take parameters.
  8066. @section fillborders
  8067. Fill borders of the input video, without changing video stream dimensions.
  8068. Sometimes video can have garbage at the four edges and you may not want to
  8069. crop video input to keep size multiple of some number.
  8070. This filter accepts the following options:
  8071. @table @option
  8072. @item left
  8073. Number of pixels to fill from left border.
  8074. @item right
  8075. Number of pixels to fill from right border.
  8076. @item top
  8077. Number of pixels to fill from top border.
  8078. @item bottom
  8079. Number of pixels to fill from bottom border.
  8080. @item mode
  8081. Set fill mode.
  8082. It accepts the following values:
  8083. @table @samp
  8084. @item smear
  8085. fill pixels using outermost pixels
  8086. @item mirror
  8087. fill pixels using mirroring
  8088. @item fixed
  8089. fill pixels with constant value
  8090. @end table
  8091. Default is @var{smear}.
  8092. @item color
  8093. Set color for pixels in fixed mode. Default is @var{black}.
  8094. @end table
  8095. @section find_rect
  8096. Find a rectangular object
  8097. It accepts the following options:
  8098. @table @option
  8099. @item object
  8100. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  8101. @item threshold
  8102. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  8103. @item mipmaps
  8104. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  8105. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  8106. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  8107. @end table
  8108. @subsection Examples
  8109. @itemize
  8110. @item
  8111. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8112. @example
  8113. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  8114. @end example
  8115. @end itemize
  8116. @section floodfill
  8117. Flood area with values of same pixel components with another values.
  8118. It accepts the following options:
  8119. @table @option
  8120. @item x
  8121. Set pixel x coordinate.
  8122. @item y
  8123. Set pixel y coordinate.
  8124. @item s0
  8125. Set source #0 component value.
  8126. @item s1
  8127. Set source #1 component value.
  8128. @item s2
  8129. Set source #2 component value.
  8130. @item s3
  8131. Set source #3 component value.
  8132. @item d0
  8133. Set destination #0 component value.
  8134. @item d1
  8135. Set destination #1 component value.
  8136. @item d2
  8137. Set destination #2 component value.
  8138. @item d3
  8139. Set destination #3 component value.
  8140. @end table
  8141. @anchor{format}
  8142. @section format
  8143. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  8144. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  8145. the next filter.
  8146. It accepts the following parameters:
  8147. @table @option
  8148. @item pix_fmts
  8149. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  8150. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  8151. @end table
  8152. @subsection Examples
  8153. @itemize
  8154. @item
  8155. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  8156. @example
  8157. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  8158. @end example
  8159. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  8160. @example
  8161. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  8162. @end example
  8163. @end itemize
  8164. @anchor{fps}
  8165. @section fps
  8166. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  8167. frames as necessary.
  8168. It accepts the following parameters:
  8169. @table @option
  8170. @item fps
  8171. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  8172. @item start_time
  8173. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  8174. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  8175. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  8176. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  8177. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  8178. frames with a negative PTS.
  8179. @item round
  8180. Timestamp (PTS) rounding method.
  8181. Possible values are:
  8182. @table @option
  8183. @item zero
  8184. round towards 0
  8185. @item inf
  8186. round away from 0
  8187. @item down
  8188. round towards -infinity
  8189. @item up
  8190. round towards +infinity
  8191. @item near
  8192. round to nearest
  8193. @end table
  8194. The default is @code{near}.
  8195. @item eof_action
  8196. Action performed when reading the last frame.
  8197. Possible values are:
  8198. @table @option
  8199. @item round
  8200. Use same timestamp rounding method as used for other frames.
  8201. @item pass
  8202. Pass through last frame if input duration has not been reached yet.
  8203. @end table
  8204. The default is @code{round}.
  8205. @end table
  8206. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8207. @var{fps}[:@var{start_time}[:@var{round}]].
  8208. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  8209. @subsection Examples
  8210. @itemize
  8211. @item
  8212. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  8213. @example
  8214. fps=fps=25
  8215. @end example
  8216. @item
  8217. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  8218. @example
  8219. fps=fps=film:round=near
  8220. @end example
  8221. @end itemize
  8222. @section framepack
  8223. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  8224. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  8225. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  8226. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  8227. @ref{fps} filters.
  8228. It accepts the following parameters:
  8229. @table @option
  8230. @item format
  8231. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  8232. @table @option
  8233. @item sbs
  8234. The views are next to each other (default).
  8235. @item tab
  8236. The views are on top of each other.
  8237. @item lines
  8238. The views are packed by line.
  8239. @item columns
  8240. The views are packed by column.
  8241. @item frameseq
  8242. The views are temporally interleaved.
  8243. @end table
  8244. @end table
  8245. Some examples:
  8246. @example
  8247. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  8248. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  8249. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  8250. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  8251. @end example
  8252. @section framerate
  8253. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  8254. frames.
  8255. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  8256. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  8257. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  8258. A description of the accepted options follows.
  8259. @table @option
  8260. @item fps
  8261. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  8262. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  8263. @item interp_start
  8264. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8265. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8266. the default is @code{15}.
  8267. @item interp_end
  8268. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8269. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8270. the default is @code{240}.
  8271. @item scene
  8272. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  8273. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  8274. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  8275. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  8276. The default is @code{8.2}.
  8277. @item flags
  8278. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  8279. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  8280. @table @option
  8281. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  8282. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  8283. This flag is enabled by default.
  8284. @end table
  8285. @end table
  8286. @section framestep
  8287. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  8288. This filter accepts the following option:
  8289. @table @option
  8290. @item step
  8291. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  8292. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  8293. @end table
  8294. @section freezedetect
  8295. Detect frozen video.
  8296. This filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects that the
  8297. input video has no significant change in content during a specified duration.
  8298. Video freeze detection calculates the mean average absolute difference of all
  8299. the components of video frames and compares it to a noise floor.
  8300. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  8301. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_start} metadata key is set on the first frame
  8302. whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection duration and it contains the
  8303. timestamp of the first frame of the freeze. The
  8304. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_duration} and
  8305. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_end} metadata keys are set on the first frame
  8306. after the freeze.
  8307. The filter accepts the following options:
  8308. @table @option
  8309. @item noise, n
  8310. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  8311. specified value) or as a difference ratio between 0 and 1. Default is -60dB, or
  8312. 0.001.
  8313. @item duration, d
  8314. Set freeze duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  8315. @end table
  8316. @anchor{frei0r}
  8317. @section frei0r
  8318. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  8319. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  8320. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  8321. It accepts the following parameters:
  8322. @table @option
  8323. @item filter_name
  8324. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  8325. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  8326. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREI0R_PATH}.
  8327. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  8328. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  8329. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  8330. @item filter_params
  8331. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  8332. @end table
  8333. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  8334. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  8335. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  8336. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or a color description as specified in the
  8337. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils},
  8338. a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  8339. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  8340. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  8341. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  8342. @subsection Examples
  8343. @itemize
  8344. @item
  8345. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  8346. @example
  8347. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  8348. @end example
  8349. @item
  8350. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  8351. @example
  8352. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  8353. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  8354. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  8355. @end example
  8356. @item
  8357. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  8358. positions:
  8359. @example
  8360. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  8361. @end example
  8362. @end itemize
  8363. For more information, see
  8364. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  8365. @section fspp
  8366. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  8367. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  8368. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  8369. This allows for much higher speed.
  8370. The filter accepts the following options:
  8371. @table @option
  8372. @item quality
  8373. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  8374. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  8375. @item qp
  8376. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  8377. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  8378. @item strength
  8379. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  8380. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  8381. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  8382. @item use_bframe_qp
  8383. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  8384. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  8385. @code{0} (not enabled).
  8386. @end table
  8387. @section gblur
  8388. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  8389. The filter accepts the following options:
  8390. @table @option
  8391. @item sigma
  8392. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8393. @item steps
  8394. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Default is @code{1}.
  8395. @item planes
  8396. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  8397. @item sigmaV
  8398. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  8399. Default is @code{-1}.
  8400. @end table
  8401. @subsection Commands
  8402. This filter supports same commands as options.
  8403. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8404. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8405. value.
  8406. @section geq
  8407. Apply generic equation to each pixel.
  8408. The filter accepts the following options:
  8409. @table @option
  8410. @item lum_expr, lum
  8411. Set the luminance expression.
  8412. @item cb_expr, cb
  8413. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  8414. @item cr_expr, cr
  8415. Set the chrominance red expression.
  8416. @item alpha_expr, a
  8417. Set the alpha expression.
  8418. @item red_expr, r
  8419. Set the red expression.
  8420. @item green_expr, g
  8421. Set the green expression.
  8422. @item blue_expr, b
  8423. Set the blue expression.
  8424. @end table
  8425. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  8426. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  8427. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  8428. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  8429. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  8430. colorspace.
  8431. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  8432. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  8433. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  8434. to the luminance expression.
  8435. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  8436. @table @option
  8437. @item N
  8438. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  8439. @item X
  8440. @item Y
  8441. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8442. @item W
  8443. @item H
  8444. The width and height of the image.
  8445. @item SW
  8446. @item SH
  8447. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  8448. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  8449. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  8450. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  8451. @item T
  8452. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  8453. @item p(x, y)
  8454. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  8455. plane.
  8456. @item lum(x, y)
  8457. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  8458. plane.
  8459. @item cb(x, y)
  8460. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8461. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8462. @item cr(x, y)
  8463. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8464. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8465. @item r(x, y)
  8466. @item g(x, y)
  8467. @item b(x, y)
  8468. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8469. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  8470. @item alpha(x, y)
  8471. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  8472. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8473. @item interpolation
  8474. Set one of interpolation methods:
  8475. @table @option
  8476. @item nearest, n
  8477. @item bilinear, b
  8478. @end table
  8479. Default is bilinear.
  8480. @end table
  8481. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  8482. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  8483. @subsection Examples
  8484. @itemize
  8485. @item
  8486. Flip the image horizontally:
  8487. @example
  8488. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  8489. @end example
  8490. @item
  8491. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  8492. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  8493. @example
  8494. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  8495. @end example
  8496. @item
  8497. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  8498. @example
  8499. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  8500. @end example
  8501. @item
  8502. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  8503. @example
  8504. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  8505. @end example
  8506. @item
  8507. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  8508. @example
  8509. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  8510. @end example
  8511. @item
  8512. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  8513. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  8514. @example
  8515. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  8516. @end example
  8517. @end itemize
  8518. @section gradfun
  8519. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  8520. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  8521. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  8522. dither them.
  8523. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  8524. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  8525. bring back the bands.
  8526. It accepts the following parameters:
  8527. @table @option
  8528. @item strength
  8529. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  8530. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  8531. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  8532. valid range.
  8533. @item radius
  8534. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  8535. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  8536. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  8537. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  8538. @end table
  8539. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8540. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  8541. @subsection Examples
  8542. @itemize
  8543. @item
  8544. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  8545. @example
  8546. gradfun=3.5:8
  8547. @end example
  8548. @item
  8549. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  8550. value):
  8551. @example
  8552. gradfun=radius=8
  8553. @end example
  8554. @end itemize
  8555. @section graphmonitor, agraphmonitor
  8556. Show various filtergraph stats.
  8557. With this filter one can debug complete filtergraph.
  8558. Especially issues with links filling with queued frames.
  8559. The filter accepts the following options:
  8560. @table @option
  8561. @item size, s
  8562. Set video output size. Default is @var{hd720}.
  8563. @item opacity, o
  8564. Set video opacity. Default is @var{0.9}. Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{1}.
  8565. @item mode, m
  8566. Set output mode, can be @var{fulll} or @var{compact}.
  8567. In @var{compact} mode only filters with some queued frames have displayed stats.
  8568. @item flags, f
  8569. Set flags which enable which stats are shown in video.
  8570. Available values for flags are:
  8571. @table @samp
  8572. @item queue
  8573. Display number of queued frames in each link.
  8574. @item frame_count_in
  8575. Display number of frames taken from filter.
  8576. @item frame_count_out
  8577. Display number of frames given out from filter.
  8578. @item pts
  8579. Display current filtered frame pts.
  8580. @item time
  8581. Display current filtered frame time.
  8582. @item timebase
  8583. Display time base for filter link.
  8584. @item format
  8585. Display used format for filter link.
  8586. @item size
  8587. Display video size or number of audio channels in case of audio used by filter link.
  8588. @item rate
  8589. Display video frame rate or sample rate in case of audio used by filter link.
  8590. @end table
  8591. @item rate, r
  8592. Set upper limit for video rate of output stream, Default value is @var{25}.
  8593. This guarantee that output video frame rate will not be higher than this value.
  8594. @end table
  8595. @section greyedge
  8596. A color constancy variation filter which estimates scene illumination via grey edge algorithm
  8597. and corrects the scene colors accordingly.
  8598. See: @url{https://staff.science.uva.nl/th.gevers/pub/GeversTIP07.pdf}
  8599. The filter accepts the following options:
  8600. @table @option
  8601. @item difford
  8602. The order of differentiation to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range
  8603. [0,2] and default value is 1.
  8604. @item minknorm
  8605. The Minkowski parameter to be used for calculating the Minkowski distance. Must
  8606. be chosen in the range [0,20] and default value is 1. Set to 0 for getting
  8607. max value instead of calculating Minkowski distance.
  8608. @item sigma
  8609. The standard deviation of Gaussian blur to be applied on the scene. Must be
  8610. chosen in the range [0,1024.0] and default value = 1. floor( @var{sigma} * break_off_sigma(3) )
  8611. can't be equal to 0 if @var{difford} is greater than 0.
  8612. @end table
  8613. @subsection Examples
  8614. @itemize
  8615. @item
  8616. Grey Edge:
  8617. @example
  8618. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=5:sigma=2
  8619. @end example
  8620. @item
  8621. Max Edge:
  8622. @example
  8623. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=0:sigma=2
  8624. @end example
  8625. @end itemize
  8626. @anchor{haldclut}
  8627. @section haldclut
  8628. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  8629. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  8630. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  8631. The filter accepts the following options:
  8632. @table @option
  8633. @item shortest
  8634. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  8635. @item repeatlast
  8636. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  8637. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  8638. Default is @code{1}.
  8639. @end table
  8640. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  8641. filters share the same internals).
  8642. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  8643. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  8644. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  8645. @subsection Workflow examples
  8646. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  8647. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  8648. @example
  8649. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  8650. @end example
  8651. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  8652. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  8653. @example
  8654. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  8655. @end example
  8656. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  8657. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  8658. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  8659. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  8660. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  8661. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  8662. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  8663. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  8664. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  8665. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  8666. @code{haldclut} filter:
  8667. @example
  8668. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  8669. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  8670. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  8671. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  8672. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  8673. @end example
  8674. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  8675. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  8676. the color changes.
  8677. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  8678. @example
  8679. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  8680. @end example
  8681. @section hflip
  8682. Flip the input video horizontally.
  8683. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  8684. @example
  8685. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  8686. @end example
  8687. @section histeq
  8688. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  8689. per-frame basis.
  8690. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  8691. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  8692. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  8693. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  8694. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  8695. video.
  8696. The filter accepts the following options:
  8697. @table @option
  8698. @item strength
  8699. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  8700. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  8701. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  8702. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  8703. @item intensity
  8704. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  8705. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  8706. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  8707. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  8708. @item antibanding
  8709. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  8710. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  8711. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  8712. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  8713. @end table
  8714. @section histogram
  8715. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  8716. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  8717. distribution in an image.
  8718. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  8719. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  8720. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  8721. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  8722. The filter accepts the following options:
  8723. @table @option
  8724. @item level_height
  8725. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  8726. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  8727. @item scale_height
  8728. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  8729. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  8730. @item display_mode
  8731. Set display mode.
  8732. It accepts the following values:
  8733. @table @samp
  8734. @item stack
  8735. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  8736. @item parade
  8737. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  8738. @item overlay
  8739. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  8740. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  8741. over one another.
  8742. @end table
  8743. Default is @code{stack}.
  8744. @item levels_mode
  8745. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  8746. Default is @code{linear}.
  8747. @item components
  8748. Set what color components to display.
  8749. Default is @code{7}.
  8750. @item fgopacity
  8751. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  8752. @item bgopacity
  8753. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8754. @end table
  8755. @subsection Examples
  8756. @itemize
  8757. @item
  8758. Calculate and draw histogram:
  8759. @example
  8760. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  8761. @end example
  8762. @end itemize
  8763. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  8764. @section hqdn3d
  8765. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  8766. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  8767. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  8768. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  8769. @table @option
  8770. @item luma_spatial
  8771. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  8772. It defaults to 4.0.
  8773. @item chroma_spatial
  8774. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  8775. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  8776. @item luma_tmp
  8777. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  8778. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  8779. @item chroma_tmp
  8780. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  8781. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  8782. @end table
  8783. @anchor{hwdownload}
  8784. @section hwdownload
  8785. Download hardware frames to system memory.
  8786. The input must be in hardware frames, and the output a non-hardware format.
  8787. Not all formats will be supported on the output - it may be necessary to insert
  8788. an additional @option{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get
  8789. the output in a supported format.
  8790. @section hwmap
  8791. Map hardware frames to system memory or to another device.
  8792. This filter has several different modes of operation; which one is used depends
  8793. on the input and output formats:
  8794. @itemize
  8795. @item
  8796. Hardware frame input, normal frame output
  8797. Map the input frames to system memory and pass them to the output. If the
  8798. original hardware frame is later required (for example, after overlaying
  8799. something else on part of it), the @option{hwmap} filter can be used again
  8800. in the next mode to retrieve it.
  8801. @item
  8802. Normal frame input, hardware frame output
  8803. If the input is actually a software-mapped hardware frame, then unmap it -
  8804. that is, return the original hardware frame.
  8805. Otherwise, a device must be provided. Create new hardware surfaces on that
  8806. device for the output, then map them back to the software format at the input
  8807. and give those frames to the preceding filter. This will then act like the
  8808. @option{hwupload} filter, but may be able to avoid an additional copy when
  8809. the input is already in a compatible format.
  8810. @item
  8811. Hardware frame input and output
  8812. A device must be supplied for the output, either directly or with the
  8813. @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices must be of
  8814. different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  8815. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  8816. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  8817. If the input frames were originally created on the output device, then unmap
  8818. to retrieve the original frames.
  8819. Otherwise, map the frames to the output device - create new hardware frames
  8820. on the output corresponding to the frames on the input.
  8821. @end itemize
  8822. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  8823. @table @option
  8824. @item mode
  8825. Set the frame mapping mode. Some combination of:
  8826. @table @var
  8827. @item read
  8828. The mapped frame should be readable.
  8829. @item write
  8830. The mapped frame should be writeable.
  8831. @item overwrite
  8832. The mapping will always overwrite the entire frame.
  8833. This may improve performance in some cases, as the original contents of the
  8834. frame need not be loaded.
  8835. @item direct
  8836. The mapping must not involve any copying.
  8837. Indirect mappings to copies of frames are created in some cases where either
  8838. direct mapping is not possible or it would have unexpected properties.
  8839. Setting this flag ensures that the mapping is direct and will fail if that is
  8840. not possible.
  8841. @end table
  8842. Defaults to @var{read+write} if not specified.
  8843. @item derive_device @var{type}
  8844. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  8845. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  8846. @item reverse
  8847. In a hardware to hardware mapping, map in reverse - create frames in the sink
  8848. and map them back to the source. This may be necessary in some cases where
  8849. a mapping in one direction is required but only the opposite direction is
  8850. supported by the devices being used.
  8851. This option is dangerous - it may break the preceding filter in undefined
  8852. ways if there are any additional constraints on that filter's output.
  8853. Do not use it without fully understanding the implications of its use.
  8854. @end table
  8855. @anchor{hwupload}
  8856. @section hwupload
  8857. Upload system memory frames to hardware surfaces.
  8858. The device to upload to must be supplied when the filter is initialised. If
  8859. using ffmpeg, select the appropriate device with the @option{-filter_hw_device}
  8860. option.
  8861. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  8862. @section hwupload_cuda
  8863. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  8864. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  8865. @table @option
  8866. @item device
  8867. The number of the CUDA device to use
  8868. @end table
  8869. @section hqx
  8870. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  8871. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  8872. It accepts the following option:
  8873. @table @option
  8874. @item n
  8875. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  8876. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  8877. Default is @code{3}.
  8878. @end table
  8879. @section hstack
  8880. Stack input videos horizontally.
  8881. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  8882. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  8883. to create same output.
  8884. The filter accepts the following option:
  8885. @table @option
  8886. @item inputs
  8887. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  8888. @item shortest
  8889. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  8890. terminates. Default value is 0.
  8891. @end table
  8892. @section hue
  8893. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  8894. It accepts the following parameters:
  8895. @table @option
  8896. @item h
  8897. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  8898. and defaults to "0".
  8899. @item s
  8900. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  8901. defaults to "1".
  8902. @item H
  8903. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  8904. expression, and defaults to "0".
  8905. @item b
  8906. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  8907. defaults to "0".
  8908. @end table
  8909. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  8910. specified at the same time.
  8911. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  8912. expressions containing the following constants:
  8913. @table @option
  8914. @item n
  8915. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  8916. @item pts
  8917. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  8918. @item r
  8919. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  8920. @item t
  8921. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  8922. @item tb
  8923. time base of the input video
  8924. @end table
  8925. @subsection Examples
  8926. @itemize
  8927. @item
  8928. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  8929. @example
  8930. hue=h=90:s=1
  8931. @end example
  8932. @item
  8933. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  8934. @example
  8935. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  8936. @end example
  8937. @item
  8938. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  8939. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  8940. @example
  8941. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  8942. @end example
  8943. @item
  8944. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  8945. @example
  8946. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  8947. @end example
  8948. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  8949. @example
  8950. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  8951. @end example
  8952. @item
  8953. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  8954. @example
  8955. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  8956. @end example
  8957. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  8958. @example
  8959. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  8960. @end example
  8961. @end itemize
  8962. @subsection Commands
  8963. This filter supports the following commands:
  8964. @table @option
  8965. @item b
  8966. @item s
  8967. @item h
  8968. @item H
  8969. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  8970. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8971. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8972. value.
  8973. @end table
  8974. @section hysteresis
  8975. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  8976. This makes it possible to build more robust edge masks.
  8977. This filter accepts the following options:
  8978. @table @option
  8979. @item planes
  8980. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  8981. copied from first stream.
  8982. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  8983. @item threshold
  8984. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  8985. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  8986. By default value is 0.
  8987. @end table
  8988. @section idet
  8989. Detect video interlacing type.
  8990. This filter tries to detect if the input frames are interlaced, progressive,
  8991. top or bottom field first. It will also try to detect fields that are
  8992. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  8993. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  8994. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  8995. The filter will log these metadata values:
  8996. @table @option
  8997. @item single.current_frame
  8998. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  8999. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9000. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9001. @item single.tff
  9002. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  9003. @item multiple.tff
  9004. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9005. @item single.bff
  9006. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  9007. @item multiple.current_frame
  9008. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  9009. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9010. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9011. @item multiple.bff
  9012. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9013. @item single.progressive
  9014. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  9015. @item multiple.progressive
  9016. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  9017. @item single.undetermined
  9018. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  9019. @item multiple.undetermined
  9020. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  9021. @item repeated.current_frame
  9022. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  9023. @item repeated.neither
  9024. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  9025. @item repeated.top
  9026. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  9027. @item repeated.bottom
  9028. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  9029. @end table
  9030. The filter accepts the following options:
  9031. @table @option
  9032. @item intl_thres
  9033. Set interlacing threshold.
  9034. @item prog_thres
  9035. Set progressive threshold.
  9036. @item rep_thres
  9037. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  9038. @item half_life
  9039. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  9040. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to its
  9041. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  9042. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  9043. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  9044. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  9045. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  9046. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  9047. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  9048. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  9049. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  9050. @end table
  9051. @section il
  9052. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  9053. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  9054. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  9055. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  9056. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  9057. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  9058. The filter accepts the following options:
  9059. @table @option
  9060. @item luma_mode, l
  9061. @item chroma_mode, c
  9062. @item alpha_mode, a
  9063. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  9064. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  9065. @table @samp
  9066. @item none
  9067. Do nothing.
  9068. @item deinterleave, d
  9069. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  9070. @item interleave, i
  9071. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  9072. @end table
  9073. Default value is @code{none}.
  9074. @item luma_swap, ls
  9075. @item chroma_swap, cs
  9076. @item alpha_swap, as
  9077. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  9078. @end table
  9079. @section inflate
  9080. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  9081. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  9082. only values higher than the pixel.
  9083. It accepts the following options:
  9084. @table @option
  9085. @item threshold0
  9086. @item threshold1
  9087. @item threshold2
  9088. @item threshold3
  9089. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  9090. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  9091. @end table
  9092. @section interlace
  9093. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  9094. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  9095. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  9096. @example
  9097. Original Original New Frame
  9098. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  9099. ========== =========== ==================
  9100. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  9101. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  9102. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  9103. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  9104. ... ... ...
  9105. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  9106. @end example
  9107. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9108. @table @option
  9109. @item scan
  9110. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  9111. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  9112. @item lowpass
  9113. Vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter interlacing and
  9114. reduce moire patterns.
  9115. @table @samp
  9116. @item 0, off
  9117. Disable vertical lowpass filter
  9118. @item 1, linear
  9119. Enable linear filter (default)
  9120. @item 2, complex
  9121. Enable complex filter. This will slightly less reduce twitter and moire
  9122. but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  9123. @end table
  9124. @end table
  9125. @section kerndeint
  9126. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  9127. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  9128. progressive frames.
  9129. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9130. @table @option
  9131. @item thresh
  9132. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  9133. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  9134. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  9135. applying the process on every pixels.
  9136. @item map
  9137. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  9138. Default is 0.
  9139. @item order
  9140. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  9141. 0. Default is 0.
  9142. @item sharp
  9143. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9144. @item twoway
  9145. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9146. @end table
  9147. @subsection Examples
  9148. @itemize
  9149. @item
  9150. Apply default values:
  9151. @example
  9152. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  9153. @end example
  9154. @item
  9155. Enable additional sharpening:
  9156. @example
  9157. kerndeint=sharp=1
  9158. @end example
  9159. @item
  9160. Paint processed pixels in white:
  9161. @example
  9162. kerndeint=map=1
  9163. @end example
  9164. @end itemize
  9165. @section lagfun
  9166. Slowly update darker pixels.
  9167. This filter makes short flashes of light appear longer.
  9168. This filter accepts the following options:
  9169. @table @option
  9170. @item decay
  9171. Set factor for decaying. Default is .95. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  9172. @item planes
  9173. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  9174. @end table
  9175. @section lenscorrection
  9176. Correct radial lens distortion
  9177. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  9178. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  9179. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  9180. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  9181. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  9182. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  9183. Digikam from the KDE project.
  9184. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  9185. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  9186. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  9187. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  9188. be applied before or after lens correction.
  9189. @subsection Options
  9190. The filter accepts the following options:
  9191. @table @option
  9192. @item cx
  9193. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9194. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9195. width. Default is 0.5.
  9196. @item cy
  9197. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9198. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9199. height. Default is 0.5.
  9200. @item k1
  9201. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1]. 0 means
  9202. no correction. Default is 0.
  9203. @item k2
  9204. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1].
  9205. 0 means no correction. Default is 0.
  9206. @end table
  9207. The formula that generates the correction is:
  9208. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  9209. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  9210. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  9211. @section lensfun
  9212. Apply lens correction via the lensfun library (@url{http://lensfun.sourceforge.net/}).
  9213. The @code{lensfun} filter requires the camera make, camera model, and lens model
  9214. to apply the lens correction. The filter will load the lensfun database and
  9215. query it to find the corresponding camera and lens entries in the database. As
  9216. long as these entries can be found with the given options, the filter can
  9217. perform corrections on frames. Note that incomplete strings will result in the
  9218. filter choosing the best match with the given options, and the filter will
  9219. output the chosen camera and lens models (logged with level "info"). You must
  9220. provide the make, camera model, and lens model as they are required.
  9221. The filter accepts the following options:
  9222. @table @option
  9223. @item make
  9224. The make of the camera (for example, "Canon"). This option is required.
  9225. @item model
  9226. The model of the camera (for example, "Canon EOS 100D"). This option is
  9227. required.
  9228. @item lens_model
  9229. The model of the lens (for example, "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM"). This
  9230. option is required.
  9231. @item mode
  9232. The type of correction to apply. The following values are valid options:
  9233. @table @samp
  9234. @item vignetting
  9235. Enables fixing lens vignetting.
  9236. @item geometry
  9237. Enables fixing lens geometry. This is the default.
  9238. @item subpixel
  9239. Enables fixing chromatic aberrations.
  9240. @item vig_geo
  9241. Enables fixing lens vignetting and lens geometry.
  9242. @item vig_subpixel
  9243. Enables fixing lens vignetting and chromatic aberrations.
  9244. @item distortion
  9245. Enables fixing both lens geometry and chromatic aberrations.
  9246. @item all
  9247. Enables all possible corrections.
  9248. @end table
  9249. @item focal_length
  9250. The focal length of the image/video (zoom; expected constant for video). For
  9251. example, a 18--55mm lens has focal length range of [18--55], so a value in that
  9252. range should be chosen when using that lens. Default 18.
  9253. @item aperture
  9254. The aperture of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9255. aperture is only used for vignetting correction. Default 3.5.
  9256. @item focus_distance
  9257. The focus distance of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9258. focus distance is only used for vignetting and only slightly affects the
  9259. vignetting correction process. If unknown, leave it at the default value (which
  9260. is 1000).
  9261. @item scale
  9262. The scale factor which is applied after transformation. After correction the
  9263. video is no longer necessarily rectangular. This parameter controls how much of
  9264. the resulting image is visible. The value 0 means that a value will be chosen
  9265. automatically such that there is little or no unmapped area in the output
  9266. image. 1.0 means that no additional scaling is done. Lower values may result
  9267. in more of the corrected image being visible, while higher values may avoid
  9268. unmapped areas in the output.
  9269. @item target_geometry
  9270. The target geometry of the output image/video. The following values are valid
  9271. options:
  9272. @table @samp
  9273. @item rectilinear (default)
  9274. @item fisheye
  9275. @item panoramic
  9276. @item equirectangular
  9277. @item fisheye_orthographic
  9278. @item fisheye_stereographic
  9279. @item fisheye_equisolid
  9280. @item fisheye_thoby
  9281. @end table
  9282. @item reverse
  9283. Apply the reverse of image correction (instead of correcting distortion, apply
  9284. it).
  9285. @item interpolation
  9286. The type of interpolation used when correcting distortion. The following values
  9287. are valid options:
  9288. @table @samp
  9289. @item nearest
  9290. @item linear (default)
  9291. @item lanczos
  9292. @end table
  9293. @end table
  9294. @subsection Examples
  9295. @itemize
  9296. @item
  9297. Apply lens correction with make "Canon", camera model "Canon EOS 100D", and lens
  9298. model "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM" with focal length of "18" and
  9299. aperture of "8.0".
  9300. @example
  9301. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8 -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9302. @end example
  9303. @item
  9304. Apply the same as before, but only for the first 5 seconds of video.
  9305. @example
  9306. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8:enable='lte(t\,5)' -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9307. @end example
  9308. @end itemize
  9309. @section libvmaf
  9310. Obtain the VMAF (Video Multi-Method Assessment Fusion)
  9311. score between two input videos.
  9312. The obtained VMAF score is printed through the logging system.
  9313. It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.
  9314. After installing the library it can be enabled using:
  9315. @code{./configure --enable-libvmaf --enable-version3}.
  9316. If no model path is specified it uses the default model: @code{vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl}.
  9317. The filter has following options:
  9318. @table @option
  9319. @item model_path
  9320. Set the model path which is to be used for SVM.
  9321. Default value: @code{"vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl"}
  9322. @item log_path
  9323. Set the file path to be used to store logs.
  9324. @item log_fmt
  9325. Set the format of the log file (xml or json).
  9326. @item enable_transform
  9327. This option can enable/disable the @code{score_transform} applied to the final predicted VMAF score,
  9328. if you have specified score_transform option in the input parameter file passed to @code{run_vmaf_training.py}
  9329. Default value: @code{false}
  9330. @item phone_model
  9331. Invokes the phone model which will generate VMAF scores higher than in the
  9332. regular model, which is more suitable for laptop, TV, etc. viewing conditions.
  9333. @item psnr
  9334. Enables computing psnr along with vmaf.
  9335. @item ssim
  9336. Enables computing ssim along with vmaf.
  9337. @item ms_ssim
  9338. Enables computing ms_ssim along with vmaf.
  9339. @item pool
  9340. Set the pool method (mean, min or harmonic mean) to be used for computing vmaf.
  9341. @item n_threads
  9342. Set number of threads to be used when computing vmaf.
  9343. @item n_subsample
  9344. Set interval for frame subsampling used when computing vmaf.
  9345. @item enable_conf_interval
  9346. Enables confidence interval.
  9347. @end table
  9348. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9349. On the below examples the input file @file{main.mpg} being processed is
  9350. compared with the reference file @file{ref.mpg}.
  9351. @example
  9352. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf -f null -
  9353. @end example
  9354. Example with options:
  9355. @example
  9356. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf="psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9357. @end example
  9358. @section limiter
  9359. Limits the pixel components values to the specified range [min, max].
  9360. The filter accepts the following options:
  9361. @table @option
  9362. @item min
  9363. Lower bound. Defaults to the lowest allowed value for the input.
  9364. @item max
  9365. Upper bound. Defaults to the highest allowed value for the input.
  9366. @item planes
  9367. Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.
  9368. @end table
  9369. @section loop
  9370. Loop video frames.
  9371. The filter accepts the following options:
  9372. @table @option
  9373. @item loop
  9374. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  9375. Default is 0.
  9376. @item size
  9377. Set maximal size in number of frames. Default is 0.
  9378. @item start
  9379. Set first frame of loop. Default is 0.
  9380. @end table
  9381. @subsection Examples
  9382. @itemize
  9383. @item
  9384. Loop single first frame infinitely:
  9385. @example
  9386. loop=loop=-1:size=1:start=0
  9387. @end example
  9388. @item
  9389. Loop single first frame 10 times:
  9390. @example
  9391. loop=loop=10:size=1:start=0
  9392. @end example
  9393. @item
  9394. Loop 10 first frames 5 times:
  9395. @example
  9396. loop=loop=5:size=10:start=0
  9397. @end example
  9398. @end itemize
  9399. @section lut1d
  9400. Apply a 1D LUT to an input video.
  9401. The filter accepts the following options:
  9402. @table @option
  9403. @item file
  9404. Set the 1D LUT file name.
  9405. Currently supported formats:
  9406. @table @samp
  9407. @item cube
  9408. Iridas
  9409. @item csp
  9410. cineSpace
  9411. @end table
  9412. @item interp
  9413. Select interpolation mode.
  9414. Available values are:
  9415. @table @samp
  9416. @item nearest
  9417. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9418. @item linear
  9419. Interpolate values using the linear interpolation.
  9420. @item cosine
  9421. Interpolate values using the cosine interpolation.
  9422. @item cubic
  9423. Interpolate values using the cubic interpolation.
  9424. @item spline
  9425. Interpolate values using the spline interpolation.
  9426. @end table
  9427. @end table
  9428. @anchor{lut3d}
  9429. @section lut3d
  9430. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  9431. The filter accepts the following options:
  9432. @table @option
  9433. @item file
  9434. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  9435. Currently supported formats:
  9436. @table @samp
  9437. @item 3dl
  9438. AfterEffects
  9439. @item cube
  9440. Iridas
  9441. @item dat
  9442. DaVinci
  9443. @item m3d
  9444. Pandora
  9445. @item csp
  9446. cineSpace
  9447. @end table
  9448. @item interp
  9449. Select interpolation mode.
  9450. Available values are:
  9451. @table @samp
  9452. @item nearest
  9453. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9454. @item trilinear
  9455. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  9456. @item tetrahedral
  9457. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  9458. @end table
  9459. @end table
  9460. @section lumakey
  9461. Turn certain luma values into transparency.
  9462. The filter accepts the following options:
  9463. @table @option
  9464. @item threshold
  9465. Set the luma which will be used as base for transparency.
  9466. Default value is @code{0}.
  9467. @item tolerance
  9468. Set the range of luma values to be keyed out.
  9469. Default value is @code{0}.
  9470. @item softness
  9471. Set the range of softness. Default value is @code{0}.
  9472. Use this to control gradual transition from zero to full transparency.
  9473. @end table
  9474. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  9475. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  9476. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  9477. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  9478. to an RGB input video.
  9479. These filters accept the following parameters:
  9480. @table @option
  9481. @item c0
  9482. set first pixel component expression
  9483. @item c1
  9484. set second pixel component expression
  9485. @item c2
  9486. set third pixel component expression
  9487. @item c3
  9488. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9489. @item r
  9490. set red component expression
  9491. @item g
  9492. set green component expression
  9493. @item b
  9494. set blue component expression
  9495. @item a
  9496. alpha component expression
  9497. @item y
  9498. set Y/luminance component expression
  9499. @item u
  9500. set U/Cb component expression
  9501. @item v
  9502. set V/Cr component expression
  9503. @end table
  9504. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9505. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9506. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9507. format in input.
  9508. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  9509. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  9510. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  9511. @table @option
  9512. @item w
  9513. @item h
  9514. The input width and height.
  9515. @item val
  9516. The input value for the pixel component.
  9517. @item clipval
  9518. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9519. @item maxval
  9520. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  9521. @item minval
  9522. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  9523. @item negval
  9524. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  9525. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  9526. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  9527. @item clip(val)
  9528. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  9529. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9530. @item gammaval(gamma)
  9531. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  9532. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  9533. expression
  9534. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  9535. @end table
  9536. All expressions default to "val".
  9537. @subsection Examples
  9538. @itemize
  9539. @item
  9540. Negate input video:
  9541. @example
  9542. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  9543. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  9544. @end example
  9545. The above is the same as:
  9546. @example
  9547. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  9548. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  9549. @end example
  9550. @item
  9551. Negate luminance:
  9552. @example
  9553. lutyuv=y=negval
  9554. @end example
  9555. @item
  9556. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  9557. @example
  9558. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  9559. @end example
  9560. @item
  9561. Apply a luma burning effect:
  9562. @example
  9563. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  9564. @end example
  9565. @item
  9566. Remove green and blue components:
  9567. @example
  9568. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  9569. @end example
  9570. @item
  9571. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  9572. @example
  9573. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  9574. @end example
  9575. @item
  9576. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  9577. @example
  9578. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  9579. @end example
  9580. @item
  9581. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  9582. @example
  9583. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  9584. @end example
  9585. @item
  9586. Technicolor like effect:
  9587. @example
  9588. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  9589. @end example
  9590. @end itemize
  9591. @section lut2, tlut2
  9592. The @code{lut2} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  9593. stream.
  9594. The @code{tlut2} (time lut2) filter takes two consecutive frames
  9595. from one single stream.
  9596. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  9597. @table @option
  9598. @item c0
  9599. set first pixel component expression
  9600. @item c1
  9601. set second pixel component expression
  9602. @item c2
  9603. set third pixel component expression
  9604. @item c3
  9605. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9606. @item d
  9607. set output bit depth, only available for @code{lut2} filter. By default is 0,
  9608. which means bit depth is automatically picked from first input format.
  9609. @end table
  9610. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9611. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9612. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9613. format in inputs.
  9614. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  9615. @table @option
  9616. @item w
  9617. @item h
  9618. The input width and height.
  9619. @item x
  9620. The first input value for the pixel component.
  9621. @item y
  9622. The second input value for the pixel component.
  9623. @item bdx
  9624. The first input video bit depth.
  9625. @item bdy
  9626. The second input video bit depth.
  9627. @end table
  9628. All expressions default to "x".
  9629. @subsection Examples
  9630. @itemize
  9631. @item
  9632. Highlight differences between two RGB video streams:
  9633. @example
  9634. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  9635. @end example
  9636. @item
  9637. Highlight differences between two YUV video streams:
  9638. @example
  9639. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  9640. @end example
  9641. @item
  9642. Show max difference between two video streams:
  9643. @example
  9644. lut2='if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1)))'
  9645. @end example
  9646. @end itemize
  9647. @section maskedclamp
  9648. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  9649. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  9650. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  9651. This filter accepts the following options:
  9652. @table @option
  9653. @item undershoot
  9654. Default value is @code{0}.
  9655. @item overshoot
  9656. Default value is @code{0}.
  9657. @item planes
  9658. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9659. copied from first stream.
  9660. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9661. @end table
  9662. @section maskedmerge
  9663. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  9664. weights in the third input stream.
  9665. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  9666. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  9667. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  9668. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  9669. input stream's pixel components.
  9670. This filter accepts the following options:
  9671. @table @option
  9672. @item planes
  9673. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9674. copied from first stream.
  9675. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9676. @end table
  9677. @section maskfun
  9678. Create mask from input video.
  9679. For example it is useful to create motion masks after @code{tblend} filter.
  9680. This filter accepts the following options:
  9681. @table @option
  9682. @item low
  9683. Set low threshold. Any pixel component lower or exact than this value will be set to 0.
  9684. @item high
  9685. Set high threshold. Any pixel component higher than this value will be set to max value
  9686. allowed for current pixel format.
  9687. @item planes
  9688. Set planes to filter, by default all available planes are filtered.
  9689. @item fill
  9690. Fill all frame pixels with this value.
  9691. @item sum
  9692. Set max average pixel value for frame. If sum of all pixel components is higher that this
  9693. average, output frame will be completely filled with value set by @var{fill} option.
  9694. Typically useful for scene changes when used in combination with @code{tblend} filter.
  9695. @end table
  9696. @section mcdeint
  9697. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  9698. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  9699. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  9700. This filter accepts the following options:
  9701. @table @option
  9702. @item mode
  9703. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  9704. It accepts one of the following values:
  9705. @table @samp
  9706. @item fast
  9707. @item medium
  9708. @item slow
  9709. use iterative motion estimation
  9710. @item extra_slow
  9711. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  9712. @end table
  9713. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  9714. @item parity
  9715. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  9716. one of the following values:
  9717. @table @samp
  9718. @item 0, tff
  9719. assume top field first
  9720. @item 1, bff
  9721. assume bottom field first
  9722. @end table
  9723. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  9724. @item qp
  9725. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  9726. encoder.
  9727. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  9728. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  9729. @end table
  9730. @section mergeplanes
  9731. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  9732. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  9733. planes to the output video.
  9734. This filter accepts the following options:
  9735. @table @option
  9736. @item mapping
  9737. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  9738. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  9739. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  9740. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  9741. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  9742. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  9743. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  9744. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  9745. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  9746. @item format
  9747. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  9748. @end table
  9749. @subsection Examples
  9750. @itemize
  9751. @item
  9752. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  9753. @example
  9754. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  9755. @end example
  9756. @item
  9757. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  9758. @example
  9759. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  9760. @end example
  9761. @item
  9762. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  9763. @example
  9764. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  9765. @end example
  9766. @item
  9767. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  9768. @example
  9769. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  9770. @end example
  9771. @item
  9772. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  9773. @example
  9774. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  9775. @end example
  9776. @end itemize
  9777. @section mestimate
  9778. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  9779. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  9780. This filter accepts the following options:
  9781. @table @option
  9782. @item method
  9783. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  9784. @table @samp
  9785. @item esa
  9786. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  9787. @item tss
  9788. Three step search algorithm.
  9789. @item tdls
  9790. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  9791. @item ntss
  9792. New three step search algorithm.
  9793. @item fss
  9794. Four step search algorithm.
  9795. @item ds
  9796. Diamond search algorithm.
  9797. @item hexbs
  9798. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  9799. @item epzs
  9800. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  9801. @item umh
  9802. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  9803. @end table
  9804. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  9805. @item mb_size
  9806. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  9807. @item search_param
  9808. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  9809. @end table
  9810. @section midequalizer
  9811. Apply Midway Image Equalization effect using two video streams.
  9812. Midway Image Equalization adjusts a pair of images to have the same
  9813. histogram, while maintaining their dynamics as much as possible. It's
  9814. useful for e.g. matching exposures from a pair of stereo cameras.
  9815. This filter has two inputs and one output, which must be of same pixel format, but
  9816. may be of different sizes. The output of filter is first input adjusted with
  9817. midway histogram of both inputs.
  9818. This filter accepts the following option:
  9819. @table @option
  9820. @item planes
  9821. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  9822. @end table
  9823. @section minterpolate
  9824. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  9825. This filter accepts the following options:
  9826. @table @option
  9827. @item fps
  9828. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  9829. @item mi_mode
  9830. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  9831. @table @samp
  9832. @item dup
  9833. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  9834. @item blend
  9835. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  9836. @item mci
  9837. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  9838. @table @samp
  9839. @item mc_mode
  9840. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  9841. @table @samp
  9842. @item obmc
  9843. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  9844. @item aobmc
  9845. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  9846. @end table
  9847. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  9848. @item me_mode
  9849. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  9850. @table @samp
  9851. @item bidir
  9852. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  9853. @item bilat
  9854. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  9855. @end table
  9856. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  9857. @item me
  9858. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  9859. @table @samp
  9860. @item esa
  9861. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  9862. @item tss
  9863. Three step search algorithm.
  9864. @item tdls
  9865. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  9866. @item ntss
  9867. New three step search algorithm.
  9868. @item fss
  9869. Four step search algorithm.
  9870. @item ds
  9871. Diamond search algorithm.
  9872. @item hexbs
  9873. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  9874. @item epzs
  9875. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  9876. @item umh
  9877. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  9878. @end table
  9879. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  9880. @item mb_size
  9881. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  9882. @item search_param
  9883. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  9884. @item vsbmc
  9885. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  9886. @end table
  9887. @end table
  9888. @item scd
  9889. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  9890. @table @samp
  9891. @item none
  9892. Disable scene change detection.
  9893. @item fdiff
  9894. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it satisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  9895. @end table
  9896. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  9897. @item scd_threshold
  9898. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{5.0}.
  9899. @end table
  9900. @section mix
  9901. Mix several video input streams into one video stream.
  9902. A description of the accepted options follows.
  9903. @table @option
  9904. @item nb_inputs
  9905. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  9906. @item weights
  9907. Specify weight of each input video stream as sequence.
  9908. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights
  9909. is smaller than number of @var{frames} last specified
  9910. weight will be used for all remaining unset weights.
  9911. @item scale
  9912. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  9913. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  9914. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  9915. @item duration
  9916. Specify how end of stream is determined.
  9917. @table @samp
  9918. @item longest
  9919. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  9920. @item shortest
  9921. The duration of the shortest input.
  9922. @item first
  9923. The duration of the first input.
  9924. @end table
  9925. @end table
  9926. @section mpdecimate
  9927. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  9928. order to reduce frame rate.
  9929. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  9930. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  9931. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  9932. A description of the accepted options follows.
  9933. @table @option
  9934. @item max
  9935. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  9936. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  9937. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding the
  9938. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  9939. Default value is 0.
  9940. @item hi
  9941. @item lo
  9942. @item frac
  9943. Set the dropping threshold values.
  9944. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  9945. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  9946. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  9947. out differently over the block.
  9948. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  9949. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  9950. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  9951. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  9952. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  9953. @end table
  9954. @section negate
  9955. Negate (invert) the input video.
  9956. It accepts the following option:
  9957. @table @option
  9958. @item negate_alpha
  9959. With value 1, it negates the alpha component, if present. Default value is 0.
  9960. @end table
  9961. @anchor{nlmeans}
  9962. @section nlmeans
  9963. Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  9964. Each pixel is adjusted by looking for other pixels with similar contexts. This
  9965. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  9966. @option{p}x@option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r}x@option{r}
  9967. around the pixel.
  9968. Note that the research area defines centers for patches, which means some
  9969. patches will be made of pixels outside that research area.
  9970. The filter accepts the following options.
  9971. @table @option
  9972. @item s
  9973. Set denoising strength. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 30.0].
  9974. @item p
  9975. Set patch size. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  9976. @item pc
  9977. Same as @option{p} but for chroma planes.
  9978. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  9979. @item r
  9980. Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  9981. @item rc
  9982. Same as @option{r} but for chroma planes.
  9983. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  9984. @end table
  9985. @section nnedi
  9986. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  9987. This filter accepts the following options:
  9988. @table @option
  9989. @item weights
  9990. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  9991. Currently file can be found here:
  9992. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  9993. @item deint
  9994. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  9995. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  9996. @item field
  9997. Set mode of operation.
  9998. Can be one of the following:
  9999. @table @samp
  10000. @item af
  10001. Use frame flags, both fields.
  10002. @item a
  10003. Use frame flags, single field.
  10004. @item t
  10005. Use top field only.
  10006. @item b
  10007. Use bottom field only.
  10008. @item tf
  10009. Use both fields, top first.
  10010. @item bf
  10011. Use both fields, bottom first.
  10012. @end table
  10013. @item planes
  10014. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  10015. @item nsize
  10016. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  10017. network.
  10018. Can be one of the following:
  10019. @table @samp
  10020. @item s8x6
  10021. @item s16x6
  10022. @item s32x6
  10023. @item s48x6
  10024. @item s8x4
  10025. @item s16x4
  10026. @item s32x4
  10027. @end table
  10028. @item nns
  10029. Set the number of neurons in predictor neural network.
  10030. Can be one of the following:
  10031. @table @samp
  10032. @item n16
  10033. @item n32
  10034. @item n64
  10035. @item n128
  10036. @item n256
  10037. @end table
  10038. @item qual
  10039. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  10040. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  10041. @code{slow}.
  10042. @item etype
  10043. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  10044. Can be one of the following:
  10045. @table @samp
  10046. @item a
  10047. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  10048. @item s
  10049. weights trained to minimize squared error
  10050. @end table
  10051. @item pscrn
  10052. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  10053. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  10054. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  10055. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  10056. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  10057. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  10058. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  10059. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  10060. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  10061. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  10062. Can be one of the following:
  10063. @table @samp
  10064. @item none
  10065. @item original
  10066. @item new
  10067. @end table
  10068. Default is @code{new}.
  10069. @item fapprox
  10070. Set various debugging flags.
  10071. @end table
  10072. @section noformat
  10073. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  10074. input to the next filter.
  10075. It accepts the following parameters:
  10076. @table @option
  10077. @item pix_fmts
  10078. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  10079. pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  10080. @end table
  10081. @subsection Examples
  10082. @itemize
  10083. @item
  10084. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  10085. input to the vflip filter:
  10086. @example
  10087. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  10088. @end example
  10089. @item
  10090. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  10091. @example
  10092. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  10093. @end example
  10094. @end itemize
  10095. @section noise
  10096. Add noise on video input frame.
  10097. The filter accepts the following options:
  10098. @table @option
  10099. @item all_seed
  10100. @item c0_seed
  10101. @item c1_seed
  10102. @item c2_seed
  10103. @item c3_seed
  10104. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10105. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  10106. @item all_strength, alls
  10107. @item c0_strength, c0s
  10108. @item c1_strength, c1s
  10109. @item c2_strength, c2s
  10110. @item c3_strength, c3s
  10111. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10112. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  10113. @item all_flags, allf
  10114. @item c0_flags, c0f
  10115. @item c1_flags, c1f
  10116. @item c2_flags, c2f
  10117. @item c3_flags, c3f
  10118. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  10119. Available values for component flags are:
  10120. @table @samp
  10121. @item a
  10122. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  10123. @item p
  10124. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  10125. @item t
  10126. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  10127. @item u
  10128. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  10129. @end table
  10130. @end table
  10131. @subsection Examples
  10132. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  10133. @example
  10134. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  10135. @end example
  10136. @section normalize
  10137. Normalize RGB video (aka histogram stretching, contrast stretching).
  10138. See: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normalization_(image_processing)
  10139. For each channel of each frame, the filter computes the input range and maps
  10140. it linearly to the user-specified output range. The output range defaults
  10141. to the full dynamic range from pure black to pure white.
  10142. Temporal smoothing can be used on the input range to reduce flickering (rapid
  10143. changes in brightness) caused when small dark or bright objects enter or leave
  10144. the scene. This is similar to the auto-exposure (automatic gain control) on a
  10145. video camera, and, like a video camera, it may cause a period of over- or
  10146. under-exposure of the video.
  10147. The R,G,B channels can be normalized independently, which may cause some
  10148. color shifting, or linked together as a single channel, which prevents
  10149. color shifting. Linked normalization preserves hue. Independent normalization
  10150. does not, so it can be used to remove some color casts. Independent and linked
  10151. normalization can be combined in any ratio.
  10152. The normalize filter accepts the following options:
  10153. @table @option
  10154. @item blackpt
  10155. @item whitept
  10156. Colors which define the output range. The minimum input value is mapped to
  10157. the @var{blackpt}. The maximum input value is mapped to the @var{whitept}.
  10158. The defaults are black and white respectively. Specifying white for
  10159. @var{blackpt} and black for @var{whitept} will give color-inverted,
  10160. normalized video. Shades of grey can be used to reduce the dynamic range
  10161. (contrast). Specifying saturated colors here can create some interesting
  10162. effects.
  10163. @item smoothing
  10164. The number of previous frames to use for temporal smoothing. The input range
  10165. of each channel is smoothed using a rolling average over the current frame
  10166. and the @var{smoothing} previous frames. The default is 0 (no temporal
  10167. smoothing).
  10168. @item independence
  10169. Controls the ratio of independent (color shifting) channel normalization to
  10170. linked (color preserving) normalization. 0.0 is fully linked, 1.0 is fully
  10171. independent. Defaults to 1.0 (fully independent).
  10172. @item strength
  10173. Overall strength of the filter. 1.0 is full strength. 0.0 is a rather
  10174. expensive no-op. Defaults to 1.0 (full strength).
  10175. @end table
  10176. @subsection Examples
  10177. Stretch video contrast to use the full dynamic range, with no temporal
  10178. smoothing; may flicker depending on the source content:
  10179. @example
  10180. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=0
  10181. @end example
  10182. As above, but with 50 frames of temporal smoothing; flicker should be
  10183. reduced, depending on the source content:
  10184. @example
  10185. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50
  10186. @end example
  10187. As above, but with hue-preserving linked channel normalization:
  10188. @example
  10189. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0
  10190. @end example
  10191. As above, but with half strength:
  10192. @example
  10193. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0:strength=0.5
  10194. @end example
  10195. Map the darkest input color to red, the brightest input color to cyan:
  10196. @example
  10197. normalize=blackpt=red:whitept=cyan
  10198. @end example
  10199. @section null
  10200. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  10201. @section ocr
  10202. Optical Character Recognition
  10203. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition. To enable
  10204. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10205. @code{--enable-libtesseract}.
  10206. It accepts the following options:
  10207. @table @option
  10208. @item datapath
  10209. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  10210. set at installation.
  10211. @item language
  10212. Set language, default is "eng".
  10213. @item whitelist
  10214. Set character whitelist.
  10215. @item blacklist
  10216. Set character blacklist.
  10217. @end table
  10218. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  10219. The filter exports confidence of recognized words as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.confidence}.
  10220. @section ocv
  10221. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  10222. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  10223. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  10224. It accepts the following parameters:
  10225. @table @option
  10226. @item filter_name
  10227. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  10228. @item filter_params
  10229. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  10230. values are assumed.
  10231. @end table
  10232. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  10233. information:
  10234. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  10235. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  10236. @anchor{dilate}
  10237. @subsection dilate
  10238. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10239. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  10240. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  10241. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  10242. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  10243. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  10244. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  10245. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  10246. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  10247. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  10248. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  10249. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  10250. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  10251. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  10252. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  10253. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  10254. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  10255. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  10256. Some examples:
  10257. @example
  10258. # Use the default values
  10259. ocv=dilate
  10260. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  10261. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  10262. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  10263. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  10264. # *
  10265. # ***
  10266. # *****
  10267. # ***
  10268. # *
  10269. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  10270. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  10271. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  10272. @end example
  10273. @subsection erode
  10274. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10275. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  10276. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  10277. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  10278. @subsection smooth
  10279. Smooth the input video.
  10280. The filter takes the following parameters:
  10281. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  10282. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  10283. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  10284. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  10285. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  10286. depends on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  10287. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  10288. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  10289. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  10290. other parameters is 0.
  10291. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  10292. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  10293. @section oscilloscope
  10294. 2D Video Oscilloscope.
  10295. Useful to measure spatial impulse, step responses, chroma delays, etc.
  10296. It accepts the following parameters:
  10297. @table @option
  10298. @item x
  10299. Set scope center x position.
  10300. @item y
  10301. Set scope center y position.
  10302. @item s
  10303. Set scope size, relative to frame diagonal.
  10304. @item t
  10305. Set scope tilt/rotation.
  10306. @item o
  10307. Set trace opacity.
  10308. @item tx
  10309. Set trace center x position.
  10310. @item ty
  10311. Set trace center y position.
  10312. @item tw
  10313. Set trace width, relative to width of frame.
  10314. @item th
  10315. Set trace height, relative to height of frame.
  10316. @item c
  10317. Set which components to trace. By default it traces first three components.
  10318. @item g
  10319. Draw trace grid. By default is enabled.
  10320. @item st
  10321. Draw some statistics. By default is enabled.
  10322. @item sc
  10323. Draw scope. By default is enabled.
  10324. @end table
  10325. @subsection Examples
  10326. @itemize
  10327. @item
  10328. Inspect full first row of video frame.
  10329. @example
  10330. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=0:s=1
  10331. @end example
  10332. @item
  10333. Inspect full last row of video frame.
  10334. @example
  10335. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=1:s=1
  10336. @end example
  10337. @item
  10338. Inspect full 5th line of video frame of height 1080.
  10339. @example
  10340. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=5/1080:s=1
  10341. @end example
  10342. @item
  10343. Inspect full last column of video frame.
  10344. @example
  10345. oscilloscope=x=1:y=0.5:s=1:t=1
  10346. @end example
  10347. @end itemize
  10348. @anchor{overlay}
  10349. @section overlay
  10350. Overlay one video on top of another.
  10351. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  10352. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  10353. It accepts the following parameters:
  10354. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10355. @table @option
  10356. @item x
  10357. @item y
  10358. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  10359. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  10360. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  10361. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  10362. @item eof_action
  10363. See @ref{framesync}.
  10364. @item eval
  10365. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  10366. It accepts the following values:
  10367. @table @samp
  10368. @item init
  10369. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10370. when a command is processed
  10371. @item frame
  10372. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10373. @end table
  10374. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  10375. @item shortest
  10376. See @ref{framesync}.
  10377. @item format
  10378. Set the format for the output video.
  10379. It accepts the following values:
  10380. @table @samp
  10381. @item yuv420
  10382. force YUV420 output
  10383. @item yuv422
  10384. force YUV422 output
  10385. @item yuv444
  10386. force YUV444 output
  10387. @item rgb
  10388. force packed RGB output
  10389. @item gbrp
  10390. force planar RGB output
  10391. @item auto
  10392. automatically pick format
  10393. @end table
  10394. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  10395. @item repeatlast
  10396. See @ref{framesync}.
  10397. @item alpha
  10398. Set format of alpha of the overlaid video, it can be @var{straight} or
  10399. @var{premultiplied}. Default is @var{straight}.
  10400. @end table
  10401. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  10402. parameters.
  10403. @table @option
  10404. @item main_w, W
  10405. @item main_h, H
  10406. The main input width and height.
  10407. @item overlay_w, w
  10408. @item overlay_h, h
  10409. The overlay input width and height.
  10410. @item x
  10411. @item y
  10412. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  10413. each new frame.
  10414. @item hsub
  10415. @item vsub
  10416. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  10417. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  10418. @var{vsub} is 1.
  10419. @item n
  10420. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10421. @item pos
  10422. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  10423. @item t
  10424. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  10425. @end table
  10426. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10427. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  10428. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  10429. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  10430. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  10431. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  10432. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  10433. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  10434. the @var{movie} filter does.
  10435. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  10436. efficiency of such approach.
  10437. @subsection Commands
  10438. This filter supports the following commands:
  10439. @table @option
  10440. @item x
  10441. @item y
  10442. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  10443. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10444. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10445. value.
  10446. @end table
  10447. @subsection Examples
  10448. @itemize
  10449. @item
  10450. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  10451. video:
  10452. @example
  10453. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  10454. @end example
  10455. Using named options the example above becomes:
  10456. @example
  10457. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  10458. @end example
  10459. @item
  10460. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  10461. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  10462. @example
  10463. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  10464. @end example
  10465. @item
  10466. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  10467. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  10468. @example
  10469. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  10470. @end example
  10471. @item
  10472. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  10473. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  10474. @example
  10475. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  10476. @end example
  10477. @item
  10478. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  10479. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  10480. @example
  10481. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  10482. @end example
  10483. The above command is the same as:
  10484. @example
  10485. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  10486. @end example
  10487. @item
  10488. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  10489. screen starting since time 2:
  10490. @example
  10491. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  10492. @end example
  10493. @item
  10494. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  10495. @example
  10496. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  10497. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  10498. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  10499. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  10500. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  10501. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  10502. "
  10503. @end example
  10504. @item
  10505. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  10506. @example
  10507. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  10508. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  10509. masked.avi
  10510. @end example
  10511. @item
  10512. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  10513. @example
  10514. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  10515. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  10516. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  10517. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  10518. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  10519. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  10520. @end example
  10521. @end itemize
  10522. @section owdenoise
  10523. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  10524. The filter accepts the following options:
  10525. @table @option
  10526. @item depth
  10527. Set depth.
  10528. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  10529. slow down filtering.
  10530. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  10531. @item luma_strength, ls
  10532. Set luma strength.
  10533. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10534. @item chroma_strength, cs
  10535. Set chroma strength.
  10536. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10537. @end table
  10538. @anchor{pad}
  10539. @section pad
  10540. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  10541. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  10542. It accepts the following parameters:
  10543. @table @option
  10544. @item width, w
  10545. @item height, h
  10546. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  10547. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  10548. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  10549. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  10550. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  10551. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  10552. @item x
  10553. @item y
  10554. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  10555. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  10556. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  10557. expression, and vice versa.
  10558. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  10559. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  10560. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  10561. @item color
  10562. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  10563. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  10564. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10565. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  10566. @item eval
  10567. Specify when to evaluate @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x} and @var{y} expression.
  10568. It accepts the following values:
  10569. @table @samp
  10570. @item init
  10571. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when
  10572. a command is processed.
  10573. @item frame
  10574. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  10575. @end table
  10576. Default value is @samp{init}.
  10577. @item aspect
  10578. Pad to aspect instead to a resolution.
  10579. @end table
  10580. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  10581. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  10582. @table @option
  10583. @item in_w
  10584. @item in_h
  10585. The input video width and height.
  10586. @item iw
  10587. @item ih
  10588. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  10589. @item out_w
  10590. @item out_h
  10591. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  10592. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  10593. @item ow
  10594. @item oh
  10595. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  10596. @item x
  10597. @item y
  10598. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  10599. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  10600. @item a
  10601. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  10602. @item sar
  10603. input sample aspect ratio
  10604. @item dar
  10605. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  10606. @item hsub
  10607. @item vsub
  10608. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  10609. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  10610. @end table
  10611. @subsection Examples
  10612. @itemize
  10613. @item
  10614. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  10615. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  10616. column 0, row 40
  10617. @example
  10618. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  10619. @end example
  10620. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  10621. @example
  10622. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  10623. @end example
  10624. @item
  10625. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  10626. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  10627. @example
  10628. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10629. @end example
  10630. @item
  10631. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  10632. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  10633. the center of the padded area:
  10634. @example
  10635. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10636. @end example
  10637. @item
  10638. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  10639. @example
  10640. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10641. @end example
  10642. @item
  10643. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  10644. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  10645. according to the relation:
  10646. @example
  10647. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  10648. X = output_dar / sar
  10649. @end example
  10650. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  10651. @example
  10652. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10653. @end example
  10654. @item
  10655. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  10656. corner of the output padded area:
  10657. @example
  10658. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  10659. @end example
  10660. @end itemize
  10661. @anchor{palettegen}
  10662. @section palettegen
  10663. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  10664. It accepts the following options:
  10665. @table @option
  10666. @item max_colors
  10667. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  10668. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  10669. will be black.
  10670. @item reserve_transparent
  10671. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  10672. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  10673. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  10674. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  10675. Set by default.
  10676. @item transparency_color
  10677. Set the color that will be used as background for transparency.
  10678. @item stats_mode
  10679. Set statistics mode.
  10680. It accepts the following values:
  10681. @table @samp
  10682. @item full
  10683. Compute full frame histograms.
  10684. @item diff
  10685. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  10686. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  10687. the background is static.
  10688. @item single
  10689. Compute new histogram for each frame.
  10690. @end table
  10691. Default value is @var{full}.
  10692. @end table
  10693. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  10694. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  10695. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  10696. @var{info} logging level.
  10697. @subsection Examples
  10698. @itemize
  10699. @item
  10700. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  10701. @example
  10702. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  10703. @end example
  10704. @end itemize
  10705. @section paletteuse
  10706. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  10707. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  10708. be a 256 pixels image.
  10709. It accepts the following options:
  10710. @table @option
  10711. @item dither
  10712. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  10713. @table @samp
  10714. @item bayer
  10715. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  10716. @item heckbert
  10717. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  10718. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  10719. reference.
  10720. @item floyd_steinberg
  10721. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  10722. @item sierra2
  10723. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  10724. @item sierra2_4a
  10725. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  10726. @end table
  10727. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  10728. @item bayer_scale
  10729. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  10730. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  10731. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  10732. at the cost of more banding.
  10733. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  10734. @item diff_mode
  10735. If set, define the zone to process
  10736. @table @samp
  10737. @item rectangle
  10738. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  10739. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  10740. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  10741. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  10742. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  10743. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  10744. @end table
  10745. Default is @var{none}.
  10746. @item new
  10747. Take new palette for each output frame.
  10748. @item alpha_threshold
  10749. Sets the alpha threshold for transparency. Alpha values above this threshold
  10750. will be treated as completely opaque, and values below this threshold will be
  10751. treated as completely transparent.
  10752. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,255]. Default is @var{128}.
  10753. @end table
  10754. @subsection Examples
  10755. @itemize
  10756. @item
  10757. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  10758. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  10759. @example
  10760. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  10761. @end example
  10762. @end itemize
  10763. @section perspective
  10764. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  10765. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  10766. @table @option
  10767. @item x0
  10768. @item y0
  10769. @item x1
  10770. @item y1
  10771. @item x2
  10772. @item y2
  10773. @item x3
  10774. @item y3
  10775. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  10776. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  10777. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  10778. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  10779. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  10780. The expressions can use the following variables:
  10781. @table @option
  10782. @item W
  10783. @item H
  10784. the width and height of video frame.
  10785. @item in
  10786. Input frame count.
  10787. @item on
  10788. Output frame count.
  10789. @end table
  10790. @item interpolation
  10791. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  10792. It accepts the following values:
  10793. @table @samp
  10794. @item linear
  10795. @item cubic
  10796. @end table
  10797. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  10798. @item sense
  10799. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  10800. It accepts the following values:
  10801. @table @samp
  10802. @item 0, source
  10803. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  10804. the corners of the destination.
  10805. @item 1, destination
  10806. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  10807. by the given coordinates.
  10808. Default value is @samp{source}.
  10809. @end table
  10810. @item eval
  10811. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  10812. It accepts the following values:
  10813. @table @samp
  10814. @item init
  10815. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10816. when a command is processed
  10817. @item frame
  10818. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10819. @end table
  10820. Default value is @samp{init}.
  10821. @end table
  10822. @section phase
  10823. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  10824. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  10825. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  10826. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  10827. @table @option
  10828. @item mode
  10829. Set phase mode.
  10830. It accepts the following values:
  10831. @table @samp
  10832. @item t
  10833. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  10834. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  10835. @item b
  10836. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  10837. Filter will delay the top field.
  10838. @item p
  10839. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  10840. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  10841. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  10842. @item a
  10843. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  10844. opposite.
  10845. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  10846. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  10847. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  10848. @item u
  10849. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  10850. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  10851. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  10852. match between the fields.
  10853. @item T
  10854. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  10855. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  10856. @item B
  10857. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  10858. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  10859. @item A
  10860. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  10861. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  10862. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  10863. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  10864. @item U
  10865. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  10866. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  10867. @end table
  10868. @end table
  10869. @section photosensitivity
  10870. Reduce various flashes in video, so to help users with epilepsy.
  10871. It accepts the following options:
  10872. @table @option
  10873. @item frames, f
  10874. Set how many frames to use when filtering. Default is 30.
  10875. @item threshold, t
  10876. Set detection threshold factor. Default is 1.
  10877. Lower is stricter.
  10878. @item skip
  10879. Set how many pixels to skip when sampling frames. Defalt is 1.
  10880. Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.
  10881. @item bypass
  10882. Leave frames unchanged. Default is disabled.
  10883. @end table
  10884. @section pixdesctest
  10885. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  10886. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  10887. For example:
  10888. @example
  10889. format=monow, pixdesctest
  10890. @end example
  10891. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  10892. @section pixscope
  10893. Display sample values of color channels. Mainly useful for checking color
  10894. and levels. Minimum supported resolution is 640x480.
  10895. The filters accept the following options:
  10896. @table @option
  10897. @item x
  10898. Set scope X position, relative offset on X axis.
  10899. @item y
  10900. Set scope Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  10901. @item w
  10902. Set scope width.
  10903. @item h
  10904. Set scope height.
  10905. @item o
  10906. Set window opacity. This window also holds statistics about pixel area.
  10907. @item wx
  10908. Set window X position, relative offset on X axis.
  10909. @item wy
  10910. Set window Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  10911. @end table
  10912. @section pp
  10913. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  10914. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  10915. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  10916. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  10917. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  10918. The filters accept the following options:
  10919. @table @option
  10920. @item subfilters
  10921. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  10922. @end table
  10923. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  10924. @table @option
  10925. @item a/autoq
  10926. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  10927. @item c/chrom
  10928. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  10929. @item y/nochrom
  10930. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  10931. @item n/noluma
  10932. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  10933. @end table
  10934. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  10935. Available subfilters are:
  10936. @table @option
  10937. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  10938. Horizontal deblocking filter
  10939. @table @option
  10940. @item difference
  10941. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  10942. @item flatness
  10943. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  10944. @end table
  10945. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  10946. Vertical deblocking filter
  10947. @table @option
  10948. @item difference
  10949. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  10950. @item flatness
  10951. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  10952. @end table
  10953. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  10954. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  10955. @table @option
  10956. @item difference
  10957. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  10958. @item flatness
  10959. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  10960. @end table
  10961. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  10962. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  10963. @table @option
  10964. @item difference
  10965. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  10966. @item flatness
  10967. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  10968. @end table
  10969. @end table
  10970. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  10971. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  10972. thresholds.
  10973. @table @option
  10974. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  10975. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  10976. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  10977. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  10978. @item dr/dering
  10979. Deringing filter
  10980. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  10981. @table @option
  10982. @item threshold1
  10983. larger -> stronger filtering
  10984. @item threshold2
  10985. larger -> stronger filtering
  10986. @item threshold3
  10987. larger -> stronger filtering
  10988. @end table
  10989. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  10990. @table @option
  10991. @item f/fullyrange
  10992. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  10993. @end table
  10994. @item lb/linblenddeint
  10995. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  10996. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  10997. @item li/linipoldeint
  10998. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  10999. linearly interpolating every second line.
  11000. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  11001. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  11002. cubically interpolating every second line.
  11003. @item md/mediandeint
  11004. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  11005. median filter to every second line.
  11006. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  11007. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  11008. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  11009. @item l5/lowpass5
  11010. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  11011. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  11012. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  11013. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  11014. specify.
  11015. @table @option
  11016. @item quantizer
  11017. Quantizer to use
  11018. @end table
  11019. @item de/default
  11020. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  11021. @item fa/fast
  11022. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  11023. @item ac
  11024. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  11025. @end table
  11026. @subsection Examples
  11027. @itemize
  11028. @item
  11029. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  11030. brightness/contrast:
  11031. @example
  11032. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  11033. @end example
  11034. @item
  11035. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  11036. @example
  11037. pp=de/-al
  11038. @end example
  11039. @item
  11040. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  11041. @example
  11042. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  11043. @end example
  11044. @item
  11045. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  11046. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  11047. @example
  11048. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  11049. @end example
  11050. @end itemize
  11051. @section pp7
  11052. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  11053. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  11054. used after IDCT.
  11055. The filter accepts the following options:
  11056. @table @option
  11057. @item qp
  11058. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  11059. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  11060. (if available).
  11061. @item mode
  11062. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  11063. @table @samp
  11064. @item hard
  11065. Set hard thresholding.
  11066. @item soft
  11067. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  11068. @item medium
  11069. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  11070. @end table
  11071. @end table
  11072. @section premultiply
  11073. Apply alpha premultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  11074. of second stream as alpha.
  11075. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  11076. The filter accepts the following option:
  11077. @table @option
  11078. @item planes
  11079. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11080. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11081. @item inplace
  11082. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  11083. @end table
  11084. @section prewitt
  11085. Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.
  11086. The filter accepts the following option:
  11087. @table @option
  11088. @item planes
  11089. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11090. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11091. @item scale
  11092. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11093. @item delta
  11094. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11095. @end table
  11096. @anchor{program_opencl}
  11097. @section program_opencl
  11098. Filter video using an OpenCL program.
  11099. @table @option
  11100. @item source
  11101. OpenCL program source file.
  11102. @item kernel
  11103. Kernel name in program.
  11104. @item inputs
  11105. Number of inputs to the filter. Defaults to 1.
  11106. @item size, s
  11107. Size of output frames. Defaults to the same as the first input.
  11108. @end table
  11109. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  11110. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  11111. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  11112. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  11113. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  11114. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  11115. @itemize
  11116. @item
  11117. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  11118. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  11119. @item
  11120. Frame index, @var{unsigned int}.
  11121. This is a counter starting from zero and increasing by one for each frame.
  11122. @item
  11123. Source images, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  11124. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  11125. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  11126. @end itemize
  11127. Example programs:
  11128. @itemize
  11129. @item
  11130. Copy the input to the output (output must be the same size as the input).
  11131. @verbatim
  11132. __kernel void copy(__write_only image2d_t destination,
  11133. unsigned int index,
  11134. __read_only image2d_t source)
  11135. {
  11136. const sampler_t sampler = CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE;
  11137. int2 location = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11138. float4 value = read_imagef(source, sampler, location);
  11139. write_imagef(destination, location, value);
  11140. }
  11141. @end verbatim
  11142. @item
  11143. Apply a simple transformation, rotating the input by an amount increasing
  11144. with the index counter. Pixel values are linearly interpolated by the
  11145. sampler, and the output need not have the same dimensions as the input.
  11146. @verbatim
  11147. __kernel void rotate_image(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  11148. unsigned int index,
  11149. __read_only image2d_t src)
  11150. {
  11151. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  11152. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  11153. float angle = (float)index / 100.0f;
  11154. float2 dst_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  11155. float2 src_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(src));
  11156. float2 dst_cen = dst_dim / 2.0f;
  11157. float2 src_cen = src_dim / 2.0f;
  11158. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11159. float2 dst_pos = convert_float2(dst_loc) - dst_cen;
  11160. float2 src_pos = {
  11161. cos(angle) * dst_pos.x - sin(angle) * dst_pos.y,
  11162. sin(angle) * dst_pos.x + cos(angle) * dst_pos.y
  11163. };
  11164. src_pos = src_pos * src_dim / dst_dim;
  11165. float2 src_loc = src_pos + src_cen;
  11166. if (src_loc.x < 0.0f || src_loc.y < 0.0f ||
  11167. src_loc.x > src_dim.x || src_loc.y > src_dim.y)
  11168. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, 0.5f);
  11169. else
  11170. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, read_imagef(src, sampler, src_loc));
  11171. }
  11172. @end verbatim
  11173. @item
  11174. Blend two inputs together, with the amount of each input used varying
  11175. with the index counter.
  11176. @verbatim
  11177. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  11178. unsigned int index,
  11179. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  11180. __read_only image2d_t src2)
  11181. {
  11182. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  11183. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  11184. float blend = (cos((float)index / 50.0f) + 1.0f) / 2.0f;
  11185. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11186. int2 src1_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src1) / get_image_dim(dst);
  11187. int2 src2_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src2) / get_image_dim(dst);
  11188. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, src1_loc);
  11189. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, src2_loc);
  11190. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, val1 * blend + val2 * (1.0f - blend));
  11191. }
  11192. @end verbatim
  11193. @end itemize
  11194. @section pseudocolor
  11195. Alter frame colors in video with pseudocolors.
  11196. This filter accepts the following options:
  11197. @table @option
  11198. @item c0
  11199. set pixel first component expression
  11200. @item c1
  11201. set pixel second component expression
  11202. @item c2
  11203. set pixel third component expression
  11204. @item c3
  11205. set pixel fourth component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  11206. @item i
  11207. set component to use as base for altering colors
  11208. @end table
  11209. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  11210. the corresponding pixel component values.
  11211. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  11212. @table @option
  11213. @item w
  11214. @item h
  11215. The input width and height.
  11216. @item val
  11217. The input value for the pixel component.
  11218. @item ymin, umin, vmin, amin
  11219. The minimum allowed component value.
  11220. @item ymax, umax, vmax, amax
  11221. The maximum allowed component value.
  11222. @end table
  11223. All expressions default to "val".
  11224. @subsection Examples
  11225. @itemize
  11226. @item
  11227. Change too high luma values to gradient:
  11228. @example
  11229. pseudocolor="'if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(ymin,ymax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(umax,umin,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(vmin,vmax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):-1'"
  11230. @end example
  11231. @end itemize
  11232. @section psnr
  11233. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  11234. Ratio) between two input videos.
  11235. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  11236. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  11237. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  11238. the PSNR.
  11239. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  11240. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  11241. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  11242. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  11243. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  11244. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  11245. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  11246. @example
  11247. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  11248. @end example
  11249. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  11250. image.
  11251. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11252. @table @option
  11253. @item stats_file, f
  11254. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  11255. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  11256. standard output.
  11257. @item stats_version
  11258. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  11259. each format are written below.
  11260. Default value is 1.
  11261. @item stats_add_max
  11262. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  11263. Default value is 0.
  11264. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  11265. the filter will return an error.
  11266. @end table
  11267. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11268. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  11269. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  11270. couple of frames.
  11271. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  11272. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  11273. format with the following parameters:
  11274. @table @option
  11275. @item psnr_log_version
  11276. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  11277. @item fields
  11278. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  11279. the log.
  11280. @end table
  11281. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  11282. @table @option
  11283. @item n
  11284. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  11285. @item mse_avg
  11286. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11287. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  11288. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_b, mse_a
  11289. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11290. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  11291. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  11292. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  11293. specified by the suffix.
  11294. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  11295. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  11296. channels.
  11297. @end table
  11298. For example:
  11299. @example
  11300. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  11301. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  11302. @end example
  11303. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  11304. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  11305. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  11306. @anchor{pullup}
  11307. @section pullup
  11308. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  11309. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  11310. content.
  11311. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  11312. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  11313. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  11314. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  11315. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  11316. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  11317. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  11318. The filter accepts the following options:
  11319. @table @option
  11320. @item jl
  11321. @item jr
  11322. @item jt
  11323. @item jb
  11324. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  11325. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  11326. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  11327. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  11328. @item sb
  11329. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  11330. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  11331. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  11332. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  11333. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  11334. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  11335. Default value is @code{0}.
  11336. @item mp
  11337. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  11338. @table @samp
  11339. @item l
  11340. Use luma plane.
  11341. @item u
  11342. Use chroma blue plane.
  11343. @item v
  11344. Use chroma red plane.
  11345. @end table
  11346. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  11347. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  11348. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  11349. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  11350. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  11351. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  11352. @end table
  11353. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  11354. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  11355. telecine NTSC input:
  11356. @example
  11357. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  11358. @end example
  11359. @section qp
  11360. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  11361. The filter accepts the following option:
  11362. @table @option
  11363. @item qp
  11364. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  11365. @end table
  11366. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  11367. the following constants:
  11368. @table @var
  11369. @item known
  11370. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  11371. @item qp
  11372. Sequential index starting from -129 to 128.
  11373. @end table
  11374. @subsection Examples
  11375. @itemize
  11376. @item
  11377. Some equation like:
  11378. @example
  11379. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  11380. @end example
  11381. @end itemize
  11382. @section random
  11383. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  11384. No frame is discarded.
  11385. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  11386. @table @option
  11387. @item frames
  11388. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  11389. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  11390. @item seed
  11391. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  11392. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  11393. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  11394. best effort basis.
  11395. @end table
  11396. @section readeia608
  11397. Read closed captioning (EIA-608) information from the top lines of a video frame.
  11398. This filter adds frame metadata for @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.cc} and
  11399. @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.line}, where @code{X} is the number of the identified line
  11400. with EIA-608 data (starting from 0). A description of each metadata value follows:
  11401. @table @option
  11402. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.cc
  11403. The two bytes stored as EIA-608 data (printed in hexadecimal).
  11404. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.line
  11405. The number of the line on which the EIA-608 data was identified and read.
  11406. @end table
  11407. This filter accepts the following options:
  11408. @table @option
  11409. @item scan_min
  11410. Set the line to start scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{0}.
  11411. @item scan_max
  11412. Set the line to end scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{29}.
  11413. @item mac
  11414. Set minimal acceptable amplitude change for sync codes detection.
  11415. Default is @code{0.2}. Allowed range is @code{[0.001 - 1]}.
  11416. @item spw
  11417. Set the ratio of width reserved for sync code detection.
  11418. Default is @code{0.27}. Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 0.7]}.
  11419. @item mhd
  11420. Set the max peaks height difference for sync code detection.
  11421. Default is @code{0.1}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11422. @item mpd
  11423. Set max peaks period difference for sync code detection.
  11424. Default is @code{0.1}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11425. @item msd
  11426. Set the first two max start code bits differences.
  11427. Default is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11428. @item bhd
  11429. Set the minimum ratio of bits height compared to 3rd start code bit.
  11430. Default is @code{0.75}. Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 1]}.
  11431. @item th_w
  11432. Set the white color threshold. Default is @code{0.35}. Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 1]}.
  11433. @item th_b
  11434. Set the black color threshold. Default is @code{0.15}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11435. @item chp
  11436. Enable checking the parity bit. In the event of a parity error, the filter will output
  11437. @code{0x00} for that character. Default is false.
  11438. @item lp
  11439. Lowpass lines prior to further processing. Default is disabled.
  11440. @end table
  11441. @subsection Examples
  11442. @itemize
  11443. @item
  11444. Output a csv with presentation time and the first two lines of identified EIA-608 captioning data.
  11445. @example
  11446. ffprobe -f lavfi -i movie=captioned_video.mov,readeia608 -show_entries frame=pkt_pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.readeia608.0.cc,lavfi.readeia608.1.cc -of csv
  11447. @end example
  11448. @end itemize
  11449. @section readvitc
  11450. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  11451. video frame.
  11452. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  11453. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  11454. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  11455. timecode data has been found or not.
  11456. This filter accepts the following options:
  11457. @table @option
  11458. @item scan_max
  11459. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  11460. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  11461. @item thr_b
  11462. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11463. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  11464. @item thr_w
  11465. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11466. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  11467. @end table
  11468. @subsection Examples
  11469. @itemize
  11470. @item
  11471. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  11472. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  11473. @example
  11474. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  11475. @end example
  11476. @end itemize
  11477. @section remap
  11478. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  11479. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  11480. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  11481. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  11482. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  11483. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  11484. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  11485. @table @option
  11486. @item format
  11487. Specify pixel format of output from this filter. Can be @code{color} or @code{gray}.
  11488. Default is @code{color}.
  11489. @end table
  11490. @section removegrain
  11491. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  11492. @table @option
  11493. @item m0
  11494. Set mode for the first plane.
  11495. @item m1
  11496. Set mode for the second plane.
  11497. @item m2
  11498. Set mode for the third plane.
  11499. @item m3
  11500. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  11501. @end table
  11502. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  11503. @table @var
  11504. @item 0
  11505. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  11506. @item 1
  11507. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11508. @item 2
  11509. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11510. @item 3
  11511. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11512. @item 4
  11513. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11514. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  11515. @item 5
  11516. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  11517. @item 6
  11518. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11519. @item 7
  11520. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11521. @item 8
  11522. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11523. @item 9
  11524. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  11525. @item 10
  11526. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  11527. @item 11
  11528. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  11529. @item 12
  11530. Same as mode 11.
  11531. @item 13
  11532. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  11533. pixels are the closest.
  11534. @item 14
  11535. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  11536. pixels are the closest.
  11537. @item 15
  11538. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  11539. interpolation formula.
  11540. @item 16
  11541. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  11542. interpolation formula.
  11543. @item 17
  11544. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  11545. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  11546. @item 18
  11547. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  11548. the current pixel is minimal.
  11549. @item 19
  11550. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  11551. @item 20
  11552. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  11553. @item 21
  11554. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  11555. @item 22
  11556. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  11557. @item 23
  11558. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  11559. @item 24
  11560. Similar as 23.
  11561. @end table
  11562. @section removelogo
  11563. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  11564. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  11565. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  11566. The filter accepts the following options:
  11567. @table @option
  11568. @item filename, f
  11569. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  11570. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  11571. video stream being processed.
  11572. @end table
  11573. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  11574. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  11575. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  11576. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  11577. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  11578. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  11579. filter once or twice.
  11580. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  11581. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  11582. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  11583. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  11584. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  11585. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  11586. @section repeatfields
  11587. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  11588. fields based on its value.
  11589. @section reverse
  11590. Reverse a video clip.
  11591. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  11592. is suggested.
  11593. @subsection Examples
  11594. @itemize
  11595. @item
  11596. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  11597. @example
  11598. trim=end=5,reverse
  11599. @end example
  11600. @end itemize
  11601. @section rgbashift
  11602. Shift R/G/B/A pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  11603. The filter accepts the following options:
  11604. @table @option
  11605. @item rh
  11606. Set amount to shift red horizontally.
  11607. @item rv
  11608. Set amount to shift red vertically.
  11609. @item gh
  11610. Set amount to shift green horizontally.
  11611. @item gv
  11612. Set amount to shift green vertically.
  11613. @item bh
  11614. Set amount to shift blue horizontally.
  11615. @item bv
  11616. Set amount to shift blue vertically.
  11617. @item ah
  11618. Set amount to shift alpha horizontally.
  11619. @item av
  11620. Set amount to shift alpha vertically.
  11621. @item edge
  11622. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  11623. @end table
  11624. @section roberts
  11625. Apply roberts cross operator to input video stream.
  11626. The filter accepts the following option:
  11627. @table @option
  11628. @item planes
  11629. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11630. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11631. @item scale
  11632. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11633. @item delta
  11634. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11635. @end table
  11636. @section rotate
  11637. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  11638. The filter accepts the following options:
  11639. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  11640. @table @option
  11641. @item angle, a
  11642. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  11643. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  11644. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  11645. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  11646. @item out_w, ow
  11647. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  11648. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  11649. @item out_h, oh
  11650. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  11651. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  11652. @item bilinear
  11653. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  11654. it. Default value is 1.
  11655. @item fillcolor, c
  11656. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  11657. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the
  11658. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11659. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  11660. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  11661. Default value is "black".
  11662. @end table
  11663. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  11664. following constants and functions:
  11665. @table @option
  11666. @item n
  11667. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  11668. before the first frame is filtered.
  11669. @item t
  11670. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  11671. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  11672. @item hsub
  11673. @item vsub
  11674. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11675. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11676. @item in_w, iw
  11677. @item in_h, ih
  11678. the input video width and height
  11679. @item out_w, ow
  11680. @item out_h, oh
  11681. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  11682. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  11683. @item rotw(a)
  11684. @item roth(a)
  11685. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  11686. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  11687. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  11688. @option{out_h} expressions.
  11689. @end table
  11690. @subsection Examples
  11691. @itemize
  11692. @item
  11693. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  11694. @example
  11695. rotate=PI/6
  11696. @end example
  11697. @item
  11698. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  11699. @example
  11700. rotate=-PI/6
  11701. @end example
  11702. @item
  11703. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  11704. @example
  11705. rotate=45*PI/180
  11706. @end example
  11707. @item
  11708. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  11709. @example
  11710. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  11711. @end example
  11712. @item
  11713. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  11714. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  11715. @example
  11716. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  11717. @end example
  11718. @item
  11719. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  11720. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  11721. @example
  11722. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  11723. @end example
  11724. @item
  11725. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  11726. shown:
  11727. @example
  11728. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  11729. @end example
  11730. @end itemize
  11731. @subsection Commands
  11732. The filter supports the following commands:
  11733. @table @option
  11734. @item a, angle
  11735. Set the angle expression.
  11736. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  11737. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  11738. value.
  11739. @end table
  11740. @section sab
  11741. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  11742. The filter accepts the following options:
  11743. @table @option
  11744. @item luma_radius, lr
  11745. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  11746. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  11747. in slower processing.
  11748. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  11749. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  11750. value is 1.0.
  11751. @item luma_strength, ls
  11752. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  11753. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  11754. @item chroma_radius, cr
  11755. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  11756. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  11757. processing.
  11758. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  11759. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  11760. @item chroma_strength, cs
  11761. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  11762. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  11763. @end table
  11764. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  11765. corresponding luma option value.
  11766. @anchor{scale}
  11767. @section scale
  11768. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  11769. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  11770. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  11771. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  11772. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  11773. requested format.
  11774. @subsection Options
  11775. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  11776. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  11777. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  11778. the complete list of scaler options.
  11779. @table @option
  11780. @item width, w
  11781. @item height, h
  11782. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  11783. dimension.
  11784. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  11785. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  11786. is used for the output.
  11787. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the scale filter
  11788. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  11789. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  11790. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  11791. adjust the value if necessary.
  11792. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  11793. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  11794. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  11795. expression.
  11796. @item eval
  11797. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  11798. @table @samp
  11799. @item init
  11800. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  11801. @item frame
  11802. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  11803. @end table
  11804. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11805. @item interl
  11806. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  11807. @table @samp
  11808. @item 1
  11809. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  11810. @item 0
  11811. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  11812. @item -1
  11813. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  11814. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  11815. @end table
  11816. Default value is @samp{0}.
  11817. @item flags
  11818. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  11819. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  11820. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  11821. the default flags.
  11822. @item param0, param1
  11823. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  11824. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  11825. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  11826. empty parameters.
  11827. @item size, s
  11828. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11829. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11830. @item in_color_matrix
  11831. @item out_color_matrix
  11832. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  11833. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  11834. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  11835. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  11836. Possible values:
  11837. @table @samp
  11838. @item auto
  11839. Choose automatically.
  11840. @item bt709
  11841. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  11842. Recommendation BT.709.
  11843. @item fcc
  11844. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  11845. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  11846. @item bt601
  11847. @item bt470
  11848. @item smpte170m
  11849. Set color space conforming to:
  11850. @itemize
  11851. @item
  11852. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  11853. @item
  11854. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  11855. @item
  11856. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  11857. @end itemize
  11858. @item smpte240m
  11859. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  11860. @item bt2020
  11861. Set color space conforming to ITU-R BT.2020 non-constant luminance system.
  11862. @end table
  11863. @item in_range
  11864. @item out_range
  11865. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  11866. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  11867. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  11868. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  11869. @table @samp
  11870. @item auto/unknown
  11871. Choose automatically.
  11872. @item jpeg/full/pc
  11873. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  11874. @item mpeg/limited/tv
  11875. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  11876. @end table
  11877. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  11878. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  11879. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  11880. @table @samp
  11881. @item disable
  11882. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  11883. @item decrease
  11884. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  11885. @item increase
  11886. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  11887. @end table
  11888. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  11889. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  11890. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  11891. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  11892. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  11893. 1280x533.
  11894. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  11895. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  11896. to work.
  11897. @item force_divisible_by
  11898. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  11899. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  11900. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  11901. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  11902. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  11903. may be slightly modified.
  11904. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  11905. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  11906. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  11907. @end table
  11908. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  11909. containing the following constants:
  11910. @table @var
  11911. @item in_w
  11912. @item in_h
  11913. The input width and height
  11914. @item iw
  11915. @item ih
  11916. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  11917. @item out_w
  11918. @item out_h
  11919. The output (scaled) width and height
  11920. @item ow
  11921. @item oh
  11922. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  11923. @item a
  11924. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  11925. @item sar
  11926. input sample aspect ratio
  11927. @item dar
  11928. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  11929. @item hsub
  11930. @item vsub
  11931. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11932. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11933. @item ohsub
  11934. @item ovsub
  11935. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11936. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11937. @end table
  11938. @subsection Examples
  11939. @itemize
  11940. @item
  11941. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  11942. @example
  11943. scale=w=200:h=100
  11944. @end example
  11945. This is equivalent to:
  11946. @example
  11947. scale=200:100
  11948. @end example
  11949. or:
  11950. @example
  11951. scale=200x100
  11952. @end example
  11953. @item
  11954. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  11955. @example
  11956. scale=qcif
  11957. @end example
  11958. which can also be written as:
  11959. @example
  11960. scale=size=qcif
  11961. @end example
  11962. @item
  11963. Scale the input to 2x:
  11964. @example
  11965. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  11966. @end example
  11967. @item
  11968. The above is the same as:
  11969. @example
  11970. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  11971. @end example
  11972. @item
  11973. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  11974. @example
  11975. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  11976. @end example
  11977. @item
  11978. Scale the input to half size:
  11979. @example
  11980. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  11981. @end example
  11982. @item
  11983. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  11984. @example
  11985. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  11986. @end example
  11987. @item
  11988. Seek Greek harmony:
  11989. @example
  11990. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  11991. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  11992. @end example
  11993. @item
  11994. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  11995. @example
  11996. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  11997. @end example
  11998. @item
  11999. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  12000. subsample values:
  12001. @example
  12002. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  12003. @end example
  12004. @item
  12005. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  12006. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  12007. @example
  12008. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  12009. @end example
  12010. @item
  12011. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar:
  12012. @example
  12013. scale='trunc(ih*dar):ih',setsar=1/1
  12014. @end example
  12015. @item
  12016. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar,
  12017. making sure the resulting resolution is even (required by some codecs):
  12018. @example
  12019. scale='trunc(ih*dar/2)*2:trunc(ih/2)*2',setsar=1/1
  12020. @end example
  12021. @end itemize
  12022. @subsection Commands
  12023. This filter supports the following commands:
  12024. @table @option
  12025. @item width, w
  12026. @item height, h
  12027. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12028. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12029. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12030. value.
  12031. @end table
  12032. @section scale_npp
  12033. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  12034. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  12035. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  12036. The following additional options are accepted:
  12037. @table @option
  12038. @item format
  12039. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  12040. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  12041. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  12042. @item interp_algo
  12043. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  12044. @table @option
  12045. @item nn
  12046. Nearest neighbour.
  12047. @item linear
  12048. @item cubic
  12049. @item cubic2p_bspline
  12050. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  12051. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  12052. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  12053. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  12054. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  12055. @item super
  12056. Supersampling
  12057. @item lanczos
  12058. @end table
  12059. @end table
  12060. @section scale2ref
  12061. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  12062. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  12063. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref also
  12064. supports the following additional constants for the @option{w} and
  12065. @option{h} options:
  12066. @table @var
  12067. @item main_w
  12068. @item main_h
  12069. The main input video's width and height
  12070. @item main_a
  12071. The same as @var{main_w} / @var{main_h}
  12072. @item main_sar
  12073. The main input video's sample aspect ratio
  12074. @item main_dar, mdar
  12075. The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from
  12076. @code{(main_w / main_h) * main_sar}.
  12077. @item main_hsub
  12078. @item main_vsub
  12079. The main input video's horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values.
  12080. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub}
  12081. is 1.
  12082. @end table
  12083. @subsection Examples
  12084. @itemize
  12085. @item
  12086. Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying
  12087. @example
  12088. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  12089. @end example
  12090. @item
  12091. Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.
  12092. @example
  12093. [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]
  12094. @end example
  12095. @end itemize
  12096. @section scroll
  12097. Scroll input video horizontally and/or vertically by constant speed.
  12098. The filter accepts the following options:
  12099. @table @option
  12100. @item horizontal, h
  12101. Set the horizontal scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12102. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12103. @item vertical, v
  12104. Set the vertical scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12105. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12106. @item hpos
  12107. Set the initial horizontal scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12108. @item vpos
  12109. Set the initial vertical scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12110. @end table
  12111. @subsection Commands
  12112. This filter supports the following @ref{commands}:
  12113. @table @option
  12114. @item horizontal, h
  12115. Set the horizontal scrolling speed.
  12116. @item vertical, v
  12117. Set the vertical scrolling speed.
  12118. @end table
  12119. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  12120. @section selectivecolor
  12121. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  12122. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  12123. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  12124. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  12125. The filter accepts the following options:
  12126. @table @option
  12127. @item correction_method
  12128. Select color correction method.
  12129. Available values are:
  12130. @table @samp
  12131. @item absolute
  12132. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  12133. component value).
  12134. @item relative
  12135. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  12136. @end table
  12137. Default is @code{absolute}.
  12138. @item reds
  12139. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  12140. @item yellows
  12141. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  12142. @item greens
  12143. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  12144. @item cyans
  12145. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  12146. @item blues
  12147. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  12148. @item magentas
  12149. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  12150. @item whites
  12151. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  12152. @item neutrals
  12153. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  12154. @item blacks
  12155. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  12156. @item psfile
  12157. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  12158. @end table
  12159. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  12160. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  12161. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  12162. pixels of its range.
  12163. @subsection Examples
  12164. @itemize
  12165. @item
  12166. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  12167. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  12168. @example
  12169. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  12170. @end example
  12171. @item
  12172. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  12173. @example
  12174. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  12175. @end example
  12176. @end itemize
  12177. @anchor{separatefields}
  12178. @section separatefields
  12179. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  12180. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  12181. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  12182. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  12183. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  12184. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  12185. @section setdar, setsar
  12186. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  12187. output video.
  12188. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  12189. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  12190. @example
  12191. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  12192. @end example
  12193. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  12194. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  12195. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  12196. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  12197. applied.
  12198. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  12199. the filter output video.
  12200. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  12201. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  12202. above.
  12203. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  12204. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  12205. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  12206. It accepts the following parameters:
  12207. @table @option
  12208. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  12209. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  12210. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  12211. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  12212. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  12213. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  12214. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  12215. should be escaped.
  12216. @item max
  12217. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  12218. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  12219. Default value is @code{100}.
  12220. @end table
  12221. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  12222. the following constants:
  12223. @table @option
  12224. @item E, PI, PHI
  12225. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  12226. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  12227. @item w, h
  12228. The input width and height.
  12229. @item a
  12230. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  12231. @item sar
  12232. The input sample aspect ratio.
  12233. @item dar
  12234. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  12235. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  12236. @item hsub, vsub
  12237. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  12238. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12239. @end table
  12240. @subsection Examples
  12241. @itemize
  12242. @item
  12243. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  12244. @example
  12245. setdar=dar=1.77777
  12246. setdar=dar=16/9
  12247. @end example
  12248. @item
  12249. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  12250. @example
  12251. setsar=sar=10/11
  12252. @end example
  12253. @item
  12254. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  12255. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  12256. @example
  12257. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  12258. @end example
  12259. @end itemize
  12260. @anchor{setfield}
  12261. @section setfield
  12262. Force field for the output video frame.
  12263. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  12264. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12265. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12266. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  12267. The filter accepts the following options:
  12268. @table @option
  12269. @item mode
  12270. Available values are:
  12271. @table @samp
  12272. @item auto
  12273. Keep the same field property.
  12274. @item bff
  12275. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12276. @item tff
  12277. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12278. @item prog
  12279. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12280. @end table
  12281. @end table
  12282. @anchor{setparams}
  12283. @section setparams
  12284. Force frame parameter for the output video frame.
  12285. The @code{setparams} filter marks interlace and color range for the
  12286. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12287. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12288. filters/encoders.
  12289. @table @option
  12290. @item field_mode
  12291. Available values are:
  12292. @table @samp
  12293. @item auto
  12294. Keep the same field property (default).
  12295. @item bff
  12296. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12297. @item tff
  12298. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12299. @item prog
  12300. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12301. @end table
  12302. @item range
  12303. Available values are:
  12304. @table @samp
  12305. @item auto
  12306. Keep the same color range property (default).
  12307. @item unspecified, unknown
  12308. Mark the frame as unspecified color range.
  12309. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  12310. Mark the frame as limited range.
  12311. @item full, pc, jpeg
  12312. Mark the frame as full range.
  12313. @end table
  12314. @item color_primaries
  12315. Set the color primaries.
  12316. Available values are:
  12317. @table @samp
  12318. @item auto
  12319. Keep the same color primaries property (default).
  12320. @item bt709
  12321. @item unknown
  12322. @item bt470m
  12323. @item bt470bg
  12324. @item smpte170m
  12325. @item smpte240m
  12326. @item film
  12327. @item bt2020
  12328. @item smpte428
  12329. @item smpte431
  12330. @item smpte432
  12331. @item jedec-p22
  12332. @end table
  12333. @item color_trc
  12334. Set the color transfer.
  12335. Available values are:
  12336. @table @samp
  12337. @item auto
  12338. Keep the same color trc property (default).
  12339. @item bt709
  12340. @item unknown
  12341. @item bt470m
  12342. @item bt470bg
  12343. @item smpte170m
  12344. @item smpte240m
  12345. @item linear
  12346. @item log100
  12347. @item log316
  12348. @item iec61966-2-4
  12349. @item bt1361e
  12350. @item iec61966-2-1
  12351. @item bt2020-10
  12352. @item bt2020-12
  12353. @item smpte2084
  12354. @item smpte428
  12355. @item arib-std-b67
  12356. @end table
  12357. @item colorspace
  12358. Set the colorspace.
  12359. Available values are:
  12360. @table @samp
  12361. @item auto
  12362. Keep the same colorspace property (default).
  12363. @item gbr
  12364. @item bt709
  12365. @item unknown
  12366. @item fcc
  12367. @item bt470bg
  12368. @item smpte170m
  12369. @item smpte240m
  12370. @item ycgco
  12371. @item bt2020nc
  12372. @item bt2020c
  12373. @item smpte2085
  12374. @item chroma-derived-nc
  12375. @item chroma-derived-c
  12376. @item ictcp
  12377. @end table
  12378. @end table
  12379. @section showinfo
  12380. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  12381. The input video is not modified.
  12382. This filter supports the following options:
  12383. @table @option
  12384. @item checksum
  12385. Calculate checksums of each plane. By default enabled.
  12386. @end table
  12387. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  12388. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  12389. The following values are shown in the output:
  12390. @table @option
  12391. @item n
  12392. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12393. @item pts
  12394. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12395. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  12396. @item pts_time
  12397. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12398. seconds.
  12399. @item pos
  12400. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  12401. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12402. @item fmt
  12403. The pixel format name.
  12404. @item sar
  12405. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12406. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  12407. @item s
  12408. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12409. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12410. @item i
  12411. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  12412. for bottom field first).
  12413. @item iskey
  12414. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  12415. @item type
  12416. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  12417. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  12418. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  12419. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  12420. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  12421. @item checksum
  12422. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  12423. @item plane_checksum
  12424. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  12425. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  12426. @end table
  12427. @section showpalette
  12428. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  12429. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  12430. It accepts the following option:
  12431. @table @option
  12432. @item s
  12433. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  12434. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  12435. @end table
  12436. @section shuffleframes
  12437. Reorder and/or duplicate and/or drop video frames.
  12438. It accepts the following parameters:
  12439. @table @option
  12440. @item mapping
  12441. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  12442. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  12443. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  12444. '-1' index have special meaning and that is to drop frame.
  12445. @end table
  12446. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12447. @subsection Examples
  12448. @itemize
  12449. @item
  12450. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  12451. @example
  12452. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  12453. @end example
  12454. @item
  12455. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  12456. @example
  12457. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  12458. @end example
  12459. @end itemize
  12460. @section shuffleplanes
  12461. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  12462. It accepts the following parameters:
  12463. @table @option
  12464. @item map0
  12465. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  12466. @item map1
  12467. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  12468. @item map2
  12469. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  12470. @item map3
  12471. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  12472. @end table
  12473. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12474. @subsection Examples
  12475. @itemize
  12476. @item
  12477. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  12478. @example
  12479. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  12480. @end example
  12481. @end itemize
  12482. @anchor{signalstats}
  12483. @section signalstats
  12484. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  12485. with the digitization of analog video media.
  12486. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  12487. @table @option
  12488. @item YMIN
  12489. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12490. range of [0-255].
  12491. @item YLOW
  12492. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12493. range of [0-255].
  12494. @item YAVG
  12495. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12496. [0-255].
  12497. @item YHIGH
  12498. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12499. range of [0-255].
  12500. @item YMAX
  12501. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12502. range of [0-255].
  12503. @item UMIN
  12504. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12505. range of [0-255].
  12506. @item ULOW
  12507. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12508. range of [0-255].
  12509. @item UAVG
  12510. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12511. [0-255].
  12512. @item UHIGH
  12513. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12514. range of [0-255].
  12515. @item UMAX
  12516. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12517. range of [0-255].
  12518. @item VMIN
  12519. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12520. range of [0-255].
  12521. @item VLOW
  12522. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12523. range of [0-255].
  12524. @item VAVG
  12525. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12526. [0-255].
  12527. @item VHIGH
  12528. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12529. range of [0-255].
  12530. @item VMAX
  12531. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12532. range of [0-255].
  12533. @item SATMIN
  12534. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12535. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12536. @item SATLOW
  12537. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  12538. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12539. @item SATAVG
  12540. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  12541. of [0-~181.02].
  12542. @item SATHIGH
  12543. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  12544. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12545. @item SATMAX
  12546. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12547. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12548. @item HUEMED
  12549. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12550. [0-360].
  12551. @item HUEAVG
  12552. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12553. [0-360].
  12554. @item YDIF
  12555. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  12556. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12557. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12558. @item UDIF
  12559. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  12560. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12561. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12562. @item VDIF
  12563. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  12564. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12565. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12566. @item YBITDEPTH
  12567. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  12568. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12569. @item UBITDEPTH
  12570. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  12571. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12572. @item VBITDEPTH
  12573. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  12574. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12575. @end table
  12576. The filter accepts the following options:
  12577. @table @option
  12578. @item stat
  12579. @item out
  12580. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  12581. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  12582. Both options accept the following values:
  12583. @table @samp
  12584. @item tout
  12585. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  12586. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  12587. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  12588. @item vrep
  12589. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  12590. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  12591. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  12592. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  12593. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  12594. @item brng
  12595. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  12596. @end table
  12597. @item color, c
  12598. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  12599. yellow.
  12600. @end table
  12601. @subsection Examples
  12602. @itemize
  12603. @item
  12604. Output data of various video metrics:
  12605. @example
  12606. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  12607. @end example
  12608. @item
  12609. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  12610. @example
  12611. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  12612. @end example
  12613. @item
  12614. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  12615. @example
  12616. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  12617. @end example
  12618. @item
  12619. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  12620. @example
  12621. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  12622. @end example
  12623. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  12624. @example
  12625. time %@{pts:hms@}
  12626. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  12627. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  12628. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  12629. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  12630. @end example
  12631. @end itemize
  12632. @anchor{signature}
  12633. @section signature
  12634. Calculates the MPEG-7 Video Signature. The filter can handle more than one
  12635. input. In this case the matching between the inputs can be calculated additionally.
  12636. The filter always passes through the first input. The signature of each stream can
  12637. be written into a file.
  12638. It accepts the following options:
  12639. @table @option
  12640. @item detectmode
  12641. Enable or disable the matching process.
  12642. Available values are:
  12643. @table @samp
  12644. @item off
  12645. Disable the calculation of a matching (default).
  12646. @item full
  12647. Calculate the matching for the whole video and output whether the whole video
  12648. matches or only parts.
  12649. @item fast
  12650. Calculate only until a matching is found or the video ends. Should be faster in
  12651. some cases.
  12652. @end table
  12653. @item nb_inputs
  12654. Set the number of inputs. The option value must be a non negative integer.
  12655. Default value is 1.
  12656. @item filename
  12657. Set the path to which the output is written. If there is more than one input,
  12658. the path must be a prototype, i.e. must contain %d or %0nd (where n is a positive
  12659. integer), that will be replaced with the input number. If no filename is
  12660. specified, no output will be written. This is the default.
  12661. @item format
  12662. Choose the output format.
  12663. Available values are:
  12664. @table @samp
  12665. @item binary
  12666. Use the specified binary representation (default).
  12667. @item xml
  12668. Use the specified xml representation.
  12669. @end table
  12670. @item th_d
  12671. Set threshold to detect one word as similar. The option value must be an integer
  12672. greater than zero. The default value is 9000.
  12673. @item th_dc
  12674. Set threshold to detect all words as similar. The option value must be an integer
  12675. greater than zero. The default value is 60000.
  12676. @item th_xh
  12677. Set threshold to detect frames as similar. The option value must be an integer
  12678. greater than zero. The default value is 116.
  12679. @item th_di
  12680. Set the minimum length of a sequence in frames to recognize it as matching
  12681. sequence. The option value must be a non negative integer value.
  12682. The default value is 0.
  12683. @item th_it
  12684. Set the minimum relation, that matching frames to all frames must have.
  12685. The option value must be a double value between 0 and 1. The default value is 0.5.
  12686. @end table
  12687. @subsection Examples
  12688. @itemize
  12689. @item
  12690. To calculate the signature of an input video and store it in signature.bin:
  12691. @example
  12692. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf signature=filename=signature.bin -map 0:v -f null -
  12693. @end example
  12694. @item
  12695. To detect whether two videos match and store the signatures in XML format in
  12696. signature0.xml and signature1.xml:
  12697. @example
  12698. ffmpeg -i input1.mkv -i input2.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] signature=nb_inputs=2:detectmode=full:format=xml:filename=signature%d.xml" -map :v -f null -
  12699. @end example
  12700. @end itemize
  12701. @anchor{smartblur}
  12702. @section smartblur
  12703. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  12704. It accepts the following options:
  12705. @table @option
  12706. @item luma_radius, lr
  12707. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  12708. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  12709. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  12710. @item luma_strength, ls
  12711. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  12712. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  12713. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  12714. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  12715. @item luma_threshold, lt
  12716. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  12717. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  12718. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  12719. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  12720. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  12721. @item chroma_radius, cr
  12722. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  12723. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  12724. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is @option{luma_radius}.
  12725. @item chroma_strength, cs
  12726. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  12727. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  12728. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  12729. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is @option{luma_strength}.
  12730. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  12731. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  12732. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  12733. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  12734. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  12735. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is @option{luma_threshold}.
  12736. @end table
  12737. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  12738. is set.
  12739. @section sobel
  12740. Apply sobel operator to input video stream.
  12741. The filter accepts the following option:
  12742. @table @option
  12743. @item planes
  12744. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  12745. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  12746. @item scale
  12747. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  12748. @item delta
  12749. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  12750. @end table
  12751. @anchor{spp}
  12752. @section spp
  12753. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  12754. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  12755. and average the results.
  12756. The filter accepts the following options:
  12757. @table @option
  12758. @item quality
  12759. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  12760. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  12761. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  12762. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  12763. @code{3}.
  12764. @item qp
  12765. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  12766. from the video stream (if available).
  12767. @item mode
  12768. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  12769. @table @samp
  12770. @item hard
  12771. Set hard thresholding (default).
  12772. @item soft
  12773. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  12774. @end table
  12775. @item use_bframe_qp
  12776. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  12777. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  12778. @code{0} (not enabled).
  12779. @end table
  12780. @section sr
  12781. Scale the input by applying one of the super-resolution methods based on
  12782. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  12783. @itemize
  12784. @item
  12785. Super-Resolution Convolutional Neural Network model (SRCNN).
  12786. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1501.00092}.
  12787. @item
  12788. Efficient Sub-Pixel Convolutional Neural Network model (ESPCN).
  12789. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1609.05158}.
  12790. @end itemize
  12791. Training scripts as well as scripts for model file (.pb) saving can be found at
  12792. @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/sr/tree/sr_dnn_native}. Original repository
  12793. is at @url{https://github.com/HighVoltageRocknRoll/sr.git}.
  12794. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  12795. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  12796. The filter accepts the following options:
  12797. @table @option
  12798. @item dnn_backend
  12799. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  12800. the following values:
  12801. @table @samp
  12802. @item native
  12803. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  12804. @item tensorflow
  12805. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  12806. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  12807. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  12808. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  12809. @end table
  12810. Default value is @samp{native}.
  12811. @item model
  12812. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  12813. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow backend
  12814. can load files for both formats, while native backend can load files for only
  12815. its format.
  12816. @item scale_factor
  12817. Set scale factor for SRCNN model. Allowed values are @code{2}, @code{3} and @code{4}.
  12818. Default value is @code{2}. Scale factor is necessary for SRCNN model, because it accepts
  12819. input upscaled using bicubic upscaling with proper scale factor.
  12820. @end table
  12821. @section ssim
  12822. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  12823. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  12824. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  12825. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  12826. the SSIM.
  12827. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  12828. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  12829. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  12830. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  12831. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  12832. @table @option
  12833. @item stats_file, f
  12834. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  12835. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  12836. standard output.
  12837. @end table
  12838. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  12839. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  12840. couple of frames.
  12841. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  12842. @table @option
  12843. @item n
  12844. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  12845. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  12846. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  12847. @item All
  12848. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  12849. @item dB
  12850. Same as above but in dB representation.
  12851. @end table
  12852. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  12853. For example:
  12854. @example
  12855. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  12856. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  12857. @end example
  12858. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  12859. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  12860. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  12861. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  12862. @example
  12863. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  12864. @end example
  12865. @section stereo3d
  12866. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  12867. The filters accept the following options:
  12868. @table @option
  12869. @item in
  12870. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  12871. Available values for input image formats are:
  12872. @table @samp
  12873. @item sbsl
  12874. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  12875. @item sbsr
  12876. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  12877. @item sbs2l
  12878. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  12879. (left eye left, right eye right)
  12880. @item sbs2r
  12881. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  12882. (right eye left, left eye right)
  12883. @item abl
  12884. @item tbl
  12885. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  12886. @item abr
  12887. @item tbr
  12888. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  12889. @item ab2l
  12890. @item tb2l
  12891. above-below with half height resolution
  12892. (left eye above, right eye below)
  12893. @item ab2r
  12894. @item tb2r
  12895. above-below with half height resolution
  12896. (right eye above, left eye below)
  12897. @item al
  12898. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  12899. @item ar
  12900. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  12901. @item irl
  12902. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  12903. @item irr
  12904. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  12905. @item icl
  12906. interleaved columns, left eye first
  12907. @item icr
  12908. interleaved columns, right eye first
  12909. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  12910. @end table
  12911. @item out
  12912. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  12913. @table @samp
  12914. @item sbsl
  12915. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  12916. @item sbsr
  12917. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  12918. @item sbs2l
  12919. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  12920. (left eye left, right eye right)
  12921. @item sbs2r
  12922. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  12923. (right eye left, left eye right)
  12924. @item abl
  12925. @item tbl
  12926. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  12927. @item abr
  12928. @item tbr
  12929. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  12930. @item ab2l
  12931. @item tb2l
  12932. above-below with half height resolution
  12933. (left eye above, right eye below)
  12934. @item ab2r
  12935. @item tb2r
  12936. above-below with half height resolution
  12937. (right eye above, left eye below)
  12938. @item al
  12939. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  12940. @item ar
  12941. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  12942. @item irl
  12943. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  12944. @item irr
  12945. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  12946. @item arbg
  12947. anaglyph red/blue gray
  12948. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  12949. @item argg
  12950. anaglyph red/green gray
  12951. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  12952. @item arcg
  12953. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  12954. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  12955. @item arch
  12956. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  12957. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  12958. @item arcc
  12959. anaglyph red/cyan color
  12960. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  12961. @item arcd
  12962. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  12963. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  12964. @item agmg
  12965. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  12966. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  12967. @item agmh
  12968. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  12969. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  12970. @item agmc
  12971. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  12972. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  12973. @item agmd
  12974. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  12975. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  12976. @item aybg
  12977. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  12978. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  12979. @item aybh
  12980. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  12981. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  12982. @item aybc
  12983. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  12984. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  12985. @item aybd
  12986. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  12987. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  12988. @item ml
  12989. mono output (left eye only)
  12990. @item mr
  12991. mono output (right eye only)
  12992. @item chl
  12993. checkerboard, left eye first
  12994. @item chr
  12995. checkerboard, right eye first
  12996. @item icl
  12997. interleaved columns, left eye first
  12998. @item icr
  12999. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13000. @item hdmi
  13001. HDMI frame pack
  13002. @end table
  13003. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  13004. @end table
  13005. @subsection Examples
  13006. @itemize
  13007. @item
  13008. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  13009. @example
  13010. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  13011. @end example
  13012. @item
  13013. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  13014. @example
  13015. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  13016. @end example
  13017. @end itemize
  13018. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  13019. Select video or audio streams.
  13020. The filter accepts the following options:
  13021. @table @option
  13022. @item inputs
  13023. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  13024. @item map
  13025. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13026. @end table
  13027. @subsection Commands
  13028. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  13029. commands:
  13030. @table @option
  13031. @item map
  13032. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13033. @end table
  13034. @subsection Examples
  13035. @itemize
  13036. @item
  13037. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  13038. @example
  13039. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13040. @end example
  13041. @item
  13042. Same as above, but for audio:
  13043. @example
  13044. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13045. @end example
  13046. @end itemize
  13047. @anchor{subtitles}
  13048. @section subtitles
  13049. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  13050. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  13051. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  13052. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  13053. Alpha) subtitles format.
  13054. The filter accepts the following options:
  13055. @table @option
  13056. @item filename, f
  13057. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  13058. @item original_size
  13059. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  13060. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13061. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13062. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  13063. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  13064. @item fontsdir
  13065. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  13066. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  13067. @item alpha
  13068. Process alpha channel, by default alpha channel is untouched.
  13069. @item charenc
  13070. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  13071. useful if not UTF-8.
  13072. @item stream_index, si
  13073. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  13074. @item force_style
  13075. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  13076. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  13077. @end table
  13078. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  13079. specifies the @option{filename}.
  13080. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  13081. video, use the command:
  13082. @example
  13083. subtitles=sub.srt
  13084. @end example
  13085. which is equivalent to:
  13086. @example
  13087. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  13088. @end example
  13089. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  13090. @example
  13091. subtitles=video.mkv
  13092. @end example
  13093. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  13094. @example
  13095. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  13096. @end example
  13097. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in 80% transparent blue
  13098. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  13099. @example
  13100. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HCCFF0000'
  13101. @end example
  13102. @section super2xsai
  13103. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  13104. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  13105. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  13106. @section swaprect
  13107. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  13108. This filter accepts the following options:
  13109. @table @option
  13110. @item w
  13111. Set object width.
  13112. @item h
  13113. Set object height.
  13114. @item x1
  13115. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  13116. @item y1
  13117. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  13118. @item x2
  13119. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  13120. @item y2
  13121. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  13122. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  13123. @end table
  13124. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  13125. @table @option
  13126. @item w
  13127. @item h
  13128. The input width and height.
  13129. @item a
  13130. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  13131. @item sar
  13132. input sample aspect ratio
  13133. @item dar
  13134. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  13135. @item n
  13136. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  13137. @item t
  13138. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  13139. @item pos
  13140. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  13141. @end table
  13142. @section swapuv
  13143. Swap U & V plane.
  13144. @section telecine
  13145. Apply telecine process to the video.
  13146. This filter accepts the following options:
  13147. @table @option
  13148. @item first_field
  13149. @table @samp
  13150. @item top, t
  13151. top field first
  13152. @item bottom, b
  13153. bottom field first
  13154. The default value is @code{top}.
  13155. @end table
  13156. @item pattern
  13157. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  13158. The default value is @code{23}.
  13159. @end table
  13160. @example
  13161. Some typical patterns:
  13162. NTSC output (30i):
  13163. 27.5p: 32222
  13164. 24p: 23 (classic)
  13165. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  13166. 20p: 33
  13167. 18p: 334
  13168. 16p: 3444
  13169. PAL output (25i):
  13170. 27.5p: 12222
  13171. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  13172. 16.67p: 33
  13173. 16p: 33333334
  13174. @end example
  13175. @section threshold
  13176. Apply threshold effect to video stream.
  13177. This filter needs four video streams to perform thresholding.
  13178. First stream is stream we are filtering.
  13179. Second stream is holding threshold values, third stream is holding min values,
  13180. and last, fourth stream is holding max values.
  13181. The filter accepts the following option:
  13182. @table @option
  13183. @item planes
  13184. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13185. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13186. @end table
  13187. For example if first stream pixel's component value is less then threshold value
  13188. of pixel component from 2nd threshold stream, third stream value will picked,
  13189. otherwise fourth stream pixel component value will be picked.
  13190. Using color source filter one can perform various types of thresholding:
  13191. @subsection Examples
  13192. @itemize
  13193. @item
  13194. Binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13195. @example
  13196. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=black -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13197. @end example
  13198. @item
  13199. Inverted binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13200. @example
  13201. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -f lavfi -i color=black -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13202. @end example
  13203. @item
  13204. Truncate binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13205. @example
  13206. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13207. @end example
  13208. @item
  13209. Threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13210. @example
  13211. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -i 320x240.avi -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13212. @end example
  13213. @item
  13214. Inverted threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13215. @example
  13216. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13217. @end example
  13218. @end itemize
  13219. @section thumbnail
  13220. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  13221. The filter accepts the following options:
  13222. @table @option
  13223. @item n
  13224. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  13225. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  13226. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  13227. @end table
  13228. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  13229. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  13230. @subsection Examples
  13231. @itemize
  13232. @item
  13233. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  13234. @example
  13235. thumbnail=50
  13236. @end example
  13237. @item
  13238. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13239. @example
  13240. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  13241. @end example
  13242. @end itemize
  13243. @section tile
  13244. Tile several successive frames together.
  13245. The filter accepts the following options:
  13246. @table @option
  13247. @item layout
  13248. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  13249. this option, check the
  13250. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13251. @item nb_frames
  13252. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  13253. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  13254. the area will be used.
  13255. @item margin
  13256. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  13257. @item padding
  13258. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  13259. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  13260. refer to the pad video filter.
  13261. @item color
  13262. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13263. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13264. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13265. @item overlap
  13266. Set the number of frames to overlap when tiling several successive frames together.
  13267. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13268. @item init_padding
  13269. Set the number of frames to initially be empty before displaying first output frame.
  13270. This controls how soon will one get first output frame.
  13271. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13272. @end table
  13273. @subsection Examples
  13274. @itemize
  13275. @item
  13276. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  13277. @example
  13278. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  13279. @end example
  13280. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  13281. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  13282. rate.
  13283. @item
  13284. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  13285. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  13286. mixed flat and named options:
  13287. @example
  13288. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  13289. @end example
  13290. @end itemize
  13291. @section tinterlace
  13292. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  13293. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  13294. considered odd.
  13295. The filter accepts the following options:
  13296. @table @option
  13297. @item mode
  13298. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  13299. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  13300. Available values are:
  13301. @table @samp
  13302. @item merge, 0
  13303. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13304. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  13305. @example
  13306. ------> time
  13307. Input:
  13308. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13309. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13310. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13311. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13312. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13313. Output:
  13314. 11111 33333
  13315. 22222 44444
  13316. 11111 33333
  13317. 22222 44444
  13318. 11111 33333
  13319. 22222 44444
  13320. 11111 33333
  13321. 22222 44444
  13322. @end example
  13323. @item drop_even, 1
  13324. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13325. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13326. @example
  13327. ------> time
  13328. Input:
  13329. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13330. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13331. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13332. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13333. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13334. Output:
  13335. 11111 33333
  13336. 11111 33333
  13337. 11111 33333
  13338. 11111 33333
  13339. @end example
  13340. @item drop_odd, 2
  13341. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13342. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13343. @example
  13344. ------> time
  13345. Input:
  13346. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13347. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13348. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13349. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13350. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13351. Output:
  13352. 22222 44444
  13353. 22222 44444
  13354. 22222 44444
  13355. 22222 44444
  13356. @end example
  13357. @item pad, 3
  13358. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  13359. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  13360. @example
  13361. ------> time
  13362. Input:
  13363. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13364. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13365. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13366. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13367. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13368. Output:
  13369. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13370. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13371. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13372. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13373. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13374. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13375. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13376. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13377. @end example
  13378. @item interleave_top, 4
  13379. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  13380. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13381. @example
  13382. ------> time
  13383. Input:
  13384. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13385. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13386. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13387. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13388. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13389. Output:
  13390. 11111 33333
  13391. 22222 44444
  13392. 11111 33333
  13393. 22222 44444
  13394. @end example
  13395. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  13396. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  13397. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13398. @example
  13399. ------> time
  13400. Input:
  13401. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13402. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13403. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13404. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13405. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13406. Output:
  13407. 22222 44444
  13408. 11111 33333
  13409. 22222 44444
  13410. 11111 33333
  13411. @end example
  13412. @item interlacex2, 6
  13413. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  13414. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  13415. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  13416. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  13417. field synchronisation.
  13418. @example
  13419. ------> time
  13420. Input:
  13421. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13422. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13423. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13424. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13425. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13426. Output:
  13427. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13428. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13429. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13430. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13431. @end example
  13432. @item mergex2, 7
  13433. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13434. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  13435. @example
  13436. ------> time
  13437. Input:
  13438. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13439. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13440. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13441. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13442. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13443. Output:
  13444. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13445. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13446. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13447. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13448. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13449. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13450. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13451. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13452. @end example
  13453. @end table
  13454. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  13455. compatibility reasons.
  13456. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  13457. @item flags
  13458. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  13459. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  13460. @table @option
  13461. @item low_pass_filter, vlpf
  13462. Enable linear vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  13463. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  13464. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  13465. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13466. patterning.
  13467. @item complex_filter, cvlpf
  13468. Enable complex vertical low-pass filtering.
  13469. This will slightly less reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13470. patterning but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  13471. @end table
  13472. Vertical low-pass filtering can only be enabled for @option{mode}
  13473. @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  13474. @end table
  13475. @section tmix
  13476. Mix successive video frames.
  13477. A description of the accepted options follows.
  13478. @table @option
  13479. @item frames
  13480. The number of successive frames to mix. If unspecified, it defaults to 3.
  13481. @item weights
  13482. Specify weight of each input video frame.
  13483. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights is smaller than
  13484. number of @var{frames} last specified weight will be used for all remaining
  13485. unset weights.
  13486. @item scale
  13487. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  13488. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  13489. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  13490. @end table
  13491. @subsection Examples
  13492. @itemize
  13493. @item
  13494. Average 7 successive frames:
  13495. @example
  13496. tmix=frames=7:weights="1 1 1 1 1 1 1"
  13497. @end example
  13498. @item
  13499. Apply simple temporal convolution:
  13500. @example
  13501. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 3 -1"
  13502. @end example
  13503. @item
  13504. Similar as above but only showing temporal differences:
  13505. @example
  13506. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 2 -1":scale=1
  13507. @end example
  13508. @end itemize
  13509. @anchor{tonemap}
  13510. @section tonemap
  13511. Tone map colors from different dynamic ranges.
  13512. This filter expects data in single precision floating point, as it needs to
  13513. operate on (and can output) out-of-range values. Another filter, such as
  13514. @ref{zscale}, is needed to convert the resulting frame to a usable format.
  13515. The tonemapping algorithms implemented only work on linear light, so input
  13516. data should be linearized beforehand (and possibly correctly tagged).
  13517. @example
  13518. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,tonemap=clip,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT
  13519. @end example
  13520. @subsection Options
  13521. The filter accepts the following options.
  13522. @table @option
  13523. @item tonemap
  13524. Set the tone map algorithm to use.
  13525. Possible values are:
  13526. @table @var
  13527. @item none
  13528. Do not apply any tone map, only desaturate overbright pixels.
  13529. @item clip
  13530. Hard-clip any out-of-range values. Use it for perfect color accuracy for
  13531. in-range values, while distorting out-of-range values.
  13532. @item linear
  13533. Stretch the entire reference gamut to a linear multiple of the display.
  13534. @item gamma
  13535. Fit a logarithmic transfer between the tone curves.
  13536. @item reinhard
  13537. Preserve overall image brightness with a simple curve, using nonlinear
  13538. contrast, which results in flattening details and degrading color accuracy.
  13539. @item hable
  13540. Preserve both dark and bright details better than @var{reinhard}, at the cost
  13541. of slightly darkening everything. Use it when detail preservation is more
  13542. important than color and brightness accuracy.
  13543. @item mobius
  13544. Smoothly map out-of-range values, while retaining contrast and colors for
  13545. in-range material as much as possible. Use it when color accuracy is more
  13546. important than detail preservation.
  13547. @end table
  13548. Default is none.
  13549. @item param
  13550. Tune the tone mapping algorithm.
  13551. This affects the following algorithms:
  13552. @table @var
  13553. @item none
  13554. Ignored.
  13555. @item linear
  13556. Specifies the scale factor to use while stretching.
  13557. Default to 1.0.
  13558. @item gamma
  13559. Specifies the exponent of the function.
  13560. Default to 1.8.
  13561. @item clip
  13562. Specify an extra linear coefficient to multiply into the signal before clipping.
  13563. Default to 1.0.
  13564. @item reinhard
  13565. Specify the local contrast coefficient at the display peak.
  13566. Default to 0.5, which means that in-gamut values will be about half as bright
  13567. as when clipping.
  13568. @item hable
  13569. Ignored.
  13570. @item mobius
  13571. Specify the transition point from linear to mobius transform. Every value
  13572. below this point is guaranteed to be mapped 1:1. The higher the value, the
  13573. more accurate the result will be, at the cost of losing bright details.
  13574. Default to 0.3, which due to the steep initial slope still preserves in-range
  13575. colors fairly accurately.
  13576. @end table
  13577. @item desat
  13578. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  13579. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  13580. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  13581. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  13582. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  13583. The default of 2.0 is somewhat conservative and will mostly just apply to
  13584. skies or directly sunlit surfaces. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  13585. This option works only if the input frame has a supported color tag.
  13586. @item peak
  13587. Override signal/nominal/reference peak with this value. Useful when the
  13588. embedded peak information in display metadata is not reliable or when tone
  13589. mapping from a lower range to a higher range.
  13590. @end table
  13591. @section tpad
  13592. Temporarily pad video frames.
  13593. The filter accepts the following options:
  13594. @table @option
  13595. @item start
  13596. Specify number of delay frames before input video stream.
  13597. @item stop
  13598. Specify number of padding frames after input video stream.
  13599. Set to -1 to pad indefinitely.
  13600. @item start_mode
  13601. Set kind of frames added to beginning of stream.
  13602. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  13603. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  13604. With @var{clone} frames are clones of first frame.
  13605. @item stop_mode
  13606. Set kind of frames added to end of stream.
  13607. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  13608. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  13609. With @var{clone} frames are clones of last frame.
  13610. @item start_duration, stop_duration
  13611. Specify the duration of the start/stop delay. See
  13612. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  13613. for the accepted syntax.
  13614. These options override @var{start} and @var{stop}.
  13615. @item color
  13616. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  13617. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  13618. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13619. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13620. @end table
  13621. @anchor{transpose}
  13622. @section transpose
  13623. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  13624. It accepts the following parameters:
  13625. @table @option
  13626. @item dir
  13627. Specify the transposition direction.
  13628. Can assume the following values:
  13629. @table @samp
  13630. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  13631. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  13632. @example
  13633. L.R L.l
  13634. . . -> . .
  13635. l.r R.r
  13636. @end example
  13637. @item 1, 5, clock
  13638. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  13639. @example
  13640. L.R l.L
  13641. . . -> . .
  13642. l.r r.R
  13643. @end example
  13644. @item 2, 6, cclock
  13645. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  13646. @example
  13647. L.R R.r
  13648. . . -> . .
  13649. l.r L.l
  13650. @end example
  13651. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  13652. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  13653. @example
  13654. L.R r.R
  13655. . . -> . .
  13656. l.r l.L
  13657. @end example
  13658. @end table
  13659. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  13660. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  13661. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  13662. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  13663. symbolic constants.
  13664. @item passthrough
  13665. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  13666. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  13667. @table @samp
  13668. @item none
  13669. Always apply transposition.
  13670. @item portrait
  13671. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  13672. @item landscape
  13673. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  13674. @end table
  13675. Default value is @code{none}.
  13676. @end table
  13677. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  13678. layout:
  13679. @example
  13680. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  13681. @end example
  13682. The command above can also be specified as:
  13683. @example
  13684. transpose=1:portrait
  13685. @end example
  13686. @section transpose_npp
  13687. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  13688. For more in depth examples see the @ref{transpose} video filter, which shares mostly the same options.
  13689. It accepts the following parameters:
  13690. @table @option
  13691. @item dir
  13692. Specify the transposition direction.
  13693. Can assume the following values:
  13694. @table @samp
  13695. @item cclock_flip
  13696. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)
  13697. @item clock
  13698. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.
  13699. @item cclock
  13700. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.
  13701. @item clock_flip
  13702. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.
  13703. @end table
  13704. @item passthrough
  13705. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  13706. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  13707. @table @samp
  13708. @item none
  13709. Always apply transposition. (default)
  13710. @item portrait
  13711. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  13712. @item landscape
  13713. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  13714. @end table
  13715. @end table
  13716. @section trim
  13717. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  13718. It accepts the following parameters:
  13719. @table @option
  13720. @item start
  13721. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  13722. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  13723. @item end
  13724. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  13725. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  13726. frame in the output.
  13727. @item start_pts
  13728. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  13729. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  13730. @item end_pts
  13731. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  13732. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  13733. @item duration
  13734. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  13735. @item start_frame
  13736. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  13737. @item end_frame
  13738. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  13739. @end table
  13740. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  13741. duration specifications; see
  13742. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  13743. for the accepted syntax.
  13744. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  13745. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  13746. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  13747. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  13748. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  13749. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  13750. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  13751. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  13752. filters.
  13753. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  13754. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  13755. Examples:
  13756. @itemize
  13757. @item
  13758. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  13759. @example
  13760. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  13761. @end example
  13762. @item
  13763. Keep only the first second:
  13764. @example
  13765. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  13766. @end example
  13767. @end itemize
  13768. @section unpremultiply
  13769. Apply alpha unpremultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  13770. of second stream as alpha.
  13771. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  13772. The filter accepts the following option:
  13773. @table @option
  13774. @item planes
  13775. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13776. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13777. If the format has 1 or 2 components, then luma is bit 0.
  13778. If the format has 3 or 4 components:
  13779. for RGB formats bit 0 is green, bit 1 is blue and bit 2 is red;
  13780. for YUV formats bit 0 is luma, bit 1 is chroma-U and bit 2 is chroma-V.
  13781. If present, the alpha channel is always the last bit.
  13782. @item inplace
  13783. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  13784. @end table
  13785. @anchor{unsharp}
  13786. @section unsharp
  13787. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  13788. It accepts the following parameters:
  13789. @table @option
  13790. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  13791. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  13792. 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  13793. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  13794. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  13795. and 23. The default value is 5.
  13796. @item luma_amount, la
  13797. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  13798. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  13799. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  13800. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  13801. Default value is 1.0.
  13802. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  13803. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  13804. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  13805. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  13806. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  13807. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  13808. @item chroma_amount, ca
  13809. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  13810. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  13811. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  13812. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  13813. Default value is 0.0.
  13814. @end table
  13815. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  13816. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  13817. @subsection Examples
  13818. @itemize
  13819. @item
  13820. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  13821. @example
  13822. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  13823. @end example
  13824. @item
  13825. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  13826. @example
  13827. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  13828. @end example
  13829. @end itemize
  13830. @section uspp
  13831. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  13832. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  13833. shifts and average the results.
  13834. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  13835. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  13836. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  13837. The filter accepts the following options:
  13838. @table @option
  13839. @item quality
  13840. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  13841. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  13842. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  13843. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  13844. @code{3}.
  13845. @item qp
  13846. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  13847. from the video stream (if available).
  13848. @end table
  13849. @section v360
  13850. Convert 360 videos between various formats.
  13851. The filter accepts the following options:
  13852. @table @option
  13853. @item input
  13854. @item output
  13855. Set format of the input/output video.
  13856. Available formats:
  13857. @table @samp
  13858. @item e
  13859. @item equirect
  13860. Equirectangular projection.
  13861. @item c3x2
  13862. @item c6x1
  13863. @item c1x6
  13864. Cubemap with 3x2/6x1/1x6 layout.
  13865. Format specific options:
  13866. @table @option
  13867. @item in_pad
  13868. @item out_pad
  13869. Set padding proportion for the input/output cubemap. Values in decimals.
  13870. Example values:
  13871. @table @samp
  13872. @item 0
  13873. No padding.
  13874. @item 0.01
  13875. 1% of face is padding. For example, with 1920x1280 resolution face size would be 640x640 and padding would be 3 pixels from each side. (640 * 0.01 = 6 pixels)
  13876. @end table
  13877. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  13878. @item fin_pad
  13879. @item fout_pad
  13880. Set fixed padding for the input/output cubemap. Values in pixels.
  13881. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}. If greater than zero it overrides other padding options.
  13882. @item in_forder
  13883. @item out_forder
  13884. Set order of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one direction for each position.
  13885. Designation of directions:
  13886. @table @samp
  13887. @item r
  13888. right
  13889. @item l
  13890. left
  13891. @item u
  13892. up
  13893. @item d
  13894. down
  13895. @item f
  13896. forward
  13897. @item b
  13898. back
  13899. @end table
  13900. Default value is @b{@samp{rludfb}}.
  13901. @item in_frot
  13902. @item out_frot
  13903. Set rotation of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one angle for each position.
  13904. Designation of angles:
  13905. @table @samp
  13906. @item 0
  13907. 0 degrees clockwise
  13908. @item 1
  13909. 90 degrees clockwise
  13910. @item 2
  13911. 180 degrees clockwise
  13912. @item 3
  13913. 270 degrees clockwise
  13914. @end table
  13915. Default value is @b{@samp{000000}}.
  13916. @end table
  13917. @item eac
  13918. Equi-Angular Cubemap.
  13919. @item flat
  13920. @item gnomonic
  13921. @item rectilinear
  13922. Regular video. @i{(output only)}
  13923. Format specific options:
  13924. @table @option
  13925. @item h_fov
  13926. @item v_fov
  13927. @item d_fov
  13928. Set horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  13929. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  13930. @end table
  13931. @item dfisheye
  13932. Dual fisheye.
  13933. Format specific options:
  13934. @table @option
  13935. @item in_pad
  13936. @item out_pad
  13937. Set padding proportion. Values in decimals.
  13938. Example values:
  13939. @table @samp
  13940. @item 0
  13941. No padding.
  13942. @item 0.01
  13943. 1% padding.
  13944. @end table
  13945. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  13946. @end table
  13947. @item barrel
  13948. @item fb
  13949. Facebook's 360 format.
  13950. @item sg
  13951. Stereographic format.
  13952. Format specific options:
  13953. @table @option
  13954. @item h_fov
  13955. @item v_fov
  13956. @item d_fov
  13957. Set horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  13958. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  13959. @end table
  13960. @item mercator
  13961. Mercator format.
  13962. @item ball
  13963. Ball format, gives significant distortion toward the back.
  13964. @item hammer
  13965. Hammer-Aitoff map projection format.
  13966. @item sinusoidal
  13967. Sinusoidal map projection format.
  13968. @end table
  13969. @item interp
  13970. Set interpolation method.@*
  13971. @i{Note: more complex interpolation methods require much more memory to run.}
  13972. Available methods:
  13973. @table @samp
  13974. @item near
  13975. @item nearest
  13976. Nearest neighbour.
  13977. @item line
  13978. @item linear
  13979. Bilinear interpolation.
  13980. @item cube
  13981. @item cubic
  13982. Bicubic interpolation.
  13983. @item lanc
  13984. @item lanczos
  13985. Lanczos interpolation.
  13986. @end table
  13987. Default value is @b{@samp{line}}.
  13988. @item w
  13989. @item h
  13990. Set the output video resolution.
  13991. Default resolution depends on formats.
  13992. @item in_stereo
  13993. @item out_stereo
  13994. Set the input/output stereo format.
  13995. @table @samp
  13996. @item 2d
  13997. 2D mono
  13998. @item sbs
  13999. Side by side
  14000. @item tb
  14001. Top bottom
  14002. @end table
  14003. Default value is @b{@samp{2d}} for input and output format.
  14004. @item yaw
  14005. @item pitch
  14006. @item roll
  14007. Set rotation for the output video. Values in degrees.
  14008. @item rorder
  14009. Set rotation order for the output video. Choose one item for each position.
  14010. @table @samp
  14011. @item y, Y
  14012. yaw
  14013. @item p, P
  14014. pitch
  14015. @item r, R
  14016. roll
  14017. @end table
  14018. Default value is @b{@samp{ypr}}.
  14019. @item h_flip
  14020. @item v_flip
  14021. @item d_flip
  14022. Flip the output video horizontally(swaps left-right)/vertically(swaps up-down)/in-depth(swaps back-forward). Boolean values.
  14023. @item ih_flip
  14024. @item iv_flip
  14025. Set if input video is flipped horizontally/vertically. Boolean values.
  14026. @item in_trans
  14027. Set if input video is transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14028. @item out_trans
  14029. Set if output video needs to be transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14030. @end table
  14031. @subsection Examples
  14032. @itemize
  14033. @item
  14034. Convert equirectangular video to cubemap with 3x2 layout and 1% padding using bicubic interpolation:
  14035. @example
  14036. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=e:c3x2:cubic:out_pad=0.01 output.mkv
  14037. @end example
  14038. @item
  14039. Extract back view of Equi-Angular Cubemap:
  14040. @example
  14041. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=eac:flat:yaw=180 output.mkv
  14042. @end example
  14043. @item
  14044. Convert transposed and horizontally flipped Equi-Angular Cubemap in side-by-side stereo format to equirectangular top-bottom stereo format:
  14045. @example
  14046. v360=eac:equirect:in_stereo=sbs:in_trans=1:ih_flip=1:out_stereo=tb
  14047. @end example
  14048. @end itemize
  14049. @section vaguedenoiser
  14050. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  14051. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  14052. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  14053. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  14054. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  14055. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  14056. This filter accepts the following options:
  14057. @table @option
  14058. @item threshold
  14059. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  14060. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  14061. before the video looks overfiltered. Default value is 2.
  14062. @item method
  14063. The filtering method the filter will use.
  14064. It accepts the following values:
  14065. @table @samp
  14066. @item hard
  14067. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  14068. @item soft
  14069. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  14070. reduced by the threshold.
  14071. @item garrote
  14072. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  14073. (less) hard thresholding.
  14074. @end table
  14075. Default is garrote.
  14076. @item nsteps
  14077. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  14078. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  14079. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480). Valid values are integers between 1 and 32. Default value is 6.
  14080. @item percent
  14081. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100. Default value is 85.
  14082. @item planes
  14083. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  14084. @end table
  14085. @section vectorscope
  14086. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  14087. a vectorscope).
  14088. This filter accepts the following options:
  14089. @table @option
  14090. @item mode, m
  14091. Set vectorscope mode.
  14092. It accepts the following values:
  14093. @table @samp
  14094. @item gray
  14095. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  14096. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  14097. @item color
  14098. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  14099. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  14100. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  14101. @item color2
  14102. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  14103. @item color3
  14104. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  14105. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  14106. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  14107. @item color4
  14108. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  14109. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  14110. not present in graph is picked.
  14111. @item color5
  14112. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  14113. component picked from radial gradient.
  14114. @end table
  14115. @item x
  14116. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  14117. @item y
  14118. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  14119. @item intensity, i
  14120. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  14121. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  14122. @item envelope, e
  14123. @table @samp
  14124. @item none
  14125. No envelope, this is default.
  14126. @item instant
  14127. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  14128. @item peak
  14129. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  14130. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  14131. @item peak+instant
  14132. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14133. @end table
  14134. @item graticule, g
  14135. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  14136. @table @samp
  14137. @item none
  14138. @item green
  14139. @item color
  14140. @end table
  14141. @item opacity, o
  14142. Set graticule opacity.
  14143. @item flags, f
  14144. Set graticule flags.
  14145. @table @samp
  14146. @item white
  14147. Draw graticule for white point.
  14148. @item black
  14149. Draw graticule for black point.
  14150. @item name
  14151. Draw color points short names.
  14152. @end table
  14153. @item bgopacity, b
  14154. Set background opacity.
  14155. @item lthreshold, l
  14156. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14157. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  14158. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14159. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  14160. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  14161. @item hthreshold, h
  14162. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14163. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  14164. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14165. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  14166. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  14167. @item colorspace, c
  14168. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  14169. @table @samp
  14170. @item auto
  14171. @item 601
  14172. @item 709
  14173. @end table
  14174. Default is auto.
  14175. @end table
  14176. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  14177. @section vidstabdetect
  14178. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  14179. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  14180. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  14181. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  14182. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  14183. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14184. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14185. This filter accepts the following options:
  14186. @table @option
  14187. @item result
  14188. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  14189. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  14190. @item shakiness
  14191. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  14192. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  14193. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  14194. @item accuracy
  14195. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  14196. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  14197. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  14198. @item stepsize
  14199. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  14200. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  14201. @item mincontrast
  14202. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  14203. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  14204. value is 0.3.
  14205. @item tripod
  14206. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  14207. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  14208. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  14209. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  14210. the camera view absolutely still.
  14211. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  14212. @item show
  14213. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  14214. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  14215. visualization.
  14216. @end table
  14217. @subsection Examples
  14218. @itemize
  14219. @item
  14220. Use default values:
  14221. @example
  14222. vidstabdetect
  14223. @end example
  14224. @item
  14225. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  14226. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  14227. @example
  14228. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  14229. @end example
  14230. @item
  14231. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  14232. video:
  14233. @example
  14234. vidstabdetect=show=1
  14235. @end example
  14236. @item
  14237. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  14238. @example
  14239. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  14240. @end example
  14241. @end itemize
  14242. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  14243. @section vidstabtransform
  14244. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  14245. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  14246. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  14247. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  14248. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  14249. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  14250. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  14251. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14252. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14253. @subsection Options
  14254. @table @option
  14255. @item input
  14256. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  14257. @file{transforms.trf}.
  14258. @item smoothing
  14259. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  14260. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  14261. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  14262. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  14263. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  14264. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  14265. camera is simulated.
  14266. @item optalgo
  14267. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  14268. Accepted values are:
  14269. @table @samp
  14270. @item gauss
  14271. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  14272. @item avg
  14273. averaging on transformations
  14274. @end table
  14275. @item maxshift
  14276. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  14277. meaning no limit.
  14278. @item maxangle
  14279. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  14280. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  14281. @item crop
  14282. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  14283. compensation.
  14284. Available values are:
  14285. @table @samp
  14286. @item keep
  14287. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  14288. @item black
  14289. fill the border black
  14290. @end table
  14291. @item invert
  14292. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  14293. @item relative
  14294. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  14295. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  14296. @item zoom
  14297. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  14298. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  14299. zoom).
  14300. @item optzoom
  14301. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  14302. Accepted values are:
  14303. @table @samp
  14304. @item 0
  14305. disabled
  14306. @item 1
  14307. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  14308. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  14309. @item 2
  14310. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  14311. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  14312. @end table
  14313. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  14314. @item zoomspeed
  14315. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  14316. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  14317. 0.25.
  14318. @item interpol
  14319. Specify type of interpolation.
  14320. Available values are:
  14321. @table @samp
  14322. @item no
  14323. no interpolation
  14324. @item linear
  14325. linear only horizontal
  14326. @item bilinear
  14327. linear in both directions (default)
  14328. @item bicubic
  14329. cubic in both directions (slow)
  14330. @end table
  14331. @item tripod
  14332. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  14333. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  14334. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  14335. @item debug
  14336. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  14337. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  14338. value is 0.
  14339. @end table
  14340. @subsection Examples
  14341. @itemize
  14342. @item
  14343. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  14344. @example
  14345. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  14346. @end example
  14347. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  14348. @item
  14349. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  14350. @example
  14351. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  14352. @end example
  14353. @item
  14354. Smoothen the video even more:
  14355. @example
  14356. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  14357. @end example
  14358. @end itemize
  14359. @section vflip
  14360. Flip the input video vertically.
  14361. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  14362. @example
  14363. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  14364. @end example
  14365. @section vfrdet
  14366. Detect variable frame rate video.
  14367. This filter tries to detect if the input is variable or constant frame rate.
  14368. At end it will output number of frames detected as having variable delta pts,
  14369. and ones with constant delta pts.
  14370. If there was frames with variable delta, than it will also show min and max delta
  14371. encountered.
  14372. @section vibrance
  14373. Boost or alter saturation.
  14374. The filter accepts the following options:
  14375. @table @option
  14376. @item intensity
  14377. Set strength of boost if positive value or strength of alter if negative value.
  14378. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -2 to 2.
  14379. @item rbal
  14380. Set the red balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14381. @item gbal
  14382. Set the green balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14383. @item bbal
  14384. Set the blue balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14385. @item rlum
  14386. Set the red luma coefficient.
  14387. @item glum
  14388. Set the green luma coefficient.
  14389. @item blum
  14390. Set the blue luma coefficient.
  14391. @item alternate
  14392. If @code{intensity} is negative and this is set to 1, colors will change,
  14393. otherwise colors will be less saturated, more towards gray.
  14394. @end table
  14395. @anchor{vignette}
  14396. @section vignette
  14397. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  14398. The filter accepts the following options:
  14399. @table @option
  14400. @item angle, a
  14401. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  14402. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  14403. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  14404. @item x0
  14405. @item y0
  14406. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  14407. by default.
  14408. @item mode
  14409. Set forward/backward mode.
  14410. Available modes are:
  14411. @table @samp
  14412. @item forward
  14413. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  14414. @item backward
  14415. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  14416. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  14417. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  14418. also be used to create a burning effect.
  14419. @end table
  14420. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  14421. @item eval
  14422. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  14423. It accepts the following values:
  14424. @table @samp
  14425. @item init
  14426. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  14427. @item frame
  14428. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  14429. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  14430. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  14431. @end table
  14432. Default value is @samp{init}.
  14433. @item dither
  14434. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  14435. (enabled).
  14436. @item aspect
  14437. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  14438. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  14439. following the dimensions of the video.
  14440. Default is @code{1/1}.
  14441. @end table
  14442. @subsection Expressions
  14443. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  14444. following parameters.
  14445. @table @option
  14446. @item w
  14447. @item h
  14448. input width and height
  14449. @item n
  14450. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  14451. @item pts
  14452. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  14453. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  14454. @item r
  14455. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  14456. @item t
  14457. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  14458. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  14459. @item tb
  14460. time base of the input video
  14461. @end table
  14462. @subsection Examples
  14463. @itemize
  14464. @item
  14465. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  14466. @example
  14467. vignette=PI/4
  14468. @end example
  14469. @item
  14470. Make a flickering vignetting:
  14471. @example
  14472. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  14473. @end example
  14474. @end itemize
  14475. @section vmafmotion
  14476. Obtain the average vmaf motion score of a video.
  14477. It is one of the component filters of VMAF.
  14478. The obtained average motion score is printed through the logging system.
  14479. In the below example the input file @file{ref.mpg} is being processed and score
  14480. is computed.
  14481. @example
  14482. ffmpeg -i ref.mpg -lavfi vmafmotion -f null -
  14483. @end example
  14484. @section vstack
  14485. Stack input videos vertically.
  14486. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  14487. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  14488. to create same output.
  14489. The filter accepts the following options:
  14490. @table @option
  14491. @item inputs
  14492. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  14493. @item shortest
  14494. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  14495. terminates. Default value is 0.
  14496. @end table
  14497. @section w3fdif
  14498. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  14499. Deinterlacing Filter").
  14500. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  14501. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  14502. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  14503. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  14504. This filter uses field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  14505. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  14506. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{w3fdif} filter.
  14507. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple"
  14508. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  14509. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  14510. @table @option
  14511. @item filter
  14512. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  14513. @table @samp
  14514. @item simple
  14515. Simple filter coefficient set.
  14516. @item complex
  14517. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  14518. @end table
  14519. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  14520. @item deint
  14521. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:
  14522. @table @samp
  14523. @item all
  14524. Deinterlace all frames,
  14525. @item interlaced
  14526. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  14527. @end table
  14528. Default value is @samp{all}.
  14529. @end table
  14530. @section waveform
  14531. Video waveform monitor.
  14532. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  14533. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  14534. source video.
  14535. It accepts the following options:
  14536. @table @option
  14537. @item mode, m
  14538. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  14539. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  14540. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  14541. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  14542. @item intensity, i
  14543. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  14544. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  14545. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  14546. @item mirror, r
  14547. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  14548. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  14549. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  14550. @code{1} (mirrored).
  14551. @item display, d
  14552. Set display mode.
  14553. It accepts the following values:
  14554. @table @samp
  14555. @item overlay
  14556. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  14557. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  14558. over one another.
  14559. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  14560. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  14561. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  14562. @item stack
  14563. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  14564. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  14565. @item parade
  14566. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  14567. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  14568. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  14569. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  14570. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  14571. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  14572. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  14573. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  14574. @end table
  14575. Default is @code{stack}.
  14576. @item components, c
  14577. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  14578. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  14579. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  14580. @item envelope, e
  14581. @table @samp
  14582. @item none
  14583. No envelope, this is default.
  14584. @item instant
  14585. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  14586. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  14587. @item peak
  14588. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  14589. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  14590. @item peak+instant
  14591. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14592. @end table
  14593. @item filter, f
  14594. @table @samp
  14595. @item lowpass
  14596. No filtering, this is default.
  14597. @item flat
  14598. Luma and chroma combined together.
  14599. @item aflat
  14600. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  14601. @item xflat
  14602. Similar as above, but use different colors.
  14603. @item yflat
  14604. Similar as above, but again with different colors.
  14605. @item chroma
  14606. Displays only chroma.
  14607. @item color
  14608. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  14609. @item acolor
  14610. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  14611. @end table
  14612. @item graticule, g
  14613. Set which graticule to display.
  14614. @table @samp
  14615. @item none
  14616. Do not display graticule.
  14617. @item green
  14618. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  14619. @item orange
  14620. Display orange graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  14621. @item invert
  14622. Display invert graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  14623. @end table
  14624. @item opacity, o
  14625. Set graticule opacity.
  14626. @item flags, fl
  14627. Set graticule flags.
  14628. @table @samp
  14629. @item numbers
  14630. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  14631. @item dots
  14632. Draw dots instead of lines.
  14633. @end table
  14634. @item scale, s
  14635. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  14636. @table @samp
  14637. @item digital
  14638. @item millivolts
  14639. @item ire
  14640. @end table
  14641. Default is digital.
  14642. @item bgopacity, b
  14643. Set background opacity.
  14644. @end table
  14645. @section weave, doubleweave
  14646. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  14647. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  14648. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  14649. The @code{doubleweave} works same as @code{weave} but without
  14650. halving frame rate and frame count.
  14651. It accepts the following option:
  14652. @table @option
  14653. @item first_field
  14654. Set first field. Available values are:
  14655. @table @samp
  14656. @item top, t
  14657. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  14658. @item bottom, b
  14659. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  14660. @end table
  14661. @end table
  14662. @subsection Examples
  14663. @itemize
  14664. @item
  14665. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  14666. @example
  14667. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  14668. @end example
  14669. @end itemize
  14670. @section xbr
  14671. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  14672. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  14673. @url{https://forums.libretro.com/t/xbr-algorithm-tutorial/123}.
  14674. It accepts the following option:
  14675. @table @option
  14676. @item n
  14677. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  14678. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  14679. Default is @code{3}.
  14680. @end table
  14681. @section xmedian
  14682. Pick median pixels from several input videos.
  14683. The filter accepts the following options:
  14684. @table @option
  14685. @item inputs
  14686. Set number of inputs.
  14687. Default is 3. Allowed range is from 3 to 255.
  14688. If number of inputs is even number, than result will be mean value between two median values.
  14689. @item planes
  14690. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  14691. @end table
  14692. @section xstack
  14693. Stack video inputs into custom layout.
  14694. All streams must be of same pixel format.
  14695. The filter accepts the following options:
  14696. @table @option
  14697. @item inputs
  14698. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  14699. @item layout
  14700. Specify layout of inputs.
  14701. This option requires the desired layout configuration to be explicitly set by the user.
  14702. This sets position of each video input in output. Each input
  14703. is separated by '|'.
  14704. The first number represents the column, and the second number represents the row.
  14705. Numbers start at 0 and are separated by '_'. Optionally one can use wX and hX,
  14706. where X is video input from which to take width or height.
  14707. Multiple values can be used when separated by '+'. In such
  14708. case values are summed together.
  14709. Note that if inputs are of different sizes gaps may appear, as not all of
  14710. the output video frame will be filled. Similarly, videos can overlap each
  14711. other if their position doesn't leave enough space for the full frame of
  14712. adjoining videos.
  14713. For 2 inputs, a default layout of @code{0_0|w0_0} is set. In all other cases,
  14714. a layout must be set by the user.
  14715. @item shortest
  14716. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  14717. terminates. Default value is 0.
  14718. @end table
  14719. @subsection Examples
  14720. @itemize
  14721. @item
  14722. Display 4 inputs into 2x2 grid.
  14723. Layout:
  14724. @example
  14725. input1(0, 0) | input3(w0, 0)
  14726. input2(0, h0) | input4(w0, h0)
  14727. @end example
  14728. @example
  14729. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|w0_0|w0_h0
  14730. @end example
  14731. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  14732. @item
  14733. Display 4 inputs into 1x4 grid.
  14734. Layout:
  14735. @example
  14736. input1(0, 0)
  14737. input2(0, h0)
  14738. input3(0, h0+h1)
  14739. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)
  14740. @end example
  14741. @example
  14742. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2
  14743. @end example
  14744. Note that if inputs are of different widths, unused space will appear.
  14745. @item
  14746. Display 9 inputs into 3x3 grid.
  14747. Layout:
  14748. @example
  14749. input1(0, 0) | input4(w0, 0) | input7(w0+w3, 0)
  14750. input2(0, h0) | input5(w0, h0) | input8(w0+w3, h0)
  14751. input3(0, h0+h1) | input6(w0, h0+h1) | input9(w0+w3, h0+h1)
  14752. @end example
  14753. @example
  14754. xstack=inputs=9:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0+w3_0|w0+w3_h0|w0+w3_h0+h1
  14755. @end example
  14756. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  14757. @item
  14758. Display 16 inputs into 4x4 grid.
  14759. Layout:
  14760. @example
  14761. input1(0, 0) | input5(w0, 0) | input9 (w0+w4, 0) | input13(w0+w4+w8, 0)
  14762. input2(0, h0) | input6(w0, h0) | input10(w0+w4, h0) | input14(w0+w4+w8, h0)
  14763. input3(0, h0+h1) | input7(w0, h0+h1) | input11(w0+w4, h0+h1) | input15(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1)
  14764. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)| input8(w0, h0+h1+h2)| input12(w0+w4, h0+h1+h2)| input16(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1+h2)
  14765. @end example
  14766. @example
  14767. xstack=inputs=16:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4_0|
  14768. w0+w4_h0|w0+w4_h0+h1|w0+w4_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4+w8_0|w0+w4+w8_h0|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1+h2
  14769. @end example
  14770. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  14771. @end itemize
  14772. @anchor{yadif}
  14773. @section yadif
  14774. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  14775. filter").
  14776. It accepts the following parameters:
  14777. @table @option
  14778. @item mode
  14779. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  14780. @table @option
  14781. @item 0, send_frame
  14782. Output one frame for each frame.
  14783. @item 1, send_field
  14784. Output one frame for each field.
  14785. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  14786. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  14787. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  14788. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  14789. @end table
  14790. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  14791. @item parity
  14792. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  14793. of the following values:
  14794. @table @option
  14795. @item 0, tff
  14796. Assume the top field is first.
  14797. @item 1, bff
  14798. Assume the bottom field is first.
  14799. @item -1, auto
  14800. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  14801. @end table
  14802. The default value is @code{auto}.
  14803. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  14804. top field first will be assumed.
  14805. @item deint
  14806. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  14807. values:
  14808. @table @option
  14809. @item 0, all
  14810. Deinterlace all frames.
  14811. @item 1, interlaced
  14812. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  14813. @end table
  14814. The default value is @code{all}.
  14815. @end table
  14816. @section yadif_cuda
  14817. Deinterlace the input video using the @ref{yadif} algorithm, but implemented
  14818. in CUDA so that it can work as part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec
  14819. and/or nvenc.
  14820. It accepts the following parameters:
  14821. @table @option
  14822. @item mode
  14823. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  14824. @table @option
  14825. @item 0, send_frame
  14826. Output one frame for each frame.
  14827. @item 1, send_field
  14828. Output one frame for each field.
  14829. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  14830. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  14831. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  14832. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  14833. @end table
  14834. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  14835. @item parity
  14836. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  14837. of the following values:
  14838. @table @option
  14839. @item 0, tff
  14840. Assume the top field is first.
  14841. @item 1, bff
  14842. Assume the bottom field is first.
  14843. @item -1, auto
  14844. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  14845. @end table
  14846. The default value is @code{auto}.
  14847. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  14848. top field first will be assumed.
  14849. @item deint
  14850. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  14851. values:
  14852. @table @option
  14853. @item 0, all
  14854. Deinterlace all frames.
  14855. @item 1, interlaced
  14856. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  14857. @end table
  14858. The default value is @code{all}.
  14859. @end table
  14860. @section zoompan
  14861. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  14862. This filter accepts the following options:
  14863. @table @option
  14864. @item zoom, z
  14865. Set the zoom expression. Range is 1-10. Default is 1.
  14866. @item x
  14867. @item y
  14868. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  14869. @item d
  14870. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  14871. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  14872. single input image.
  14873. @item s
  14874. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  14875. @item fps
  14876. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  14877. @end table
  14878. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  14879. @table @option
  14880. @item in_w, iw
  14881. Input width.
  14882. @item in_h, ih
  14883. Input height.
  14884. @item out_w, ow
  14885. Output width.
  14886. @item out_h, oh
  14887. Output height.
  14888. @item in
  14889. Input frame count.
  14890. @item on
  14891. Output frame count.
  14892. @item x
  14893. @item y
  14894. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  14895. for current input frame.
  14896. @item px
  14897. @item py
  14898. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  14899. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  14900. @item zoom
  14901. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  14902. @item pzoom
  14903. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  14904. @item duration
  14905. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  14906. for each input frame.
  14907. @item pduration
  14908. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  14909. @item a
  14910. Rational number: input width / input height
  14911. @item sar
  14912. sample aspect ratio
  14913. @item dar
  14914. display aspect ratio
  14915. @end table
  14916. @subsection Examples
  14917. @itemize
  14918. @item
  14919. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  14920. @example
  14921. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  14922. @end example
  14923. @item
  14924. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
  14925. @example
  14926. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  14927. @end example
  14928. @item
  14929. Same as above but without pausing:
  14930. @example
  14931. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  14932. @end example
  14933. @end itemize
  14934. @anchor{zscale}
  14935. @section zscale
  14936. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  14937. @url{https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg}. To enable compilation of this
  14938. filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzimg}.
  14939. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  14940. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  14941. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  14942. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  14943. requested format.
  14944. @subsection Options
  14945. The filter accepts the following options.
  14946. @table @option
  14947. @item width, w
  14948. @item height, h
  14949. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  14950. dimension.
  14951. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  14952. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  14953. is used for the output.
  14954. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the zscale filter
  14955. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  14956. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  14957. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  14958. adjust the value if necessary.
  14959. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  14960. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  14961. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  14962. expression.
  14963. @item size, s
  14964. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  14965. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  14966. @item dither, d
  14967. Set the dither type.
  14968. Possible values are:
  14969. @table @var
  14970. @item none
  14971. @item ordered
  14972. @item random
  14973. @item error_diffusion
  14974. @end table
  14975. Default is none.
  14976. @item filter, f
  14977. Set the resize filter type.
  14978. Possible values are:
  14979. @table @var
  14980. @item point
  14981. @item bilinear
  14982. @item bicubic
  14983. @item spline16
  14984. @item spline36
  14985. @item lanczos
  14986. @end table
  14987. Default is bilinear.
  14988. @item range, r
  14989. Set the color range.
  14990. Possible values are:
  14991. @table @var
  14992. @item input
  14993. @item limited
  14994. @item full
  14995. @end table
  14996. Default is same as input.
  14997. @item primaries, p
  14998. Set the color primaries.
  14999. Possible values are:
  15000. @table @var
  15001. @item input
  15002. @item 709
  15003. @item unspecified
  15004. @item 170m
  15005. @item 240m
  15006. @item 2020
  15007. @end table
  15008. Default is same as input.
  15009. @item transfer, t
  15010. Set the transfer characteristics.
  15011. Possible values are:
  15012. @table @var
  15013. @item input
  15014. @item 709
  15015. @item unspecified
  15016. @item 601
  15017. @item linear
  15018. @item 2020_10
  15019. @item 2020_12
  15020. @item smpte2084
  15021. @item iec61966-2-1
  15022. @item arib-std-b67
  15023. @end table
  15024. Default is same as input.
  15025. @item matrix, m
  15026. Set the colorspace matrix.
  15027. Possible value are:
  15028. @table @var
  15029. @item input
  15030. @item 709
  15031. @item unspecified
  15032. @item 470bg
  15033. @item 170m
  15034. @item 2020_ncl
  15035. @item 2020_cl
  15036. @end table
  15037. Default is same as input.
  15038. @item rangein, rin
  15039. Set the input color range.
  15040. Possible values are:
  15041. @table @var
  15042. @item input
  15043. @item limited
  15044. @item full
  15045. @end table
  15046. Default is same as input.
  15047. @item primariesin, pin
  15048. Set the input color primaries.
  15049. Possible values are:
  15050. @table @var
  15051. @item input
  15052. @item 709
  15053. @item unspecified
  15054. @item 170m
  15055. @item 240m
  15056. @item 2020
  15057. @end table
  15058. Default is same as input.
  15059. @item transferin, tin
  15060. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  15061. Possible values are:
  15062. @table @var
  15063. @item input
  15064. @item 709
  15065. @item unspecified
  15066. @item 601
  15067. @item linear
  15068. @item 2020_10
  15069. @item 2020_12
  15070. @end table
  15071. Default is same as input.
  15072. @item matrixin, min
  15073. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  15074. Possible value are:
  15075. @table @var
  15076. @item input
  15077. @item 709
  15078. @item unspecified
  15079. @item 470bg
  15080. @item 170m
  15081. @item 2020_ncl
  15082. @item 2020_cl
  15083. @end table
  15084. @item chromal, c
  15085. Set the output chroma location.
  15086. Possible values are:
  15087. @table @var
  15088. @item input
  15089. @item left
  15090. @item center
  15091. @item topleft
  15092. @item top
  15093. @item bottomleft
  15094. @item bottom
  15095. @end table
  15096. @item chromalin, cin
  15097. Set the input chroma location.
  15098. Possible values are:
  15099. @table @var
  15100. @item input
  15101. @item left
  15102. @item center
  15103. @item topleft
  15104. @item top
  15105. @item bottomleft
  15106. @item bottom
  15107. @end table
  15108. @item npl
  15109. Set the nominal peak luminance.
  15110. @end table
  15111. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  15112. containing the following constants:
  15113. @table @var
  15114. @item in_w
  15115. @item in_h
  15116. The input width and height
  15117. @item iw
  15118. @item ih
  15119. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  15120. @item out_w
  15121. @item out_h
  15122. The output (scaled) width and height
  15123. @item ow
  15124. @item oh
  15125. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  15126. @item a
  15127. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  15128. @item sar
  15129. input sample aspect ratio
  15130. @item dar
  15131. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  15132. @item hsub
  15133. @item vsub
  15134. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15135. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15136. @item ohsub
  15137. @item ovsub
  15138. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15139. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15140. @end table
  15141. @table @option
  15142. @end table
  15143. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  15144. @chapter OpenCL Video Filters
  15145. @c man begin OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  15146. Below is a description of the currently available OpenCL video filters.
  15147. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  15148. @code{--enable-opencl}.
  15149. Running OpenCL filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all filters in any filter graph.
  15150. @table @option
  15151. @item -init_hw_device opencl[=@var{name}][:@var{device}[,@var{key=value}...]]
  15152. Initialise a new hardware device of type @var{opencl} called @var{name}, using the
  15153. given device parameters.
  15154. @item -filter_hw_device @var{name}
  15155. Pass the hardware device called @var{name} to all filters in any filter graph.
  15156. @end table
  15157. For more detailed information see @url{https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options}
  15158. @itemize
  15159. @item
  15160. Example of choosing the first device on the second platform and running avgblur_opencl filter with default parameters on it.
  15161. @example
  15162. -init_hw_device opencl=gpu:1.0 -filter_hw_device gpu -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15163. @end example
  15164. @end itemize
  15165. Since OpenCL filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be uploaded(@ref{hwupload}) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then downloaded(@ref{hwdownload}) back to normal memory. Note that @ref{hwupload} will upload to a surface with the same layout as the software frame, so it may be necessary to add a @ref{format} filter immediately before to get the input into the right format and @ref{hwdownload} does not support all formats on the output - it may be necessary to insert an additional @ref{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a supported format.
  15166. @section avgblur_opencl
  15167. Apply average blur filter.
  15168. The filter accepts the following options:
  15169. @table @option
  15170. @item sizeX
  15171. Set horizontal radius size.
  15172. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{1}.
  15173. @item planes
  15174. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15175. @item sizeY
  15176. Set vertical radius size. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{0}. If zero, @code{sizeX} value will be used.
  15177. @end table
  15178. @subsection Example
  15179. @itemize
  15180. @item
  15181. Apply average blur filter with horizontal and vertical size of 3, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of the 7x7 region centered on it in the input. For pixels on the edges of the image, the region does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15182. @example
  15183. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15184. @end example
  15185. @end itemize
  15186. @section boxblur_opencl
  15187. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  15188. It accepts the following parameters:
  15189. @table @option
  15190. @item luma_radius, lr
  15191. @item luma_power, lp
  15192. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15193. @item chroma_power, cp
  15194. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15195. @item alpha_power, ap
  15196. @end table
  15197. A description of the accepted options follows.
  15198. @table @option
  15199. @item luma_radius, lr
  15200. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15201. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15202. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  15203. corresponding input plane.
  15204. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  15205. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  15206. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  15207. planes.
  15208. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  15209. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  15210. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  15211. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  15212. @table @option
  15213. @item w
  15214. @item h
  15215. The input width and height in pixels.
  15216. @item cw
  15217. @item ch
  15218. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  15219. @item hsub
  15220. @item vsub
  15221. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  15222. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15223. @end table
  15224. @item luma_power, lp
  15225. @item chroma_power, cp
  15226. @item alpha_power, ap
  15227. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  15228. corresponding plane.
  15229. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  15230. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  15231. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  15232. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  15233. @end table
  15234. @subsection Examples
  15235. Apply boxblur filter, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of box-radiuses @var{luma_radius}, @var{chroma_radius}, @var{alpha_radius} for each plane respectively. The filter will apply @var{luma_power}, @var{chroma_power}, @var{alpha_power} times onto the corresponding plane. For pixels on the edges of the image, the radius does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15236. @itemize
  15237. @item
  15238. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radius
  15239. set to 2 and luma, chroma, and alpha power set to 3. The filter will run 3 times with box-radius set to 2 for every plane of the image.
  15240. @example
  15241. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=luma_radius=2:luma_power=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15242. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15243. @end example
  15244. @item
  15245. Apply a boxblur filter with luma radius set to 2, luma_power to 1, chroma_radius to 4, chroma_power to 5, alpha_radius to 3 and alpha_power to 7.
  15246. For the luma plane, a 2x2 box radius will be run once.
  15247. For the chroma plane, a 4x4 box radius will be run 5 times.
  15248. For the alpha plane, a 3x3 box radius will be run 7 times.
  15249. @example
  15250. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:1:4:5:3:7, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15251. @end example
  15252. @end itemize
  15253. @section convolution_opencl
  15254. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 matrix.
  15255. The filter accepts the following options:
  15256. @table @option
  15257. @item 0m
  15258. @item 1m
  15259. @item 2m
  15260. @item 3m
  15261. Set matrix for each plane.
  15262. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed numbers.
  15263. Default value for each plane is @code{0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0}.
  15264. @item 0rdiv
  15265. @item 1rdiv
  15266. @item 2rdiv
  15267. @item 3rdiv
  15268. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  15269. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  15270. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{1.0}.
  15271. @item 0bias
  15272. @item 1bias
  15273. @item 2bias
  15274. @item 3bias
  15275. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  15276. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker.
  15277. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{0.0}.
  15278. @end table
  15279. @subsection Examples
  15280. @itemize
  15281. @item
  15282. Apply sharpen:
  15283. @example
  15284. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15285. @end example
  15286. @item
  15287. Apply blur:
  15288. @example
  15289. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15290. @end example
  15291. @item
  15292. Apply edge enhance:
  15293. @example
  15294. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15295. @end example
  15296. @item
  15297. Apply edge detect:
  15298. @example
  15299. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15300. @end example
  15301. @item
  15302. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  15303. @example
  15304. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15305. @end example
  15306. @item
  15307. Apply emboss:
  15308. @example
  15309. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15310. @end example
  15311. @end itemize
  15312. @section dilation_opencl
  15313. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  15314. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  15315. It accepts the following options:
  15316. @table @option
  15317. @item threshold0
  15318. @item threshold1
  15319. @item threshold2
  15320. @item threshold3
  15321. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  15322. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  15323. @item coordinates
  15324. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  15325. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  15326. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  15327. 1 2 3
  15328. 4 x 5
  15329. 6 7 8
  15330. @end table
  15331. @subsection Example
  15332. @itemize
  15333. @item
  15334. Apply dilation filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local maximum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local maximum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel + threshold of corresponding plane.
  15335. @example
  15336. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, dilation_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15337. @end example
  15338. @end itemize
  15339. @section erosion_opencl
  15340. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  15341. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  15342. It accepts the following options:
  15343. @table @option
  15344. @item threshold0
  15345. @item threshold1
  15346. @item threshold2
  15347. @item threshold3
  15348. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  15349. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  15350. @item coordinates
  15351. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  15352. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  15353. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  15354. 1 2 3
  15355. 4 x 5
  15356. 6 7 8
  15357. @end table
  15358. @subsection Example
  15359. @itemize
  15360. @item
  15361. Apply erosion filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local minimum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local minimum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel - threshold of corresponding plane.
  15362. @example
  15363. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, erosion_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15364. @end example
  15365. @end itemize
  15366. @section colorkey_opencl
  15367. RGB colorspace color keying.
  15368. The filter accepts the following options:
  15369. @table @option
  15370. @item color
  15371. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  15372. @item similarity
  15373. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  15374. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  15375. @item blend
  15376. Blend percentage.
  15377. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  15378. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  15379. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  15380. @end table
  15381. @subsection Examples
  15382. @itemize
  15383. @item
  15384. Make every semi-green pixel in the input transparent with some slight blending:
  15385. @example
  15386. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, colorkey_opencl=green:0.3:0.1, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15387. @end example
  15388. @end itemize
  15389. @section deshake_opencl
  15390. Feature-point based video stabilization filter.
  15391. The filter accepts the following options:
  15392. @table @option
  15393. @item tripod
  15394. Simulates a tripod by preventing any camera movement whatsoever from the original frame. Defaults to @code{0}.
  15395. @item debug
  15396. Whether or not additional debug info should be displayed, both in the processed output and in the console.
  15397. Note that in order to see console debug output you will also need to pass @code{-v verbose} to ffmpeg.
  15398. Viewing point matches in the output video is only supported for RGB input.
  15399. Defaults to @code{0}.
  15400. @item adaptive_crop
  15401. Whether or not to do a tiny bit of cropping at the borders to cut down on the amount of mirrored pixels.
  15402. Defaults to @code{1}.
  15403. @item refine_features
  15404. Whether or not feature points should be refined at a sub-pixel level.
  15405. This can be turned off for a slight performance gain at the cost of precision.
  15406. Defaults to @code{1}.
  15407. @item smooth_strength
  15408. The strength of the smoothing applied to the camera path from @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}.
  15409. @code{1.0} is the maximum smoothing strength while values less than that result in less smoothing.
  15410. @code{0.0} causes the filter to adaptively choose a smoothing strength on a per-frame basis.
  15411. Defaults to @code{0.0}.
  15412. @item smooth_window_multiplier
  15413. Controls the size of the smoothing window (the number of frames buffered to determine motion information from).
  15414. The size of the smoothing window is determined by multiplying the framerate of the video by this number.
  15415. Acceptable values range from @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}.
  15416. Larger values increase the amount of motion data available for determining how to smooth the camera path,
  15417. potentially improving smoothness, but also increase latency and memory usage.
  15418. Defaults to @code{2.0}.
  15419. @end table
  15420. @subsection Examples
  15421. @itemize
  15422. @item
  15423. Stabilize a video with a fixed, medium smoothing strength:
  15424. @example
  15425. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, deshake_opencl=smooth_strength=0.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15426. @end example
  15427. @item
  15428. Stabilize a video with debugging (both in console and in rendered video):
  15429. @example
  15430. -i INPUT -filter_complex "[0:v]format=rgba, hwupload, deshake_opencl=debug=1, hwdownload, format=rgba, format=yuv420p" -v verbose OUTPUT
  15431. @end example
  15432. @end itemize
  15433. @section nlmeans_opencl
  15434. Non-local Means denoise filter through OpenCL, this filter accepts same options as @ref{nlmeans}.
  15435. @section overlay_opencl
  15436. Overlay one video on top of another.
  15437. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is overlaid.
  15438. This filter requires same memory layout for all the inputs. So, format conversion may be needed.
  15439. The filter accepts the following options:
  15440. @table @option
  15441. @item x
  15442. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  15443. Default value is @code{0}.
  15444. @item y
  15445. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  15446. Default value is @code{0}.
  15447. @end table
  15448. @subsection Examples
  15449. @itemize
  15450. @item
  15451. Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs are yuv420p format.
  15452. @example
  15453. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15454. @end example
  15455. @item
  15456. The inputs have same memory layout for color channels , the overlay has additional alpha plane, like INPUT is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.
  15457. @example
  15458. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15459. @end example
  15460. @end itemize
  15461. @section prewitt_opencl
  15462. Apply the Prewitt operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Prewitt_operator}) to input video stream.
  15463. The filter accepts the following option:
  15464. @table @option
  15465. @item planes
  15466. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15467. @item scale
  15468. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15469. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15470. @item delta
  15471. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15472. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15473. @end table
  15474. @subsection Example
  15475. @itemize
  15476. @item
  15477. Apply the Prewitt operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10.
  15478. @example
  15479. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, prewitt_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15480. @end example
  15481. @end itemize
  15482. @section roberts_opencl
  15483. Apply the Roberts cross operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Roberts_cross}) to input video stream.
  15484. The filter accepts the following option:
  15485. @table @option
  15486. @item planes
  15487. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15488. @item scale
  15489. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15490. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15491. @item delta
  15492. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15493. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15494. @end table
  15495. @subsection Example
  15496. @itemize
  15497. @item
  15498. Apply the Roberts cross operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  15499. @example
  15500. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, roberts_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15501. @end example
  15502. @end itemize
  15503. @section sobel_opencl
  15504. Apply the Sobel operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sobel_operator}) to input video stream.
  15505. The filter accepts the following option:
  15506. @table @option
  15507. @item planes
  15508. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15509. @item scale
  15510. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15511. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15512. @item delta
  15513. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15514. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15515. @end table
  15516. @subsection Example
  15517. @itemize
  15518. @item
  15519. Apply sobel operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  15520. @example
  15521. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, sobel_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15522. @end example
  15523. @end itemize
  15524. @section tonemap_opencl
  15525. Perform HDR(PQ/HLG) to SDR conversion with tone-mapping.
  15526. It accepts the following parameters:
  15527. @table @option
  15528. @item tonemap
  15529. Specify the tone-mapping operator to be used. Same as tonemap option in @ref{tonemap}.
  15530. @item param
  15531. Tune the tone mapping algorithm. same as param option in @ref{tonemap}.
  15532. @item desat
  15533. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  15534. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  15535. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  15536. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  15537. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  15538. The default value is 0.5, and the algorithm here is a little different from
  15539. the cpu version tonemap currently. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  15540. @item threshold
  15541. The tonemapping algorithm parameters is fine-tuned per each scene. And a threshold
  15542. is used to detect whether the scene has changed or not. If the distance between
  15543. the current frame average brightness and the current running average exceeds
  15544. a threshold value, we would re-calculate scene average and peak brightness.
  15545. The default value is 0.2.
  15546. @item format
  15547. Specify the output pixel format.
  15548. Currently supported formats are:
  15549. @table @var
  15550. @item p010
  15551. @item nv12
  15552. @end table
  15553. @item range, r
  15554. Set the output color range.
  15555. Possible values are:
  15556. @table @var
  15557. @item tv/mpeg
  15558. @item pc/jpeg
  15559. @end table
  15560. Default is same as input.
  15561. @item primaries, p
  15562. Set the output color primaries.
  15563. Possible values are:
  15564. @table @var
  15565. @item bt709
  15566. @item bt2020
  15567. @end table
  15568. Default is same as input.
  15569. @item transfer, t
  15570. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  15571. Possible values are:
  15572. @table @var
  15573. @item bt709
  15574. @item bt2020
  15575. @end table
  15576. Default is bt709.
  15577. @item matrix, m
  15578. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  15579. Possible value are:
  15580. @table @var
  15581. @item bt709
  15582. @item bt2020
  15583. @end table
  15584. Default is same as input.
  15585. @end table
  15586. @subsection Example
  15587. @itemize
  15588. @item
  15589. Convert HDR(PQ/HLG) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format using linear operator.
  15590. @example
  15591. -i INPUT -vf "format=p010,hwupload,tonemap_opencl=t=bt2020:tonemap=linear:format=p010,hwdownload,format=p010" OUTPUT
  15592. @end example
  15593. @end itemize
  15594. @section unsharp_opencl
  15595. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  15596. It accepts the following parameters:
  15597. @table @option
  15598. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  15599. Set the luma matrix horizontal size.
  15600. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15601. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  15602. Set the luma matrix vertical size.
  15603. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15604. @item luma_amount, la
  15605. Set the luma effect strength.
  15606. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15607. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  15608. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  15609. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  15610. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size.
  15611. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15612. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  15613. Set the chroma matrix vertical size.
  15614. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15615. @item chroma_amount, ca
  15616. Set the chroma effect strength.
  15617. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15618. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  15619. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  15620. @end table
  15621. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  15622. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  15623. @subsection Examples
  15624. @itemize
  15625. @item
  15626. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  15627. @example
  15628. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15629. @end example
  15630. @item
  15631. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  15632. @example
  15633. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=7:7:-2:7:7:-2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15634. @end example
  15635. @end itemize
  15636. @c man end OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  15637. @chapter Video Sources
  15638. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  15639. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  15640. @section buffer
  15641. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  15642. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  15643. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  15644. It accepts the following parameters:
  15645. @table @option
  15646. @item video_size
  15647. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  15648. syntax of this option, check the
  15649. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15650. @item width
  15651. The input video width.
  15652. @item height
  15653. The input video height.
  15654. @item pix_fmt
  15655. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  15656. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  15657. name.
  15658. @item time_base
  15659. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  15660. @item frame_rate
  15661. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  15662. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  15663. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  15664. @item sws_param
  15665. Specify the optional parameters to be used for the scale filter which
  15666. is automatically inserted when an input change is detected in the
  15667. input size or format.
  15668. @item hw_frames_ctx
  15669. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  15670. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  15671. @end table
  15672. For example:
  15673. @example
  15674. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  15675. @end example
  15676. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  15677. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  15678. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  15679. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  15680. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  15681. this example corresponds to:
  15682. @example
  15683. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  15684. @end example
  15685. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  15686. syntax is deprecated:
  15687. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}[:@var{sws_param}]
  15688. @section cellauto
  15689. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  15690. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  15691. @option{filename} and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  15692. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  15693. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  15694. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  15695. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  15696. This source accepts the following options:
  15697. @table @option
  15698. @item filename, f
  15699. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  15700. the specified file.
  15701. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  15702. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  15703. file will be ignored.
  15704. @item pattern, p
  15705. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  15706. the specified string.
  15707. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  15708. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  15709. string will be ignored.
  15710. @item rate, r
  15711. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  15712. Default is 25.
  15713. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  15714. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  15715. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  15716. 1/PHI.
  15717. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  15718. @item random_seed, seed
  15719. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  15720. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  15721. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  15722. effort basis.
  15723. @item rule
  15724. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  15725. Default value is 110.
  15726. @item size, s
  15727. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15728. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15729. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  15730. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  15731. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  15732. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  15733. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  15734. larger row.
  15735. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  15736. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  15737. @item scroll
  15738. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  15739. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  15740. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  15741. Defaults to 1.
  15742. @item start_full, full
  15743. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  15744. outputting the first frame.
  15745. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  15746. @item stitch
  15747. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  15748. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  15749. @end table
  15750. @subsection Examples
  15751. @itemize
  15752. @item
  15753. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  15754. size 200x400.
  15755. @example
  15756. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  15757. @end example
  15758. @item
  15759. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  15760. ratio of 2/3:
  15761. @example
  15762. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  15763. @end example
  15764. @item
  15765. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  15766. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  15767. @example
  15768. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  15769. @end example
  15770. @item
  15771. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  15772. @example
  15773. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  15774. @end example
  15775. @end itemize
  15776. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  15777. @section coreimagesrc
  15778. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  15779. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  15780. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  15781. generate the content.
  15782. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  15783. @table @option
  15784. @item list_generators
  15785. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  15786. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  15787. @example
  15788. list_generators=true
  15789. @end example
  15790. @item size, s
  15791. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15792. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15793. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  15794. @item rate, r
  15795. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  15796. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  15797. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  15798. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  15799. "25".
  15800. @item sar
  15801. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  15802. @item duration, d
  15803. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  15804. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  15805. for the accepted syntax.
  15806. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  15807. supposed to be generated forever.
  15808. @end table
  15809. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  15810. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  15811. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  15812. and examples for details.
  15813. @subsection Examples
  15814. @itemize
  15815. @item
  15816. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  15817. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  15818. @example
  15819. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  15820. @end example
  15821. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  15822. need for a nullsrc video source.
  15823. @end itemize
  15824. @section mandelbrot
  15825. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  15826. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  15827. This source accepts the following options:
  15828. @table @option
  15829. @item end_pts
  15830. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  15831. @item end_scale
  15832. Set the terminal scale value.
  15833. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  15834. @item inner
  15835. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  15836. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  15837. It shall assume one of the following values:
  15838. @table @option
  15839. @item black
  15840. Set black mode.
  15841. @item convergence
  15842. Show time until convergence.
  15843. @item mincol
  15844. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  15845. @item period
  15846. Set period mode.
  15847. @end table
  15848. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  15849. @item bailout
  15850. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  15851. @item maxiter
  15852. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  15853. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  15854. @item outer
  15855. Set outer coloring mode.
  15856. It shall assume one of following values:
  15857. @table @option
  15858. @item iteration_count
  15859. Set iteration count mode.
  15860. @item normalized_iteration_count
  15861. set normalized iteration count mode.
  15862. @end table
  15863. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  15864. @item rate, r
  15865. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  15866. value is "25".
  15867. @item size, s
  15868. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  15869. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  15870. @item start_scale
  15871. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  15872. @item start_x
  15873. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  15874. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  15875. @item start_y
  15876. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  15877. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  15878. @end table
  15879. @section mptestsrc
  15880. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  15881. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  15882. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  15883. This source accepts the following options:
  15884. @table @option
  15885. @item rate, r
  15886. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  15887. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  15888. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  15889. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  15890. "25".
  15891. @item duration, d
  15892. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  15893. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  15894. for the accepted syntax.
  15895. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  15896. supposed to be generated forever.
  15897. @item test, t
  15898. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  15899. @table @option
  15900. @item dc_luma
  15901. @item dc_chroma
  15902. @item freq_luma
  15903. @item freq_chroma
  15904. @item amp_luma
  15905. @item amp_chroma
  15906. @item cbp
  15907. @item mv
  15908. @item ring1
  15909. @item ring2
  15910. @item all
  15911. @end table
  15912. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  15913. @end table
  15914. Some examples:
  15915. @example
  15916. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  15917. @end example
  15918. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  15919. @section frei0r_src
  15920. Provide a frei0r source.
  15921. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  15922. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  15923. This source accepts the following parameters:
  15924. @table @option
  15925. @item size
  15926. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15927. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15928. @item framerate
  15929. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  15930. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  15931. @item filter_name
  15932. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  15933. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  15934. documentation.
  15935. @item filter_params
  15936. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  15937. @end table
  15938. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  15939. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  15940. @example
  15941. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  15942. @end example
  15943. @section life
  15944. Generate a life pattern.
  15945. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  15946. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  15947. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  15948. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  15949. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  15950. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  15951. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  15952. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  15953. the rule to adopt.
  15954. This source accepts the following options:
  15955. @table @option
  15956. @item filename, f
  15957. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  15958. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  15959. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  15960. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  15961. randomly.
  15962. @item rate, r
  15963. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  15964. Default is 25.
  15965. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  15966. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  15967. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  15968. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  15969. @item random_seed, seed
  15970. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  15971. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  15972. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  15973. effort basis.
  15974. @item rule
  15975. Set the life rule.
  15976. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  15977. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  15978. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  15979. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  15980. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  15981. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  15982. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  15983. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  15984. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  15985. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  15986. higher number of neighbor cells.
  15987. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  15988. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  15989. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  15990. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  15991. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  15992. a dead cell.
  15993. @item size, s
  15994. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15995. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15996. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  15997. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  15998. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  15999. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  16000. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  16001. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  16002. @item stitch
  16003. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  16004. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  16005. @item mold
  16006. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  16007. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  16008. value from 0 to 255.
  16009. @item life_color
  16010. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  16011. @item death_color
  16012. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  16013. used to represent a dead cell.
  16014. @item mold_color
  16015. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  16016. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  16017. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16018. @end table
  16019. @subsection Examples
  16020. @itemize
  16021. @item
  16022. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  16023. 300x300 pixels:
  16024. @example
  16025. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  16026. @end example
  16027. @item
  16028. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  16029. @example
  16030. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16031. @end example
  16032. @item
  16033. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  16034. @example
  16035. life=rule=S14/B34
  16036. @end example
  16037. @item
  16038. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  16039. @example
  16040. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  16041. @end example
  16042. @end itemize
  16043. @anchor{allrgb}
  16044. @anchor{allyuv}
  16045. @anchor{color}
  16046. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  16047. @anchor{nullsrc}
  16048. @anchor{pal75bars}
  16049. @anchor{pal100bars}
  16050. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  16051. @anchor{smptebars}
  16052. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  16053. @anchor{testsrc}
  16054. @anchor{testsrc2}
  16055. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  16056. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, pal75bars, pal100bars, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  16057. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  16058. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  16059. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  16060. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  16061. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  16062. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  16063. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  16064. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  16065. The @code{pal75bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16066. EBU PAL recommendations with 75% color levels.
  16067. The @code{pal100bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16068. EBU PAL recommendations with 100% color levels.
  16069. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  16070. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  16071. stripe from top to bottom.
  16072. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16073. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  16074. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16075. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  16076. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  16077. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  16078. intended for testing purposes.
  16079. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  16080. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  16081. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  16082. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  16083. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  16084. The sources accept the following parameters:
  16085. @table @option
  16086. @item level
  16087. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  16088. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  16089. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  16090. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  16091. @item color, c
  16092. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  16093. source. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16094. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16095. @item size, s
  16096. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16097. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16098. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  16099. This option is not available with the @code{allrgb}, @code{allyuv}, and
  16100. @code{haldclutsrc} filters.
  16101. @item rate, r
  16102. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16103. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16104. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16105. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16106. "25".
  16107. @item duration, d
  16108. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16109. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16110. for the accepted syntax.
  16111. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16112. supposed to be generated forever.
  16113. @item sar
  16114. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  16115. @item alpha
  16116. Specify the alpha (opacity) of the background, only available in the
  16117. @code{testsrc2} source. The value must be between 0 (fully transparent) and
  16118. 255 (fully opaque, the default).
  16119. @item decimals, n
  16120. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  16121. @code{testsrc} source.
  16122. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  16123. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  16124. value. Default value is 0.
  16125. @end table
  16126. @subsection Examples
  16127. @itemize
  16128. @item
  16129. Generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  16130. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second:
  16131. @example
  16132. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  16133. @end example
  16134. @item
  16135. The following graph description will generate a red source
  16136. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  16137. frames per second:
  16138. @example
  16139. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  16140. @end example
  16141. @item
  16142. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  16143. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  16144. the @code{geq} filter:
  16145. @example
  16146. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  16147. @end example
  16148. @end itemize
  16149. @subsection Commands
  16150. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  16151. @table @option
  16152. @item c, color
  16153. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  16154. corresponding @option{color} option.
  16155. @end table
  16156. @section openclsrc
  16157. Generate video using an OpenCL program.
  16158. @table @option
  16159. @item source
  16160. OpenCL program source file.
  16161. @item kernel
  16162. Kernel name in program.
  16163. @item size, s
  16164. Size of frames to generate. This must be set.
  16165. @item format
  16166. Pixel format to use for the generated frames. This must be set.
  16167. @item rate, r
  16168. Number of frames generated every second. Default value is '25'.
  16169. @end table
  16170. For details of how the program loading works, see the @ref{program_opencl}
  16171. filter.
  16172. Example programs:
  16173. @itemize
  16174. @item
  16175. Generate a colour ramp by setting pixel values from the position of the pixel
  16176. in the output image. (Note that this will work with all pixel formats, but
  16177. the generated output will not be the same.)
  16178. @verbatim
  16179. __kernel void ramp(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16180. unsigned int index)
  16181. {
  16182. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16183. float4 val;
  16184. val.xy = val.zw = convert_float2(loc) / convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  16185. write_imagef(dst, loc, val);
  16186. }
  16187. @end verbatim
  16188. @item
  16189. Generate a Sierpinski carpet pattern, panning by a single pixel each frame.
  16190. @verbatim
  16191. __kernel void sierpinski_carpet(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16192. unsigned int index)
  16193. {
  16194. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16195. float4 value = 0.0f;
  16196. int x = loc.x + index;
  16197. int y = loc.y + index;
  16198. while (x > 0 || y > 0) {
  16199. if (x % 3 == 1 && y % 3 == 1) {
  16200. value = 1.0f;
  16201. break;
  16202. }
  16203. x /= 3;
  16204. y /= 3;
  16205. }
  16206. write_imagef(dst, loc, value);
  16207. }
  16208. @end verbatim
  16209. @end itemize
  16210. @section sierpinski
  16211. Generate a Sierpinski carpet/triangle fractal, and randomly pan around.
  16212. This source accepts the following options:
  16213. @table @option
  16214. @item size, s
  16215. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  16216. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  16217. @item rate, r
  16218. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16219. value is "25".
  16220. @item seed
  16221. Set seed which is used for random panning.
  16222. @item jump
  16223. Set max jump for single pan destination. Allowed range is from 1 to 10000.
  16224. @item type
  16225. Set fractal type, can be default @code{carpet} or @code{triangle}.
  16226. @end table
  16227. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  16228. @chapter Video Sinks
  16229. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  16230. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  16231. @section buffersink
  16232. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  16233. graph.
  16234. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  16235. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  16236. or the options system.
  16237. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  16238. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  16239. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  16240. @section nullsink
  16241. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  16242. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  16243. tools.
  16244. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  16245. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  16246. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  16247. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  16248. @section abitscope
  16249. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio bit scope.
  16250. The filter accepts the following options:
  16251. @table @option
  16252. @item rate, r
  16253. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16254. value is "25".
  16255. @item size, s
  16256. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16257. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16258. Default value is @code{1024x256}.
  16259. @item colors
  16260. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  16261. draw channels. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  16262. by white color.
  16263. @end table
  16264. @section ahistogram
  16265. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  16266. The filter accepts the following options:
  16267. @table @option
  16268. @item dmode
  16269. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  16270. It accepts the following values:
  16271. @table @samp
  16272. @item single
  16273. Use single histogram for all channels.
  16274. @item separate
  16275. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  16276. @end table
  16277. Default is @code{single}.
  16278. @item rate, r
  16279. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16280. value is "25".
  16281. @item size, s
  16282. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16283. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16284. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  16285. @item scale
  16286. Set display scale.
  16287. It accepts the following values:
  16288. @table @samp
  16289. @item log
  16290. logarithmic
  16291. @item sqrt
  16292. square root
  16293. @item cbrt
  16294. cubic root
  16295. @item lin
  16296. linear
  16297. @item rlog
  16298. reverse logarithmic
  16299. @end table
  16300. Default is @code{log}.
  16301. @item ascale
  16302. Set amplitude scale.
  16303. It accepts the following values:
  16304. @table @samp
  16305. @item log
  16306. logarithmic
  16307. @item lin
  16308. linear
  16309. @end table
  16310. Default is @code{log}.
  16311. @item acount
  16312. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  16313. Default is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  16314. @item rheight
  16315. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  16316. @item slide
  16317. Set sonogram sliding.
  16318. It accepts the following values:
  16319. @table @samp
  16320. @item replace
  16321. replace old rows with new ones.
  16322. @item scroll
  16323. scroll from top to bottom.
  16324. @end table
  16325. Default is @code{replace}.
  16326. @end table
  16327. @section aphasemeter
  16328. Measures phase of input audio, which is exported as metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase},
  16329. representing mean phase of current audio frame. A video output can also be produced and is
  16330. enabled by default. The audio is passed through as first output.
  16331. Audio will be rematrixed to stereo if it has a different channel layout. Phase value is in
  16332. range @code{[-1, 1]} where @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase
  16333. and @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  16334. The filter accepts the following options, all related to its video output:
  16335. @table @option
  16336. @item rate, r
  16337. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  16338. @item size, s
  16339. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16340. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16341. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  16342. @item rc
  16343. @item gc
  16344. @item bc
  16345. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  16346. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  16347. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16348. @item mpc
  16349. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  16350. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  16351. @item video
  16352. Enable video output. Default is enabled.
  16353. @end table
  16354. @section avectorscope
  16355. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  16356. scope.
  16357. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  16358. audio stream. A monaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  16359. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  16360. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  16361. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  16362. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  16363. The filter accepts the following options:
  16364. @table @option
  16365. @item mode, m
  16366. Set the vectorscope mode.
  16367. Available values are:
  16368. @table @samp
  16369. @item lissajous
  16370. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  16371. @item lissajous_xy
  16372. Same as above but not rotated.
  16373. @item polar
  16374. Shape resembling half of circle.
  16375. @end table
  16376. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  16377. @item size, s
  16378. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16379. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16380. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  16381. @item rate, r
  16382. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  16383. @item rc
  16384. @item gc
  16385. @item bc
  16386. @item ac
  16387. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  16388. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  16389. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16390. @item rf
  16391. @item gf
  16392. @item bf
  16393. @item af
  16394. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  16395. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  16396. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16397. @item zoom
  16398. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  16399. Values lower than @var{1} will auto adjust zoom factor to maximal possible value.
  16400. @item draw
  16401. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  16402. Available values are:
  16403. @table @samp
  16404. @item dot
  16405. Draw dot for each sample.
  16406. @item line
  16407. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  16408. @end table
  16409. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  16410. @item scale
  16411. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  16412. Available values are:
  16413. @table @samp
  16414. @item lin
  16415. Linear.
  16416. @item sqrt
  16417. Square root.
  16418. @item cbrt
  16419. Cubic root.
  16420. @item log
  16421. Logarithmic.
  16422. @end table
  16423. @item swap
  16424. Swap left channel axis with right channel axis.
  16425. @item mirror
  16426. Mirror axis.
  16427. @table @samp
  16428. @item none
  16429. No mirror.
  16430. @item x
  16431. Mirror only x axis.
  16432. @item y
  16433. Mirror only y axis.
  16434. @item xy
  16435. Mirror both axis.
  16436. @end table
  16437. @end table
  16438. @subsection Examples
  16439. @itemize
  16440. @item
  16441. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  16442. @example
  16443. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  16444. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  16445. @end example
  16446. @end itemize
  16447. @section bench, abench
  16448. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  16449. The filter accepts the following options:
  16450. @table @option
  16451. @item action
  16452. Start or stop a timer.
  16453. Available values are:
  16454. @table @samp
  16455. @item start
  16456. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  16457. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  16458. @item stop
  16459. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  16460. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  16461. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  16462. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  16463. @end table
  16464. @end table
  16465. @subsection Examples
  16466. @itemize
  16467. @item
  16468. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  16469. @example
  16470. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  16471. @end example
  16472. @end itemize
  16473. @section concat
  16474. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  16475. other.
  16476. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  16477. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  16478. also be the number of streams at output.
  16479. The filter accepts the following options:
  16480. @table @option
  16481. @item n
  16482. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  16483. @item v
  16484. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  16485. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  16486. @item a
  16487. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  16488. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  16489. @item unsafe
  16490. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  16491. @end table
  16492. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  16493. @var{a} audio outputs.
  16494. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  16495. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  16496. segment, etc.
  16497. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  16498. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  16499. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  16500. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  16501. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  16502. audio streams with silence.
  16503. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  16504. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  16505. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  16506. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  16507. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  16508. explicitly by the user.
  16509. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  16510. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  16511. @subsection Examples
  16512. @itemize
  16513. @item
  16514. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  16515. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  16516. @example
  16517. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  16518. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  16519. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  16520. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  16521. @end example
  16522. @item
  16523. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  16524. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  16525. @example
  16526. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  16527. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  16528. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  16529. @end example
  16530. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  16531. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  16532. @end itemize
  16533. @subsection Commands
  16534. This filter supports the following commands:
  16535. @table @option
  16536. @item next
  16537. Close the current segment and step to the next one
  16538. @end table
  16539. @section drawgraph, adrawgraph
  16540. Draw a graph using input video or audio metadata.
  16541. It accepts the following parameters:
  16542. @table @option
  16543. @item m1
  16544. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  16545. @item fg1
  16546. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  16547. @item m2
  16548. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  16549. @item fg2
  16550. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  16551. @item m3
  16552. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  16553. @item fg3
  16554. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  16555. @item m4
  16556. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  16557. @item fg4
  16558. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  16559. @item min
  16560. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  16561. @item max
  16562. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  16563. @item bg
  16564. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  16565. @item mode
  16566. Set graph mode.
  16567. Available values for mode is:
  16568. @table @samp
  16569. @item bar
  16570. @item dot
  16571. @item line
  16572. @end table
  16573. Default is @code{line}.
  16574. @item slide
  16575. Set slide mode.
  16576. Available values for slide is:
  16577. @table @samp
  16578. @item frame
  16579. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  16580. @item replace
  16581. Replace old columns with new ones.
  16582. @item scroll
  16583. Scroll from right to left.
  16584. @item rscroll
  16585. Scroll from left to right.
  16586. @item picture
  16587. Draw single picture.
  16588. @end table
  16589. Default is @code{frame}.
  16590. @item size
  16591. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16592. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16593. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  16594. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  16595. @table @option
  16596. @item MIN
  16597. Minimal value of metadata value.
  16598. @item MAX
  16599. Maximal value of metadata value.
  16600. @item VAL
  16601. Current metadata key value.
  16602. @end table
  16603. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  16604. @end table
  16605. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  16606. @example
  16607. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  16608. @end example
  16609. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  16610. @example
  16611. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  16612. @end example
  16613. @anchor{ebur128}
  16614. @section ebur128
  16615. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream and analyzes its loudness
  16616. level. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  16617. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  16618. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  16619. The filter can only analyze streams which have a sampling rate of 48000 Hz and whose
  16620. sample format is double-precision floating point. The input stream will be converted to
  16621. this specification, if needed. Users may need to insert aformat and/or aresample filters
  16622. after this filter to obtain the original parameters.
  16623. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  16624. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  16625. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  16626. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  16627. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  16628. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds), but can optionally be configured
  16629. to instead display short-term loudness (see @var{gauge}).
  16630. The green area marks a +/- 1LU target range around the target loudness
  16631. (-23LUFS by default, unless modified through @var{target}).
  16632. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  16633. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  16634. The filter accepts the following options:
  16635. @table @option
  16636. @item video
  16637. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  16638. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  16639. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  16640. @item size
  16641. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  16642. option, check the
  16643. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16644. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  16645. @item meter
  16646. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  16647. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  16648. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  16649. @item metadata
  16650. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  16651. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  16652. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  16653. Default is @code{0}.
  16654. @item framelog
  16655. Force the frame logging level.
  16656. Available values are:
  16657. @table @samp
  16658. @item info
  16659. information logging level
  16660. @item verbose
  16661. verbose logging level
  16662. @end table
  16663. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  16664. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  16665. @item peak
  16666. Set peak mode(s).
  16667. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  16668. values are:
  16669. @table @samp
  16670. @item none
  16671. Disable any peak mode (default).
  16672. @item sample
  16673. Enable sample-peak mode.
  16674. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  16675. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  16676. @item true
  16677. Enable true-peak mode.
  16678. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  16679. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  16680. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  16681. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  16682. @end table
  16683. @item dualmono
  16684. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  16685. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  16686. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  16687. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  16688. @item panlaw
  16689. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  16690. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  16691. @item target
  16692. Set a specific target level (in LUFS) used as relative zero in the visualization.
  16693. This parameter is optional and has a default value of -23LUFS as specified
  16694. by EBU R128. However, material published online may prefer a level of -16LUFS
  16695. (e.g. for use with podcasts or video platforms).
  16696. @item gauge
  16697. Set the value displayed by the gauge. Valid values are @code{momentary} and s
  16698. @code{shortterm}. By default the momentary value will be used, but in certain
  16699. scenarios it may be more useful to observe the short term value instead (e.g.
  16700. live mixing).
  16701. @item scale
  16702. Sets the display scale for the loudness. Valid parameters are @code{absolute}
  16703. (in LUFS) or @code{relative} (LU) relative to the target. This only affects the
  16704. video output, not the summary or continuous log output.
  16705. @end table
  16706. @subsection Examples
  16707. @itemize
  16708. @item
  16709. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  16710. @example
  16711. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  16712. @end example
  16713. @item
  16714. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  16715. @example
  16716. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  16717. @end example
  16718. @end itemize
  16719. @section interleave, ainterleave
  16720. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  16721. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  16722. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  16723. queued frame to the output.
  16724. Input streams must have well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  16725. timestamp values.
  16726. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  16727. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  16728. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  16729. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  16730. which always drops input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  16731. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  16732. to output until the input sends an end-of-stream signal.
  16733. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  16734. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  16735. the queue is already filled.
  16736. These filters accept the following options:
  16737. @table @option
  16738. @item nb_inputs, n
  16739. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  16740. @end table
  16741. @subsection Examples
  16742. @itemize
  16743. @item
  16744. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  16745. @example
  16746. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  16747. @end example
  16748. @item
  16749. Add flickering blur effect:
  16750. @example
  16751. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  16752. @end example
  16753. @end itemize
  16754. @section metadata, ametadata
  16755. Manipulate frame metadata.
  16756. This filter accepts the following options:
  16757. @table @option
  16758. @item mode
  16759. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  16760. Can be one of the following:
  16761. @table @samp
  16762. @item select
  16763. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  16764. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  16765. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  16766. @item add
  16767. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  16768. do nothing.
  16769. @item modify
  16770. Modify value of already present key.
  16771. @item delete
  16772. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  16773. Otherwise, delete key. If @code{key} is not set, delete all metadata values in
  16774. the frame.
  16775. @item print
  16776. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  16777. metadata values available in frame.
  16778. @end table
  16779. @item key
  16780. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print} and @code{delete}.
  16781. @item value
  16782. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  16783. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  16784. @item function
  16785. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  16786. Can be one of following:
  16787. @table @samp
  16788. @item same_str
  16789. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  16790. @item starts_with
  16791. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  16792. the @code{value} option string.
  16793. @item less
  16794. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  16795. @item equal
  16796. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  16797. @item greater
  16798. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  16799. @item expr
  16800. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  16801. evaluates to true.
  16802. @item ends_with
  16803. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value ends with
  16804. the @code{value} option string.
  16805. @end table
  16806. @item expr
  16807. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  16808. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  16809. constants:
  16810. @table @option
  16811. @item VALUE1
  16812. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  16813. @item VALUE2
  16814. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  16815. @end table
  16816. @item file
  16817. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  16818. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  16819. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  16820. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  16821. @end table
  16822. @subsection Examples
  16823. @itemize
  16824. @item
  16825. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.signalstats.YDIF} with values
  16826. between 0 and 1.
  16827. @example
  16828. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  16829. @end example
  16830. @item
  16831. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  16832. @example
  16833. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  16834. @end example
  16835. @item
  16836. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  16837. @example
  16838. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  16839. @end example
  16840. @end itemize
  16841. @section perms, aperms
  16842. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  16843. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  16844. following filter in the filtergraph.
  16845. The filters accept the following options:
  16846. @table @option
  16847. @item mode
  16848. Select the permissions mode.
  16849. It accepts the following values:
  16850. @table @samp
  16851. @item none
  16852. Do nothing. This is the default.
  16853. @item ro
  16854. Set all the output frames read-only.
  16855. @item rw
  16856. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  16857. @item toggle
  16858. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  16859. @item random
  16860. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  16861. @end table
  16862. @item seed
  16863. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  16864. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  16865. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  16866. basis.
  16867. @end table
  16868. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  16869. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  16870. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  16871. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  16872. @section realtime, arealtime
  16873. Slow down filtering to match real time approximately.
  16874. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  16875. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  16876. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  16877. They accept the following options:
  16878. @table @option
  16879. @item limit
  16880. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  16881. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  16882. @item speed
  16883. Speed factor for processing. The value must be a float larger than zero.
  16884. Values larger than 1.0 will result in faster than realtime processing,
  16885. smaller will slow processing down. The @var{limit} is automatically adapted
  16886. accordingly. Default is 1.0.
  16887. A processing speed faster than what is possible without these filters cannot
  16888. be achieved.
  16889. @end table
  16890. @anchor{select}
  16891. @section select, aselect
  16892. Select frames to pass in output.
  16893. This filter accepts the following options:
  16894. @table @option
  16895. @item expr, e
  16896. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  16897. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  16898. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  16899. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  16900. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  16901. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  16902. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  16903. @item outputs, n
  16904. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  16905. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  16906. @end table
  16907. The expression can contain the following constants:
  16908. @table @option
  16909. @item n
  16910. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  16911. @item selected_n
  16912. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  16913. @item prev_selected_n
  16914. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  16915. @item TB
  16916. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  16917. @item pts
  16918. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  16919. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  16920. @item t
  16921. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  16922. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  16923. @item prev_pts
  16924. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  16925. @item prev_selected_pts
  16926. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  16927. @item prev_selected_t
  16928. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  16929. @item start_pts
  16930. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  16931. @item start_t
  16932. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  16933. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  16934. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  16935. values:
  16936. @table @option
  16937. @item I
  16938. @item P
  16939. @item B
  16940. @item S
  16941. @item SI
  16942. @item SP
  16943. @item BI
  16944. @end table
  16945. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  16946. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  16947. @table @option
  16948. @item PROGRESSIVE
  16949. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  16950. @item TOPFIRST
  16951. The frame is top-field-first.
  16952. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  16953. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  16954. @end table
  16955. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  16956. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  16957. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  16958. the number of samples in the current frame
  16959. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  16960. the input sample rate
  16961. @item key
  16962. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  16963. @item pos
  16964. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  16965. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  16966. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  16967. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  16968. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  16969. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  16970. @item concatdec_select
  16971. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  16972. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  16973. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  16974. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  16975. interval.
  16976. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  16977. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  16978. present in the decoded frames.
  16979. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  16980. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  16981. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  16982. missing.
  16983. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  16984. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  16985. @end table
  16986. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  16987. @subsection Examples
  16988. @itemize
  16989. @item
  16990. Select all frames in input:
  16991. @example
  16992. select
  16993. @end example
  16994. The example above is the same as:
  16995. @example
  16996. select=1
  16997. @end example
  16998. @item
  16999. Skip all frames:
  17000. @example
  17001. select=0
  17002. @end example
  17003. @item
  17004. Select only I-frames:
  17005. @example
  17006. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  17007. @end example
  17008. @item
  17009. Select one frame every 100:
  17010. @example
  17011. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  17012. @end example
  17013. @item
  17014. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17015. @example
  17016. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  17017. @end example
  17018. @item
  17019. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17020. @example
  17021. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  17022. @end example
  17023. @item
  17024. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  17025. @example
  17026. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  17027. @end example
  17028. @item
  17029. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  17030. @example
  17031. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  17032. @end example
  17033. @item
  17034. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  17035. @example
  17036. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  17037. @end example
  17038. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  17039. choice.
  17040. @item
  17041. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  17042. @example
  17043. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  17044. @end example
  17045. @item
  17046. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  17047. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  17048. @example
  17049. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  17050. @end example
  17051. @end itemize
  17052. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  17053. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  17054. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  17055. filtergraph.
  17056. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  17057. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  17058. from that they act the same way.
  17059. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  17060. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  17061. @var{filename} option.
  17062. These filters accept the following options:
  17063. @table @option
  17064. @item commands, c
  17065. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  17066. @item filename, f
  17067. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  17068. filters.
  17069. @end table
  17070. @subsection Commands syntax
  17071. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  17072. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  17073. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  17074. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  17075. interval.
  17076. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  17077. @example
  17078. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  17079. @end example
  17080. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  17081. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  17082. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  17083. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  17084. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  17085. @var{END}.
  17086. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  17087. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  17088. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  17089. @example
  17090. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  17091. @end example
  17092. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  17093. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  17094. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  17095. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  17096. The following flags are recognized:
  17097. @table @option
  17098. @item enter
  17099. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  17100. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17101. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  17102. current is.
  17103. @item leave
  17104. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  17105. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17106. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  17107. current is not.
  17108. @end table
  17109. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  17110. assumed.
  17111. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  17112. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  17113. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  17114. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  17115. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  17116. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  17117. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  17118. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  17119. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  17120. follows:
  17121. @example
  17122. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  17123. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  17124. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  17125. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  17126. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  17127. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  17128. @end example
  17129. @subsection Examples
  17130. @itemize
  17131. @item
  17132. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  17133. @example
  17134. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  17135. @end example
  17136. @item
  17137. Target a specific filter instance:
  17138. @example
  17139. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo@@my tempo 1.5',atempo@@my
  17140. @end example
  17141. @item
  17142. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  17143. @example
  17144. # show text in the interval 5-10
  17145. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  17146. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  17147. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  17148. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  17149. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  17150. [leave] hue s 1,
  17151. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  17152. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  17153. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  17154. @end example
  17155. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  17156. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  17157. @example
  17158. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  17159. @end example
  17160. @end itemize
  17161. @anchor{setpts}
  17162. @section setpts, asetpts
  17163. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  17164. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  17165. This filter accepts the following options:
  17166. @table @option
  17167. @item expr
  17168. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  17169. @end table
  17170. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  17171. constants:
  17172. @table @option
  17173. @item FRAME_RATE, FR
  17174. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  17175. @item PTS
  17176. The presentation timestamp in input
  17177. @item N
  17178. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  17179. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  17180. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  17181. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  17182. audio)
  17183. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  17184. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  17185. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  17186. The audio sample rate.
  17187. @item STARTPTS
  17188. The PTS of the first frame.
  17189. @item STARTT
  17190. the time in seconds of the first frame
  17191. @item INTERLACED
  17192. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  17193. @item T
  17194. the time in seconds of the current frame
  17195. @item POS
  17196. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  17197. for the current frame
  17198. @item PREV_INPTS
  17199. The previous input PTS.
  17200. @item PREV_INT
  17201. previous input time in seconds
  17202. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  17203. The previous output PTS.
  17204. @item PREV_OUTT
  17205. previous output time in seconds
  17206. @item RTCTIME
  17207. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  17208. instead.
  17209. @item RTCSTART
  17210. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  17211. @item TB
  17212. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  17213. @end table
  17214. @subsection Examples
  17215. @itemize
  17216. @item
  17217. Start counting PTS from zero
  17218. @example
  17219. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  17220. @end example
  17221. @item
  17222. Apply fast motion effect:
  17223. @example
  17224. setpts=0.5*PTS
  17225. @end example
  17226. @item
  17227. Apply slow motion effect:
  17228. @example
  17229. setpts=2.0*PTS
  17230. @end example
  17231. @item
  17232. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  17233. @example
  17234. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  17235. @end example
  17236. @item
  17237. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  17238. @example
  17239. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  17240. @end example
  17241. @item
  17242. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  17243. @example
  17244. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  17245. @end example
  17246. @item
  17247. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  17248. @example
  17249. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  17250. @end example
  17251. @item
  17252. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  17253. @example
  17254. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  17255. @end example
  17256. @end itemize
  17257. @section setrange
  17258. Force color range for the output video frame.
  17259. The @code{setrange} filter marks the color range property for the
  17260. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  17261. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  17262. following filters.
  17263. The filter accepts the following options:
  17264. @table @option
  17265. @item range
  17266. Available values are:
  17267. @table @samp
  17268. @item auto
  17269. Keep the same color range property.
  17270. @item unspecified, unknown
  17271. Set the color range as unspecified.
  17272. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  17273. Set the color range as limited.
  17274. @item full, pc, jpeg
  17275. Set the color range as full.
  17276. @end table
  17277. @end table
  17278. @section settb, asettb
  17279. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  17280. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  17281. It accepts the following parameters:
  17282. @table @option
  17283. @item expr, tb
  17284. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  17285. @end table
  17286. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  17287. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  17288. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  17289. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  17290. @subsection Examples
  17291. @itemize
  17292. @item
  17293. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  17294. @example
  17295. settb=expr=1/25
  17296. @end example
  17297. @item
  17298. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  17299. @example
  17300. settb=expr=0.1
  17301. @end example
  17302. @item
  17303. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  17304. @example
  17305. settb=1+0.001
  17306. @end example
  17307. @item
  17308. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  17309. @example
  17310. settb=2*intb
  17311. @end example
  17312. @item
  17313. Set the default timebase value:
  17314. @example
  17315. settb=AVTB
  17316. @end example
  17317. @end itemize
  17318. @section showcqt
  17319. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  17320. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  17321. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  17322. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  17323. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  17324. The filter accepts the following options:
  17325. @table @option
  17326. @item size, s
  17327. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  17328. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17329. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  17330. @item fps, rate, r
  17331. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17332. @item bar_h
  17333. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  17334. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  17335. @item axis_h
  17336. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  17337. the axis height automatically.
  17338. @item sono_h
  17339. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  17340. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  17341. @item fullhd
  17342. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  17343. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  17344. @item sono_v, volume
  17345. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  17346. @table @option
  17347. @item bar_v
  17348. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  17349. @item frequency, freq, f
  17350. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17351. @item timeclamp, tc
  17352. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17353. @end table
  17354. and functions:
  17355. @table @option
  17356. @item a_weighting(f)
  17357. A-weighting of equal loudness
  17358. @item b_weighting(f)
  17359. B-weighting of equal loudness
  17360. @item c_weighting(f)
  17361. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  17362. @end table
  17363. Default value is @code{16}.
  17364. @item bar_v, volume2
  17365. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  17366. @table @option
  17367. @item sono_v
  17368. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  17369. @item frequency, freq, f
  17370. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17371. @item timeclamp, tc
  17372. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17373. @end table
  17374. and functions:
  17375. @table @option
  17376. @item a_weighting(f)
  17377. A-weighting of equal loudness
  17378. @item b_weighting(f)
  17379. B-weighting of equal loudness
  17380. @item c_weighting(f)
  17381. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  17382. @end table
  17383. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  17384. @item sono_g, gamma
  17385. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  17386. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  17387. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  17388. @item bar_g, gamma2
  17389. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  17390. @code{[1, 7]}.
  17391. @item bar_t
  17392. Specify the bargraph transparency level. Lower value makes the bargraph sharper.
  17393. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  17394. @item timeclamp, tc
  17395. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  17396. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  17397. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  17398. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  17399. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.002, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  17400. @item attack
  17401. Set attack time in seconds. The default is @code{0} (disabled). Otherwise, it
  17402. limits future samples by applying asymmetric windowing in time domain, useful
  17403. when low latency is required. Accepted range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  17404. @item basefreq
  17405. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  17406. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  17407. @item endfreq
  17408. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  17409. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  17410. @item coeffclamp
  17411. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  17412. @item tlength
  17413. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  17414. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  17415. It can contain variables:
  17416. @table @option
  17417. @item frequency, freq, f
  17418. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17419. @item timeclamp, tc
  17420. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  17421. @end table
  17422. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  17423. @item count
  17424. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  17425. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  17426. @item fcount
  17427. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  17428. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  17429. @item fontfile
  17430. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  17431. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  17432. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  17433. option instead.
  17434. @item font
  17435. Specify fontconfig pattern. This has lower priority than @var{fontfile}. The
  17436. @code{:} in the pattern may be replaced by @code{|} to avoid unnecessary
  17437. escaping.
  17438. @item fontcolor
  17439. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  17440. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  17441. @table @option
  17442. @item frequency, freq, f
  17443. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17444. @item timeclamp, tc
  17445. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17446. @end table
  17447. and functions:
  17448. @table @option
  17449. @item midi(f)
  17450. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  17451. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  17452. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  17453. @end table
  17454. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  17455. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  17456. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  17457. @item axisfile
  17458. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  17459. @var{fontcolor} option.
  17460. @item axis, text
  17461. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  17462. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  17463. Default value is @code{1}.
  17464. @item csp
  17465. Set colorspace. The accepted values are:
  17466. @table @samp
  17467. @item unspecified
  17468. Unspecified (default)
  17469. @item bt709
  17470. BT.709
  17471. @item fcc
  17472. FCC
  17473. @item bt470bg
  17474. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  17475. @item smpte170m
  17476. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  17477. @item smpte240m
  17478. SMPTE-240M
  17479. @item bt2020ncl
  17480. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  17481. @end table
  17482. @item cscheme
  17483. Set spectrogram color scheme. This is list of floating point values with format
  17484. @code{left_r|left_g|left_b|right_r|right_g|right_b}.
  17485. The default is @code{1|0.5|0|0|0.5|1}.
  17486. @end table
  17487. @subsection Examples
  17488. @itemize
  17489. @item
  17490. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  17491. @example
  17492. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  17493. @end example
  17494. @item
  17495. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  17496. @example
  17497. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  17498. @end example
  17499. @item
  17500. Playing at 1280x720:
  17501. @example
  17502. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  17503. @end example
  17504. @item
  17505. Disable sonogram display:
  17506. @example
  17507. sono_h=0
  17508. @end example
  17509. @item
  17510. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  17511. @example
  17512. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  17513. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  17514. @end example
  17515. @item
  17516. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  17517. @example
  17518. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  17519. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  17520. @end example
  17521. @item
  17522. Custom volume:
  17523. @example
  17524. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  17525. @end example
  17526. @item
  17527. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  17528. @example
  17529. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  17530. @end example
  17531. @item
  17532. Custom tlength equation:
  17533. @example
  17534. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  17535. @end example
  17536. @item
  17537. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  17538. @example
  17539. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  17540. @end example
  17541. @item
  17542. Custom font using fontconfig:
  17543. @example
  17544. font='Courier New,Monospace,mono|bold'
  17545. @end example
  17546. @item
  17547. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  17548. @example
  17549. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  17550. @end example
  17551. @end itemize
  17552. @section showfreqs
  17553. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  17554. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  17555. The filter accepts the following options:
  17556. @table @option
  17557. @item size, s
  17558. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17559. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17560. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  17561. @item mode
  17562. Set display mode.
  17563. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  17564. It accepts the following values:
  17565. @table @samp
  17566. @item line
  17567. @item bar
  17568. @item dot
  17569. @end table
  17570. Default is @code{bar}.
  17571. @item ascale
  17572. Set amplitude scale.
  17573. It accepts the following values:
  17574. @table @samp
  17575. @item lin
  17576. Linear scale.
  17577. @item sqrt
  17578. Square root scale.
  17579. @item cbrt
  17580. Cubic root scale.
  17581. @item log
  17582. Logarithmic scale.
  17583. @end table
  17584. Default is @code{log}.
  17585. @item fscale
  17586. Set frequency scale.
  17587. It accepts the following values:
  17588. @table @samp
  17589. @item lin
  17590. Linear scale.
  17591. @item log
  17592. Logarithmic scale.
  17593. @item rlog
  17594. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  17595. @end table
  17596. Default is @code{lin}.
  17597. @item win_size
  17598. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 65536.
  17599. Default is @code{2048}
  17600. @item win_func
  17601. Set windowing function.
  17602. It accepts the following values:
  17603. @table @samp
  17604. @item rect
  17605. @item bartlett
  17606. @item hanning
  17607. @item hamming
  17608. @item blackman
  17609. @item welch
  17610. @item flattop
  17611. @item bharris
  17612. @item bnuttall
  17613. @item bhann
  17614. @item sine
  17615. @item nuttall
  17616. @item lanczos
  17617. @item gauss
  17618. @item tukey
  17619. @item dolph
  17620. @item cauchy
  17621. @item parzen
  17622. @item poisson
  17623. @item bohman
  17624. @end table
  17625. Default is @code{hanning}.
  17626. @item overlap
  17627. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  17628. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  17629. @item averaging
  17630. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  17631. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  17632. @item colors
  17633. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  17634. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  17635. by white color.
  17636. @item cmode
  17637. Set channel display mode.
  17638. It accepts the following values:
  17639. @table @samp
  17640. @item combined
  17641. @item separate
  17642. @end table
  17643. Default is @code{combined}.
  17644. @item minamp
  17645. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  17646. @end table
  17647. @section showspatial
  17648. Convert stereo input audio to a video output, representing the spatial relationship
  17649. between two channels.
  17650. The filter accepts the following options:
  17651. @table @option
  17652. @item size, s
  17653. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17654. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17655. Default value is @code{512x512}.
  17656. @item win_size
  17657. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  17658. @item win_func
  17659. Set window function.
  17660. It accepts the following values:
  17661. @table @samp
  17662. @item rect
  17663. @item bartlett
  17664. @item hann
  17665. @item hanning
  17666. @item hamming
  17667. @item blackman
  17668. @item welch
  17669. @item flattop
  17670. @item bharris
  17671. @item bnuttall
  17672. @item bhann
  17673. @item sine
  17674. @item nuttall
  17675. @item lanczos
  17676. @item gauss
  17677. @item tukey
  17678. @item dolph
  17679. @item cauchy
  17680. @item parzen
  17681. @item poisson
  17682. @item bohman
  17683. @end table
  17684. Default value is @code{hann}.
  17685. @item overlap
  17686. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  17687. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  17688. window function currently used.
  17689. @end table
  17690. @anchor{showspectrum}
  17691. @section showspectrum
  17692. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  17693. spectrum.
  17694. The filter accepts the following options:
  17695. @table @option
  17696. @item size, s
  17697. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17698. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17699. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  17700. @item slide
  17701. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  17702. It accepts the following values:
  17703. @table @samp
  17704. @item replace
  17705. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  17706. @item scroll
  17707. the samples scroll from right to left
  17708. @item fullframe
  17709. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  17710. @item rscroll
  17711. the samples scroll from left to right
  17712. @end table
  17713. Default value is @code{replace}.
  17714. @item mode
  17715. Specify display mode.
  17716. It accepts the following values:
  17717. @table @samp
  17718. @item combined
  17719. all channels are displayed in the same row
  17720. @item separate
  17721. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  17722. @end table
  17723. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  17724. @item color
  17725. Specify display color mode.
  17726. It accepts the following values:
  17727. @table @samp
  17728. @item channel
  17729. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  17730. @item intensity
  17731. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  17732. @item rainbow
  17733. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  17734. @item moreland
  17735. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  17736. @item nebulae
  17737. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  17738. @item fire
  17739. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  17740. @item fiery
  17741. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  17742. @item fruit
  17743. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  17744. @item cool
  17745. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  17746. @item magma
  17747. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  17748. @item green
  17749. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  17750. @item viridis
  17751. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  17752. @item plasma
  17753. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  17754. @item cividis
  17755. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  17756. @item terrain
  17757. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  17758. @end table
  17759. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  17760. @item scale
  17761. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  17762. It accepts the following values:
  17763. @table @samp
  17764. @item lin
  17765. linear
  17766. @item sqrt
  17767. square root, default
  17768. @item cbrt
  17769. cubic root
  17770. @item log
  17771. logarithmic
  17772. @item 4thrt
  17773. 4th root
  17774. @item 5thrt
  17775. 5th root
  17776. @end table
  17777. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  17778. @item fscale
  17779. Specify frequency scale.
  17780. It accepts the following values:
  17781. @table @samp
  17782. @item lin
  17783. linear
  17784. @item log
  17785. logarithmic
  17786. @end table
  17787. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  17788. @item saturation
  17789. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  17790. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  17791. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  17792. Default value is @code{1}.
  17793. @item win_func
  17794. Set window function.
  17795. It accepts the following values:
  17796. @table @samp
  17797. @item rect
  17798. @item bartlett
  17799. @item hann
  17800. @item hanning
  17801. @item hamming
  17802. @item blackman
  17803. @item welch
  17804. @item flattop
  17805. @item bharris
  17806. @item bnuttall
  17807. @item bhann
  17808. @item sine
  17809. @item nuttall
  17810. @item lanczos
  17811. @item gauss
  17812. @item tukey
  17813. @item dolph
  17814. @item cauchy
  17815. @item parzen
  17816. @item poisson
  17817. @item bohman
  17818. @end table
  17819. Default value is @code{hann}.
  17820. @item orientation
  17821. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  17822. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  17823. @item overlap
  17824. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  17825. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  17826. window function currently used.
  17827. @item gain
  17828. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  17829. Default value is @code{1}.
  17830. @item data
  17831. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  17832. @item rotation
  17833. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  17834. Default value is @code{0}.
  17835. @item start
  17836. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  17837. @item stop
  17838. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  17839. @item fps
  17840. Set upper frame rate limit. Default is @code{auto}, unlimited.
  17841. @item legend
  17842. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is disabled.
  17843. @end table
  17844. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  17845. section.
  17846. @subsection Examples
  17847. @itemize
  17848. @item
  17849. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  17850. @example
  17851. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  17852. @end example
  17853. @item
  17854. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  17855. @example
  17856. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  17857. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  17858. @end example
  17859. @end itemize
  17860. @section showspectrumpic
  17861. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  17862. spectrum.
  17863. The filter accepts the following options:
  17864. @table @option
  17865. @item size, s
  17866. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17867. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17868. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  17869. @item mode
  17870. Specify display mode.
  17871. It accepts the following values:
  17872. @table @samp
  17873. @item combined
  17874. all channels are displayed in the same row
  17875. @item separate
  17876. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  17877. @end table
  17878. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  17879. @item color
  17880. Specify display color mode.
  17881. It accepts the following values:
  17882. @table @samp
  17883. @item channel
  17884. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  17885. @item intensity
  17886. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  17887. @item rainbow
  17888. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  17889. @item moreland
  17890. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  17891. @item nebulae
  17892. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  17893. @item fire
  17894. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  17895. @item fiery
  17896. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  17897. @item fruit
  17898. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  17899. @item cool
  17900. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  17901. @item magma
  17902. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  17903. @item green
  17904. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  17905. @item viridis
  17906. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  17907. @item plasma
  17908. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  17909. @item cividis
  17910. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  17911. @item terrain
  17912. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  17913. @end table
  17914. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  17915. @item scale
  17916. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  17917. It accepts the following values:
  17918. @table @samp
  17919. @item lin
  17920. linear
  17921. @item sqrt
  17922. square root, default
  17923. @item cbrt
  17924. cubic root
  17925. @item log
  17926. logarithmic
  17927. @item 4thrt
  17928. 4th root
  17929. @item 5thrt
  17930. 5th root
  17931. @end table
  17932. Default value is @samp{log}.
  17933. @item fscale
  17934. Specify frequency scale.
  17935. It accepts the following values:
  17936. @table @samp
  17937. @item lin
  17938. linear
  17939. @item log
  17940. logarithmic
  17941. @end table
  17942. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  17943. @item saturation
  17944. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  17945. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  17946. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  17947. Default value is @code{1}.
  17948. @item win_func
  17949. Set window function.
  17950. It accepts the following values:
  17951. @table @samp
  17952. @item rect
  17953. @item bartlett
  17954. @item hann
  17955. @item hanning
  17956. @item hamming
  17957. @item blackman
  17958. @item welch
  17959. @item flattop
  17960. @item bharris
  17961. @item bnuttall
  17962. @item bhann
  17963. @item sine
  17964. @item nuttall
  17965. @item lanczos
  17966. @item gauss
  17967. @item tukey
  17968. @item dolph
  17969. @item cauchy
  17970. @item parzen
  17971. @item poisson
  17972. @item bohman
  17973. @end table
  17974. Default value is @code{hann}.
  17975. @item orientation
  17976. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  17977. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  17978. @item gain
  17979. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  17980. Default value is @code{1}.
  17981. @item legend
  17982. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  17983. @item rotation
  17984. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  17985. Default value is @code{0}.
  17986. @item start
  17987. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  17988. @item stop
  17989. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  17990. @end table
  17991. @subsection Examples
  17992. @itemize
  17993. @item
  17994. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  17995. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  17996. @example
  17997. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  17998. @end example
  17999. @end itemize
  18000. @section showvolume
  18001. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  18002. The filter accepts the following options:
  18003. @table @option
  18004. @item rate, r
  18005. Set video rate.
  18006. @item b
  18007. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  18008. @item w
  18009. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  18010. @item h
  18011. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  18012. @item f
  18013. Set fade, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  18014. @item c
  18015. Set volume color expression.
  18016. The expression can use the following variables:
  18017. @table @option
  18018. @item VOLUME
  18019. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  18020. @item PEAK
  18021. Current peak.
  18022. @item CHANNEL
  18023. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  18024. @end table
  18025. @item t
  18026. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  18027. @item v
  18028. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  18029. @item o
  18030. Set orientation, can be horizontal: @code{h} or vertical: @code{v},
  18031. default is @code{h}.
  18032. @item s
  18033. Set step size, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  18034. step is disabled.
  18035. @item p
  18036. Set background opacity, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.
  18037. @item m
  18038. Set metering mode, can be peak: @code{p} or rms: @code{r},
  18039. default is @code{p}.
  18040. @item ds
  18041. Set display scale, can be linear: @code{lin} or log: @code{log},
  18042. default is @code{lin}.
  18043. @item dm
  18044. In second.
  18045. If set to > 0., display a line for the max level
  18046. in the previous seconds.
  18047. default is disabled: @code{0.}
  18048. @item dmc
  18049. The color of the max line. Use when @code{dm} option is set to > 0.
  18050. default is: @code{orange}
  18051. @end table
  18052. @section showwaves
  18053. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  18054. The filter accepts the following options:
  18055. @table @option
  18056. @item size, s
  18057. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18058. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18059. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18060. @item mode
  18061. Set display mode.
  18062. Available values are:
  18063. @table @samp
  18064. @item point
  18065. Draw a point for each sample.
  18066. @item line
  18067. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  18068. @item p2p
  18069. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  18070. @item cline
  18071. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  18072. @end table
  18073. Default value is @code{point}.
  18074. @item n
  18075. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  18076. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  18077. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  18078. is not explicitly specified.
  18079. @item rate, r
  18080. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  18081. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  18082. @item split_channels
  18083. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18084. @item colors
  18085. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18086. @item scale
  18087. Set amplitude scale.
  18088. Available values are:
  18089. @table @samp
  18090. @item lin
  18091. Linear.
  18092. @item log
  18093. Logarithmic.
  18094. @item sqrt
  18095. Square root.
  18096. @item cbrt
  18097. Cubic root.
  18098. @end table
  18099. Default is linear.
  18100. @item draw
  18101. Set the draw mode. This is mostly useful to set for high @var{n}.
  18102. Available values are:
  18103. @table @samp
  18104. @item scale
  18105. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  18106. @item full
  18107. Draw every sample directly.
  18108. @end table
  18109. Default value is @code{scale}.
  18110. @end table
  18111. @subsection Examples
  18112. @itemize
  18113. @item
  18114. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  18115. at the same time:
  18116. @example
  18117. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  18118. @end example
  18119. @item
  18120. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  18121. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  18122. @example
  18123. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  18124. @end example
  18125. @end itemize
  18126. @section showwavespic
  18127. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  18128. The filter accepts the following options:
  18129. @table @option
  18130. @item size, s
  18131. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18132. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18133. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18134. @item split_channels
  18135. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18136. @item colors
  18137. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18138. @item scale
  18139. Set amplitude scale.
  18140. Available values are:
  18141. @table @samp
  18142. @item lin
  18143. Linear.
  18144. @item log
  18145. Logarithmic.
  18146. @item sqrt
  18147. Square root.
  18148. @item cbrt
  18149. Cubic root.
  18150. @end table
  18151. Default is linear.
  18152. @item draw
  18153. Set the draw mode.
  18154. Available values are:
  18155. @table @samp
  18156. @item scale
  18157. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  18158. @item full
  18159. Draw every sample directly.
  18160. @end table
  18161. Default value is @code{scale}.
  18162. @end table
  18163. @subsection Examples
  18164. @itemize
  18165. @item
  18166. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  18167. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  18168. @example
  18169. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  18170. @end example
  18171. @end itemize
  18172. @section sidedata, asidedata
  18173. Delete frame side data, or select frames based on it.
  18174. This filter accepts the following options:
  18175. @table @option
  18176. @item mode
  18177. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  18178. Can be one of the following:
  18179. @table @samp
  18180. @item select
  18181. Select every frame with side data of @code{type}.
  18182. @item delete
  18183. Delete side data of @code{type}. If @code{type} is not set, delete all side
  18184. data in the frame.
  18185. @end table
  18186. @item type
  18187. Set side data type used with all modes. Must be set for @code{select} mode. For
  18188. the list of frame side data types, refer to the @code{AVFrameSideDataType} enum
  18189. in @file{libavutil/frame.h}. For example, to choose
  18190. @code{AV_FRAME_DATA_PANSCAN} side data, you must specify @code{PANSCAN}.
  18191. @end table
  18192. @section spectrumsynth
  18193. Synthesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  18194. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  18195. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  18196. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  18197. This filter is primarily created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  18198. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  18199. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  18200. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  18201. it's just recreated from random noise.
  18202. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  18203. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  18204. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  18205. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  18206. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  18207. The filter accepts the following options:
  18208. @table @option
  18209. @item sample_rate
  18210. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  18211. spectrum was generated may differ.
  18212. @item channels
  18213. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  18214. @item scale
  18215. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  18216. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  18217. @item slide
  18218. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  18219. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  18220. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  18221. @item win_func
  18222. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  18223. @item overlap
  18224. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  18225. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  18226. @item orientation
  18227. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  18228. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18229. @end table
  18230. @subsection Examples
  18231. @itemize
  18232. @item
  18233. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  18234. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  18235. @example
  18236. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  18237. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  18238. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  18239. @end example
  18240. @end itemize
  18241. @section split, asplit
  18242. Split input into several identical outputs.
  18243. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  18244. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  18245. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  18246. @subsection Examples
  18247. @itemize
  18248. @item
  18249. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  18250. @example
  18251. [in] split [out0][out1]
  18252. @end example
  18253. @item
  18254. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  18255. outputs, like in:
  18256. @example
  18257. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  18258. @end example
  18259. @item
  18260. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  18261. one padded:
  18262. @example
  18263. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  18264. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  18265. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  18266. @end example
  18267. @item
  18268. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  18269. @example
  18270. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  18271. @end example
  18272. @end itemize
  18273. @section zmq, azmq
  18274. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  18275. filters in the filtergraph.
  18276. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  18277. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  18278. audio filters. Both are capable to send messages to any filter type.
  18279. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  18280. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  18281. For more information about libzmq see:
  18282. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  18283. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  18284. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  18285. @option{bind_address} (or the abbreviation "@option{b}") option.
  18286. Default value of this option is @file{tcp://localhost:5555}. You may
  18287. want to alter this value to your needs, but do not forget to escape any
  18288. ':' signs (see @ref{filtergraph escaping}).
  18289. The received message must be in the form:
  18290. @example
  18291. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  18292. @end example
  18293. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  18294. the filter class or a specific filter instance name. The default
  18295. filter instance name uses the pattern @samp{Parsed_<filter_name>_<index>},
  18296. but you can override this by using the @samp{filter_name@@id} syntax
  18297. (see @ref{Filtergraph syntax}).
  18298. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  18299. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  18300. given @var{COMMAND}.
  18301. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  18302. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  18303. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  18304. @example
  18305. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  18306. @var{MESSAGE}
  18307. @end example
  18308. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  18309. @subsection Examples
  18310. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  18311. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  18312. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}.
  18313. In this example the last overlay filter has an instance name. All other
  18314. filters will have default instance names.
  18315. @example
  18316. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  18317. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  18318. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  18319. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  18320. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  18321. [bg+l][r] overlay@@my=x=100 "
  18322. @end example
  18323. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  18324. command can be used:
  18325. @example
  18326. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  18327. @end example
  18328. To change the right side:
  18329. @example
  18330. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  18331. @end example
  18332. To change the position of the right side:
  18333. @example
  18334. echo overlay@@my x 150 | tools/zmqsend
  18335. @end example
  18336. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  18337. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  18338. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  18339. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  18340. @section amovie
  18341. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  18342. stream by default.
  18343. @anchor{movie}
  18344. @section movie
  18345. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  18346. It accepts the following parameters:
  18347. @table @option
  18348. @item filename
  18349. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  18350. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  18351. @item format_name, f
  18352. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  18353. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  18354. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  18355. @item seek_point, sp
  18356. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  18357. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  18358. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  18359. postfix. The default value is "0".
  18360. @item streams, s
  18361. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  18362. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  18363. same order. The syntax is explained in the @ref{Stream specifiers,,"Stream specifiers"
  18364. section in the ffmpeg manual,ffmpeg}. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  18365. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  18366. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  18367. @item stream_index, si
  18368. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  18369. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  18370. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  18371. audio instead of video.
  18372. @item loop
  18373. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  18374. If the value is 0, the stream will be looped infinitely.
  18375. Default value is "1".
  18376. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  18377. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  18378. @item discontinuity
  18379. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  18380. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  18381. timestamps.
  18382. @end table
  18383. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  18384. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  18385. @example
  18386. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  18387. ^
  18388. |
  18389. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  18390. @end example
  18391. @subsection Examples
  18392. @itemize
  18393. @item
  18394. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  18395. on top of the input labelled "in":
  18396. @example
  18397. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  18398. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  18399. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  18400. @end example
  18401. @item
  18402. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  18403. labelled "in":
  18404. @example
  18405. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  18406. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  18407. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  18408. @end example
  18409. @item
  18410. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  18411. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  18412. connected to the pad named "audio":
  18413. @example
  18414. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  18415. @end example
  18416. @end itemize
  18417. @subsection Commands
  18418. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  18419. @table @option
  18420. @item seek
  18421. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  18422. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  18423. @itemize
  18424. @item
  18425. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  18426. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  18427. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  18428. @item
  18429. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  18430. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  18431. @item
  18432. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  18433. @end itemize
  18434. @item get_duration
  18435. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  18436. @end table
  18437. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES